(latin1-char-displayable-p): New
[bpt/emacs.git] / mac / src / macterm.c
CommitLineData
1a578e9b
AC
1/* Implementation of GUI terminal on the Mac OS.
2 Copyright (C) 2000 Free Software Foundation, Inc.
3
4This file is part of GNU Emacs.
5
6GNU Emacs is free software; you can redistribute it and/or modify
7it under the terms of the GNU General Public License as published by
8the Free Software Foundation; either version 2, or (at your option)
9any later version.
10
11GNU Emacs is distributed in the hope that it will be useful,
12but WITHOUT ANY WARRANTY; without even the implied warranty of
13MERCHANTABILITY or FITNESS FOR A PARTICULAR PURPOSE. See the
14GNU General Public License for more details.
15
16You should have received a copy of the GNU General Public License
17along with GNU Emacs; see the file COPYING. If not, write to
18the Free Software Foundation, Inc., 59 Temple Place - Suite 330,
19Boston, MA 02111-1307, USA. */
20
21/* Contributed by Andrew Choi (akochoi@users.sourceforge.net). */
22
23#include <config.h>
24
25/* On 4.3 these lose if they come after xterm.h. */
26/* Putting these at the beginning seems to be standard for other .c files. */
27#include <signal.h>
28
29#include <stdio.h>
30
31#include "lisp.h"
32#include "blockinput.h"
33
34/* Need syssignal.h for various externs and definitions that may be required
35 by some configurations for calls to signal later in this source file. */
36#include "syssignal.h"
37
38/* This may include sys/types.h, and that somehow loses
39 if this is not done before the other system files. */
40#include "macterm.h"
41
42#include <stdlib.h>
43#include <string.h>
44#include <alloca.h>
45
46#include <Quickdraw.h>
47#include <ToolUtils.h>
48#include <Sound.h>
49#include <Events.h>
50#include <Script.h>
51#include <Resources.h>
52#include <Fonts.h>
53#include <TextUtils.h>
54#include <LowMem.h>
55#include <Controls.h>
56#if defined (__MRC__) || defined (CODEWARRIOR_VERSION_6)
57#include <ControlDefinitions.h>
58#endif
59
60#if __profile__
61#include <profiler.h>
62#endif
63
64#include <sys/types.h>
65
66#include "systty.h"
67#include "systime.h"
68
69#ifndef INCLUDED_FCNTL
70#include <fcntl.h>
71#endif
72#include <ctype.h>
73#include <errno.h>
74#include <setjmp.h>
75#include <sys/stat.h>
76
77#include "charset.h"
78#include "ccl.h"
79#include "frame.h"
80#include "dispextern.h"
81#include "fontset.h"
82#include "termhooks.h"
83#include "termopts.h"
84#include "termchar.h"
85#include "gnu.h"
86#include "disptab.h"
87#include "buffer.h"
88#include "window.h"
89#include "keyboard.h"
90#include "intervals.h"
91#include "process.h"
92#include "atimer.h"
93#include "coding.h"
94
95#ifdef HAVE_UNISTD_H
96#include <unistd.h>
97#endif
98
99#ifndef USE_X_TOOLKIT
100#define x_any_window_to_frame x_window_to_frame
101#define x_top_window_to_frame x_window_to_frame
102#endif
103
104#ifndef min
105#define min(a,b) ((a) < (b) ? (a) : (b))
106#endif
107#ifndef max
108#define max(a,b) ((a) > (b) ? (a) : (b))
109#endif
110
111#define BETWEEN(X, LOWER, UPPER) ((X) >= (LOWER) && (X) < (UPPER))
112
113\f
114/* Bitmaps for truncated lines. */
115
116enum bitmap_type
117{
118 NO_BITMAP,
119 LEFT_TRUNCATION_BITMAP,
120 RIGHT_TRUNCATION_BITMAP,
121 OVERLAY_ARROW_BITMAP,
122 CONTINUED_LINE_BITMAP,
123 CONTINUATION_LINE_BITMAP,
124 ZV_LINE_BITMAP
125};
126
127/* Bitmap drawn to indicate lines not displaying text if
128 `indicate-empty-lines' is non-nil. */
129
130#define zv_width 8
131#define zv_height 8
132static unsigned char zv_bits[] = {
133 0x00, 0x00, 0x78, 0x78, 0x78, 0x78, 0x00, 0x00};
134
135/* An arrow like this: `<-'. */
136
137#define left_width 8
138#define left_height 8
139static unsigned char left_bits[] = {
140 0x18, 0x30, 0x60, 0xfc, 0xfc, 0x60, 0x30, 0x18};
141
142/* Right truncation arrow bitmap `->'. */
143
144#define right_width 8
145#define right_height 8
146static unsigned char right_bits[] = {
147 0x18, 0x0c, 0x06, 0x3f, 0x3f, 0x06, 0x0c, 0x18};
148
149/* Marker for continued lines. */
150
151#define continued_width 8
152#define continued_height 8
153static unsigned char continued_bits[] = {
154 0x3c, 0x3e, 0x03, 0x27, 0x3f, 0x3e, 0x3c, 0x3e};
155
156/* Marker for continuation lines. */
157
158#define continuation_width 8
159#define continuation_height 8
160static unsigned char continuation_bits[] = {
161 0x3c, 0x7c, 0xc0, 0xe4, 0xfc, 0x7c, 0x3c, 0x7c};
162
163/* Overlay arrow bitmap. */
164
165#if 0
166/* A bomb. */
167#define ov_width 8
168#define ov_height 8
169static unsigned char ov_bits[] = {
170 0x0c, 0x10, 0x3c, 0x7e, 0x5e, 0x5e, 0x46, 0x3c};
171#else
172/* A triangular arrow. */
173#define ov_width 8
174#define ov_height 8
175static unsigned char ov_bits[] = {
176 0xc0, 0xf0, 0xf8, 0xfc, 0xfc, 0xf8, 0xf0, 0xc0};
177#endif
178
179extern Lisp_Object Qhelp_echo;
180
181\f
182/* Non-zero means Emacs uses toolkit scroll bars. */
183
184int x_toolkit_scroll_bars_p;
185
186/* If a string, XTread_socket generates an event to display that string.
187 (The display is done in read_char.) */
188
189static Lisp_Object help_echo;
190static Lisp_Object help_echo_window;
191static Lisp_Object help_echo_object;
192static int help_echo_pos;
193
194/* Temporary variable for XTread_socket. */
195
196static Lisp_Object previous_help_echo;
197
198/* Non-zero means that a HELP_EVENT has been generated since Emacs
199 start. */
200
201static int any_help_event_p;
202
203/* Non-zero means draw block and hollow cursor as wide as the glyph
204 under it. For example, if a block cursor is over a tab, it will be
205 drawn as wide as that tab on the display. */
206
207int x_stretch_cursor_p;
208
209/* This is a chain of structures for all the X displays currently in
210 use. */
211
212struct x_display_info *x_display_list;
213
214/* This is a list of cons cells, each of the form (NAME
215 . FONT-LIST-CACHE), one for each element of x_display_list and in
216 the same order. NAME is the name of the frame. FONT-LIST-CACHE
217 records previous values returned by x-list-fonts. */
218
219Lisp_Object x_display_name_list;
220
221/* This is display since Mac does not support multiple ones. */
222struct mac_display_info one_mac_display_info;
223
224/* Frame being updated by update_frame. This is declared in term.c.
225 This is set by update_begin and looked at by all the XT functions.
226 It is zero while not inside an update. In that case, the XT
227 functions assume that `selected_frame' is the frame to apply to. */
228
229extern struct frame *updating_frame;
230
231extern int waiting_for_input;
232
233/* This is a frame waiting to be auto-raised, within XTread_socket. */
234
235struct frame *pending_autoraise_frame;
236
237/* Nominal cursor position -- where to draw output.
238 HPOS and VPOS are window relative glyph matrix coordinates.
239 X and Y are window relative pixel coordinates. */
240
241struct cursor_pos output_cursor;
242
243/* Non-zero means user is interacting with a toolkit scroll bar. */
244
245static int toolkit_scroll_bar_interaction;
246
247/* Mouse movement.
248
249 Formerly, we used PointerMotionHintMask (in standard_event_mask)
250 so that we would have to call XQueryPointer after each MotionNotify
251 event to ask for another such event. However, this made mouse tracking
252 slow, and there was a bug that made it eventually stop.
253
254 Simply asking for MotionNotify all the time seems to work better.
255
256 In order to avoid asking for motion events and then throwing most
257 of them away or busy-polling the server for mouse positions, we ask
258 the server for pointer motion hints. This means that we get only
259 one event per group of mouse movements. "Groups" are delimited by
260 other kinds of events (focus changes and button clicks, for
261 example), or by XQueryPointer calls; when one of these happens, we
262 get another MotionNotify event the next time the mouse moves. This
263 is at least as efficient as getting motion events when mouse
264 tracking is on, and I suspect only negligibly worse when tracking
265 is off. */
266
267/* Where the mouse was last time we reported a mouse event. */
268
269FRAME_PTR last_mouse_frame;
270static Rect last_mouse_glyph;
271static Lisp_Object last_mouse_press_frame;
272
273/* The scroll bar in which the last X motion event occurred.
274
275 If the last X motion event occurred in a scroll bar, we set this so
276 XTmouse_position can know whether to report a scroll bar motion or
277 an ordinary motion.
278
279 If the last X motion event didn't occur in a scroll bar, we set
280 this to Qnil, to tell XTmouse_position to return an ordinary motion
281 event. */
282
283static Lisp_Object last_mouse_scroll_bar;
284
285/* This is a hack. We would really prefer that XTmouse_position would
286 return the time associated with the position it returns, but there
287 doesn't seem to be any way to wrest the time-stamp from the server
288 along with the position query. So, we just keep track of the time
289 of the last movement we received, and return that in hopes that
290 it's somewhat accurate. */
291
292static Time last_mouse_movement_time;
293
294enum mouse_tracking_type {
295 mouse_tracking_none,
296 mouse_tracking_mouse_movement,
297 mouse_tracking_scroll_bar
298};
299
300enum mouse_tracking_type mouse_tracking_in_progress = mouse_tracking_none;
301
302struct scroll_bar *tracked_scroll_bar = NULL;
303
304/* Incremented by XTread_socket whenever it really tries to read
305 events. */
306
307#ifdef __STDC__
308static int volatile input_signal_count;
309#else
310static int input_signal_count;
311#endif
312
313/* Used locally within XTread_socket. */
314
315static int x_noop_count;
316
317/* Initial values of argv and argc. */
318
319extern char **initial_argv;
320extern int initial_argc;
321
322extern Lisp_Object Vcommand_line_args, Vsystem_name;
323
324/* Tells if a window manager is present or not. */
325
326extern Lisp_Object Vx_no_window_manager;
327
328extern Lisp_Object Qface, Qmouse_face;
329
330extern int errno;
331
332/* A mask of extra modifier bits to put into every keyboard char. */
333
334extern int extra_keyboard_modifiers;
335
336static Lisp_Object Qvendor_specific_keysyms;
337
338#if 0
339extern XrmDatabase x_load_resources P_ ((Display *, char *, char *, char *));
340#endif
341
342extern Lisp_Object x_icon_type P_ ((struct frame *));
343
344
345#if __MRC__
346QDGlobals qd; /* QuickDraw global information structure. */
347#endif
348
349
350/* Enumeration for overriding/changing the face to use for drawing
351 glyphs in x_draw_glyphs. */
352
353enum draw_glyphs_face
354{
355 DRAW_NORMAL_TEXT,
356 DRAW_INVERSE_VIDEO,
357 DRAW_CURSOR,
358 DRAW_MOUSE_FACE,
359 DRAW_IMAGE_RAISED,
360 DRAW_IMAGE_SUNKEN
361};
362
363struct frame * x_window_to_frame (struct mac_display_info *, WindowPtr);
364struct mac_display_info *mac_display_info_for_display (Display *);
365static void x_update_window_end P_ ((struct window *, int, int));
366static void frame_to_window_pixel_xy P_ ((struct window *, int *, int *));
367void x_delete_display P_ ((struct x_display_info *));
368static unsigned int x_mac_to_emacs_modifiers P_ ((struct x_display_info *,
369 unsigned short));
370static int fast_find_position P_ ((struct window *, int, int *, int *,
371 int *, int *));
372static void set_output_cursor P_ ((struct cursor_pos *));
373static struct glyph *x_y_to_hpos_vpos P_ ((struct window *, int, int,
374 int *, int *, int *));
375static void note_mode_line_highlight P_ ((struct window *, int, int));
376static void note_mouse_highlight P_ ((struct frame *, int, int));
377static void note_tool_bar_highlight P_ ((struct frame *f, int, int));
378static void x_handle_tool_bar_click P_ ((struct frame *, XButtonEvent *));
379static void show_mouse_face P_ ((struct x_display_info *,
380 enum draw_glyphs_face));
381void clear_mouse_face P_ ((struct mac_display_info *));
382static int x_io_error_quitter P_ ((Display *));
383int x_catch_errors P_ ((Display *));
384void x_uncatch_errors P_ ((Display *, int));
385void x_lower_frame P_ ((struct frame *));
386void x_scroll_bar_clear P_ ((struct frame *));
387int x_had_errors_p P_ ((Display *));
388void x_wm_set_size_hint P_ ((struct frame *, long, int));
389void x_raise_frame P_ ((struct frame *));
390void x_set_window_size P_ ((struct frame *, int, int, int));
391void x_wm_set_window_state P_ ((struct frame *, int));
392void x_wm_set_icon_pixmap P_ ((struct frame *, int));
393void x_initialize P_ ((void));
394static void x_font_min_bounds P_ ((XFontStruct *, int *, int *));
395static int x_compute_min_glyph_bounds P_ ((struct frame *));
396enum text_cursor_kinds x_specified_cursor_type P_ ((Lisp_Object, int *));
397static void x_draw_phys_cursor_glyph P_ ((struct window *,
398 struct glyph_row *,
399 enum draw_glyphs_face));
400static void x_update_end P_ ((struct frame *));
401static void XTframe_up_to_date P_ ((struct frame *));
402static void XTreassert_line_highlight P_ ((int, int));
403static void x_change_line_highlight P_ ((int, int, int, int));
404static void XTset_terminal_modes P_ ((void));
405static void XTreset_terminal_modes P_ ((void));
406static void XTcursor_to P_ ((int, int, int, int));
407static void x_write_glyphs P_ ((struct glyph *, int));
408static void x_clear_end_of_line P_ ((int));
409static void x_clear_frame P_ ((void));
410static void x_clear_cursor P_ ((struct window *));
411static void frame_highlight P_ ((struct frame *));
412static void frame_unhighlight P_ ((struct frame *));
413static void x_new_focus_frame P_ ((struct x_display_info *, struct frame *));
414static void XTframe_rehighlight P_ ((struct frame *));
415static void x_frame_rehighlight P_ ((struct x_display_info *));
416static void x_draw_hollow_cursor P_ ((struct window *, struct glyph_row *));
417static void x_draw_bar_cursor P_ ((struct window *, struct glyph_row *, int));
418static int x_intersect_rectangles P_ ((Rect *, Rect *, Rect *));
419static void expose_frame P_ ((struct frame *, int, int, int, int));
420static void expose_window_tree P_ ((struct window *, Rect *));
421static void expose_window P_ ((struct window *, Rect *));
422static void expose_area P_ ((struct window *, struct glyph_row *,
423 XRectangle *, enum glyph_row_area));
424static void expose_line P_ ((struct window *, struct glyph_row *,
425 XRectangle *));
426void x_display_cursor (struct window *, int, int, int, int, int);
427void x_update_cursor P_ ((struct frame *, int));
428static void x_update_cursor_in_window_tree P_ ((struct window *, int));
429static void x_update_window_cursor P_ ((struct window *, int));
430static void x_erase_phys_cursor P_ ((struct window *));
431void x_display_and_set_cursor P_ ((struct window *, int, int, int, int, int));
432static void x_draw_bitmap P_ ((struct window *, struct glyph_row *,
433 enum bitmap_type));
434
435static void x_clip_to_row P_ ((struct window *, struct glyph_row *,
436 GC, int));
437static int x_phys_cursor_in_rect_p P_ ((struct window *, Rect *));
438static void x_draw_row_bitmaps P_ ((struct window *, struct glyph_row *));
439static void note_overwritten_text_cursor P_ ((struct window *, int, int));
440static void x_flush P_ ((struct frame *f));
441static void x_update_begin P_ ((struct frame *));
442static void x_update_window_begin P_ ((struct window *));
443static void x_draw_vertical_border P_ ((struct window *));
444static void x_after_update_window_line P_ ((struct glyph_row *));
445static INLINE void take_vertical_position_into_account P_ ((struct it *));
446static void x_produce_stretch_glyph P_ ((struct it *));
447
448static void activate_scroll_bars (FRAME_PTR);
449static void deactivate_scroll_bars (FRAME_PTR);
450
451extern int image_ascent (struct image *, struct face *);
452void x_set_offset (struct frame *, int, int, int);
453int x_bitmap_icon (struct frame *, Lisp_Object);
454void x_make_frame_visible (struct frame *);
455
456extern void window_scroll (Lisp_Object, int, int, int);
457
458/* Defined in macmenu.h. */
459extern void menubar_selection_callback (FRAME_PTR, int);
460extern void set_frame_menubar (FRAME_PTR, int, int);
461
462/* X display function emulation */
463
464/* Structure borrowed from Xlib.h to represent two-byte characters in
465 dumpglyphs. */
466
467typedef struct {
468 unsigned char byte1;
469 unsigned char byte2;
470} XChar2b;
471
472static void
473XFreePixmap (display, pixmap)
474 Display *display;
475 Pixmap pixmap;
476{
477 PixMap *p = (PixMap *) pixmap;
478
479 xfree (p->baseAddr);
480 xfree (p);
481}
482
483
484/* Set foreground color for subsequent QuickDraw commands. Assume
485 graphic port has already been set. */
486
487static void
488mac_set_forecolor (unsigned long color)
489{
490 RGBColor fg_color;
491
492 fg_color.red = RED_FROM_ULONG (color) * 256;
493 fg_color.green = GREEN_FROM_ULONG (color) * 256;
494 fg_color.blue = BLUE_FROM_ULONG (color) * 256;
495
496 RGBForeColor (&fg_color);
497}
498
499
500/* Set background color for subsequent QuickDraw commands. Assume
501 graphic port has already been set. */
502
503static void
504mac_set_backcolor (unsigned long color)
505{
506 RGBColor bg_color;
507
508 bg_color.red = RED_FROM_ULONG (color) * 256;
509 bg_color.green = GREEN_FROM_ULONG (color) * 256;
510 bg_color.blue = BLUE_FROM_ULONG (color) * 256;
511
512 RGBBackColor (&bg_color);
513}
514
515/* Set foreground and background color for subsequent QuickDraw
516 commands. Assume that the graphic port has already been set. */
517
518static void
519mac_set_colors (GC gc)
520{
521 mac_set_forecolor (gc->foreground);
522 mac_set_backcolor (gc->background);
523}
524
525/* Mac version of XDrawLine. */
526
527static void
528XDrawLine (display, w, gc, x1, y1, x2, y2)
529 Display *display;
530 WindowPtr w;
531 GC gc;
532 int x1, y1, x2, y2;
533{
534 SetPort (w);
535 mac_set_colors (gc);
536
537 MoveTo (x1, y1);
538 LineTo (x2, y2);
539}
540
541/* Mac version of XClearArea. */
542
543static void
544XClearArea (display, w, x, y, width, height, exposures)
545 Display *display;
546 WindowPtr w;
547 int x, y;
548 unsigned int width, height;
549 int exposures;
550{
551 struct mac_output *mwp = (mac_output *) GetWRefCon (w);
552 Rect r;
553 XGCValues xgc;
554
555 xgc.foreground = mwp->foreground_pixel;
556 xgc.background = mwp->background_pixel;
557
558 SetPort (w);
559 mac_set_colors (&xgc);
560 SetRect (&r, x, y, x + width, y + height);
561
562 EraseRect (&r);
563}
564
565/* Mac version of XClearWindow. */
566
567static void
568XClearWindow (display, w)
569 Display *display;
570 WindowPtr w;
571{
572 struct mac_output *mwp = (mac_output *) GetWRefCon (w);
573 XGCValues xgc;
574
575 xgc.foreground = mwp->foreground_pixel;
576 xgc.background = mwp->background_pixel;
577
578 SetPort (w);
579 mac_set_colors (&xgc);
580
581 EraseRect (&(w->portRect));
582}
583
584
585/* Mac replacement for XCopyArea. */
586
587static void
588mac_draw_bitmap (display, w, gc, x, y, bitmap)
589 Display *display;
590 WindowPtr w;
591 GC gc;
592 int x, y;
593 BitMap *bitmap;
594{
595 Rect r;
596
597 SetPort (w);
598 mac_set_colors (gc);
599 SetRect (&r, x, y, x + bitmap->bounds.right, y + bitmap->bounds.bottom);
600
601 CopyBits (bitmap, &(w->portBits), &(bitmap->bounds), &r, srcCopy, 0);
602}
603
604
605/* Mac replacement for XSetClipRectangles. */
606
607static void
608mac_set_clip_rectangle (display, w, r)
609 Display *display;
610 WindowPtr w;
611 Rect *r;
612{
613 SetPort (w);
614
615 ClipRect (r);
616}
617
618
619/* Mac replacement for XSetClipMask. */
620
621static void
622mac_reset_clipping (display, w)
623 Display *display;
624 WindowPtr w;
625{
626 Rect r;
627
628 SetPort (w);
629
630 SetRect (&r, -32767, -32767, 32767, 32767);
631 ClipRect (&r);
632}
633
634
635/* Mac replacement for XCreateBitmapFromBitmapData. */
636
637static void
638mac_create_bitmap_from_bitmap_data (bitmap, bits, w, h)
639 BitMap *bitmap;
640 char *bits;
641 int w, h;
642{
643 int bytes_per_row, i, j;
644
645 bitmap->rowBytes = (w + 15) / 16 * 2; /* must be on word boundary */
646 bitmap->baseAddr = xmalloc (bitmap->rowBytes * h);
647 if (!bitmap->baseAddr)
648 abort ();
649
650 bzero (bitmap->baseAddr, bitmap->rowBytes * h);
651 for (i = 0; i < h; i++)
652 for (j = 0; j < w; j++)
653 if (BitTst (bits, i * w + j))
654 BitSet (bitmap->baseAddr, i * bitmap->rowBytes * 8 + j);
655
656 SetRect (&(bitmap->bounds), 0, 0, w, h);
657}
658
659
660static void
661mac_free_bitmap (bitmap)
662 BitMap *bitmap;
663{
664 xfree (bitmap->baseAddr);
665}
666
667/* Mac replacement for XFillRectangle. */
668
669static void
670XFillRectangle (display, w, gc, x, y, width, height)
671 Display *display;
672 WindowPtr w;
673 GC gc;
674 int x, y;
675 unsigned int width, height;
676{
677 Rect r;
678
679 SetPort (w);
680 mac_set_colors (gc);
681 SetRect (&r, x, y, x + width, y + height);
682
683 PaintRect (&r); /* using foreground color of gc */
684}
685
686
687/* Mac replacement for XDrawRectangle: dest is a window. */
688
689static void
690mac_draw_rectangle (display, w, gc, x, y, width, height)
691 Display *display;
692 WindowPtr w;
693 GC gc;
694 int x, y;
695 unsigned int width, height;
696{
697 Rect r;
698
699 SetPort (w);
700 mac_set_colors (gc);
701 SetRect (&r, x, y, x + width + 1, y + height + 1);
702
703 FrameRect (&r); /* using foreground color of gc */
704}
705
706
707/* Mac replacement for XDrawRectangle: dest is a Pixmap. */
708
709static void
710mac_draw_rectangle_to_pixmap (display, p, gc, x, y, width, height)
711 Display *display;
712 Pixmap p;
713 GC gc;
714 int x, y;
715 unsigned int width, height;
716{
717#if 0 /* MAC_TODO: draw a rectangle in a PixMap */
718 Rect r;
719
720 SetPort (w);
721 mac_set_colors (gc);
722 SetRect (&r, x, y, x + width, y + height);
723
724 FrameRect (&r); /* using foreground color of gc */
725#endif
726}
727
728
729static void
730mac_draw_string_common (display, w, gc, x, y, buf, nchars, mode,
731 bytes_per_char)
732 Display *display;
733 WindowPtr w;
734 GC gc;
735 int x, y;
736 char *buf;
737 int nchars, mode, bytes_per_char;
738{
739 SetPort (w);
740 mac_set_colors (gc);
741
742 TextFont (gc->font->mac_fontnum);
743 TextSize (gc->font->mac_fontsize);
744 TextFace (gc->font->mac_fontface);
745 TextMode (mode);
746
747 MoveTo (x, y);
748 DrawText (buf, 0, nchars * bytes_per_char);
749}
750
751
752/* Mac replacement for XDrawString. */
753
754static void
755XDrawString (display, w, gc, x, y, buf, nchars)
756 Display *display;
757 WindowPtr w;
758 GC gc;
759 int x, y;
760 char *buf;
761 int nchars;
762{
763 mac_draw_string_common (display, w, gc, x, y, buf, nchars, srcOr, 1);
764}
765
766
767/* Mac replacement for XDrawString16. */
768
769static void
770XDrawString16 (display, w, gc, x, y, buf, nchars)
771 Display *display;
772 WindowPtr w;
773 GC gc;
774 int x, y;
775 XChar2b *buf;
776 int nchars;
777{
778 mac_draw_string_common (display, w, gc, x, y, (char *) buf, nchars, srcOr,
779 2);
780}
781
782
783/* Mac replacement for XDrawImageString. */
784
785static void
786XDrawImageString (display, w, gc, x, y, buf, nchars)
787 Display *display;
788 WindowPtr w;
789 GC gc;
790 int x, y;
791 char *buf;
792 int nchars;
793{
794 mac_draw_string_common (display, w, gc, x, y, buf, nchars, srcCopy, 1);
795}
796
797
798/* Mac replacement for XDrawString16. */
799
800static void
801XDrawImageString16 (display, w, gc, x, y, buf, nchars)
802 Display *display;
803 WindowPtr w;
804 GC gc;
805 int x, y;
806 XChar2b *buf;
807 int nchars;
808{
809 mac_draw_string_common (display, w, gc, x, y, (char *) buf, nchars, srcCopy,
810 2);
811}
812
813
814/* Mac replacement for XCopyArea: dest must be window. */
815
816static void
817mac_copy_area (display, src, dest, gc, src_x, src_y, width, height, dest_x,
818 dest_y)
819 Display *display;
820 Pixmap src;
821 WindowPtr dest;
822 GC gc;
823 int src_x, src_y;
824 unsigned int width, height;
825 int dest_x, dest_y;
826{
827 Rect src_r, dest_r;
828
829 SetPort (dest);
830 mac_set_colors (gc);
831
832 SetRect (&src_r, src_x, src_y, src_x + width, src_y + height);
833 SetRect (&dest_r, dest_x, dest_y, dest_x + width, dest_y + height);
834
835 CopyBits ((BitMap *) src, &(dest->portBits), &src_r, &dest_r, srcCopy, 0);
836}
837
838
839/* Convert a pair of local coordinates to global (screen) coordinates.
840 Assume graphic port has been properly set. */
841static void
842local_to_global_coord (short *h, short *v)
843{
844 Point p;
845
846 p.h = *h;
847 p.v = *v;
848
849 LocalToGlobal (&p);
850
851 *h = p.h;
852 *v = p.v;
853}
854
855
856/* Mac replacement for XCopyArea: used only for scrolling. */
857
858static void
859mac_scroll_area (display, w, gc, src_x, src_y, width, height, dest_x, dest_y)
860 Display *display;
861 WindowPtr w;
862 GC gc;
863 int src_x, src_y;
864 unsigned int width, height;
865 int dest_x, dest_y;
866{
867 Rect src_r, dest_r;
868
869 SetPort (w);
870 mac_set_colors (gc);
871
872 SetRect (&src_r, src_x, src_y, src_x + width, src_y + height);
873 SetRect (&dest_r, dest_x, dest_y, dest_x + width, dest_y + height);
874
875 /* Need to use global coordinates and screenBits since src and dest
876 areas overlap in general. */
877 local_to_global_coord (&src_r.left, &src_r.top);
878 local_to_global_coord (&src_r.right, &src_r.bottom);
879 local_to_global_coord (&dest_r.left, &dest_r.top);
880 local_to_global_coord (&dest_r.right, &dest_r.bottom);
881
882 CopyBits (&qd.screenBits, &qd.screenBits, &src_r, &dest_r, srcCopy, 0);
883}
884
885
886/* Mac replacement for XCopyArea: dest must be Pixmap. */
887
888static void
889mac_copy_area_to_pixmap (display, src, dest, gc, src_x, src_y, width, height,
890 dest_x, dest_y)
891 Display *display;
892 Pixmap src;
893 Pixmap dest;
894 GC gc;
895 int src_x, src_y;
896 unsigned int width, height;
897 int dest_x, dest_y;
898{
899 Rect src_r, dest_r;
900 int src_right = ((PixMap *) src)->bounds.right;
901 int src_bottom = ((PixMap *) src)->bounds.bottom;
902 int w = src_right - src_x;
903 int h = src_bottom - src_y;
904
905 mac_set_colors (gc);
906
907 SetRect (&src_r, src_x, src_y, src_right, src_bottom);
908 SetRect (&dest_r, dest_x, dest_y, dest_x + w, dest_y + h);
909
910 CopyBits ((BitMap *) src, (BitMap *) dest, &src_r, &dest_r, srcCopy, 0);
911}
912
913
914/* Mac replacement for XChangeGC. */
915
916static void
917XChangeGC (void * ignore, XGCValues* gc, unsigned long mask,
918 XGCValues *xgcv)
919{
920 if (mask & GCForeground)
921 gc->foreground = xgcv->foreground;
922 if (mask & GCBackground)
923 gc->background = xgcv->background;
924 if (mask & GCFont)
925 gc->font = xgcv->font;
926}
927
928
929/* Mac replacement for XCreateGC. */
930
931XGCValues *
932XCreateGC (void * ignore, Window window, unsigned long mask,
933 XGCValues *xgcv)
934{
935 XGCValues *gc = (XGCValues *) xmalloc (sizeof (XGCValues));
936 bzero (gc, sizeof (XGCValues));
937
938 XChangeGC (ignore, gc, mask, xgcv);
939
940 return gc;
941}
942
943
944/* Used in xfaces.c. */
945
946void
947XFreeGC (display, gc)
948 Display *display;
949 GC gc;
950{
951 xfree (gc);
952}
953
954
955/* Mac replacement for XGetGCValues. */
956
957static void
958XGetGCValues (void* ignore, XGCValues *gc,
959 unsigned long mask, XGCValues *xgcv)
960{
961 XChangeGC (ignore, xgcv, mask, gc);
962}
963
964
965/* Mac replacement for XSetForeground. */
966
967static void
968XSetForeground (display, gc, color)
969 Display *display;
970 GC gc;
971 unsigned long color;
972{
973 gc->foreground = color;
974}
975
976
977/* Mac replacement for XSetFont. */
978
979static void
980XSetFont (display, gc, font)
981 Display *display;
982 GC gc;
983 XFontStruct *font;
984{
985 gc->font = font;
986}
987
988
989static void
990XTextExtents16 (XFontStruct *font, XChar2b *text, int nchars,
991 int *direction,int *font_ascent,
992 int *font_descent, XCharStruct *cs)
993{
994 /* MAC_TODO: Use GetTextMetrics to do this and inline it below. */
995}
996
997
998/* x_sync is a no-op on Mac. */
999void
1000x_sync (f)
1001 void *f;
1002{
1003}
1004
1005
1006/* Flush display of frame F, or of all frames if F is null. */
1007
1008void
1009x_flush (f)
1010 struct frame *f;
1011{
1012#if 0 /* Nothing to do for Mac OS (needed in OS X perhaps?). */
1013 BLOCK_INPUT;
1014 if (f == NULL)
1015 {
1016 Lisp_Object rest, frame;
1017 FOR_EACH_FRAME (rest, frame)
1018 x_flush (XFRAME (frame));
1019 }
1020 else if (FRAME_X_P (f))
1021 XFlush (FRAME_MAC_DISPLAY (f));
1022 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
1023#endif
1024}
1025
1026
1027/* Remove calls to XFlush by defining XFlush to an empty replacement.
1028 Calls to XFlush should be unnecessary because the X output buffer
1029 is flushed automatically as needed by calls to XPending,
1030 XNextEvent, or XWindowEvent according to the XFlush man page.
1031 XTread_socket calls XPending. Removing XFlush improves
1032 performance. */
1033
1034#define XFlush(DISPLAY) (void) 0
1035
1036\f
1037/* Return the struct mac_display_info corresponding to DPY. There's
1038 only one. */
1039
1040struct mac_display_info *
1041mac_display_info_for_display (dpy)
1042 Display *dpy;
1043{
1044 return &one_mac_display_info;
1045}
1046
1047
1048\f
1049/***********************************************************************
1050 Starting and ending an update
1051 ***********************************************************************/
1052
1053/* Start an update of frame F. This function is installed as a hook
1054 for update_begin, i.e. it is called when update_begin is called.
1055 This function is called prior to calls to x_update_window_begin for
1056 each window being updated. Currently, there is nothing to do here
1057 because all interesting stuff is done on a window basis. */
1058
1059void
1060x_update_begin (f)
1061 struct frame *f;
1062{
1063 /* Nothing to do. */
1064}
1065
1066
1067/* Start update of window W. Set the global variable updated_window
1068 to the window being updated and set output_cursor to the cursor
1069 position of W. */
1070
1071void
1072x_update_window_begin (w)
1073 struct window *w;
1074{
1075 struct frame *f = XFRAME (WINDOW_FRAME (w));
1076 struct mac_display_info *display_info = FRAME_MAC_DISPLAY_INFO (f);
1077
1078 updated_window = w;
1079 set_output_cursor (&w->cursor);
1080
1081 BLOCK_INPUT;
1082
1083 if (f == display_info->mouse_face_mouse_frame)
1084 {
1085 /* Don't do highlighting for mouse motion during the update. */
1086 display_info->mouse_face_defer = 1;
1087
1088 /* If F needs to be redrawn, simply forget about any prior mouse
1089 highlighting. */
1090 if (FRAME_GARBAGED_P (f))
1091 display_info->mouse_face_window = Qnil;
1092
1093#if 0 /* Rows in a current matrix containing glyphs in mouse-face have
1094 their mouse_face_p flag set, which means that they are always
1095 unequal to rows in a desired matrix which never have that
1096 flag set. So, rows containing mouse-face glyphs are never
1097 scrolled, and we don't have to switch the mouse highlight off
1098 here to prevent it from being scrolled. */
1099
1100 /* Can we tell that this update does not affect the window
1101 where the mouse highlight is? If so, no need to turn off.
1102 Likewise, don't do anything if the frame is garbaged;
1103 in that case, the frame's current matrix that we would use
1104 is all wrong, and we will redisplay that line anyway. */
1105 if (!NILP (display_info->mouse_face_window)
1106 && w == XWINDOW (display_info->mouse_face_window))
1107 {
1108 int i;
1109
1110 for (i = 0; i < w->desired_matrix->nrows; ++i)
1111 if (MATRIX_ROW_ENABLED_P (w->desired_matrix, i))
1112 break;
1113
1114 if (i < w->desired_matrix->nrows)
1115 clear_mouse_face (display_info);
1116 }
1117#endif /* 0 */
1118 }
1119
1120 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
1121}
1122
1123
1124/* Draw a vertical window border to the right of window W if W doesn't
1125 have vertical scroll bars. */
1126
1127static void
1128x_draw_vertical_border (w)
1129 struct window *w;
1130{
1131 struct frame *f = XFRAME (WINDOW_FRAME (w));
1132
1133 /* Redraw borders between horizontally adjacent windows. Don't
1134 do it for frames with vertical scroll bars because either the
1135 right scroll bar of a window, or the left scroll bar of its
1136 neighbor will suffice as a border. */
1137 if (!WINDOW_RIGHTMOST_P (w)
1138 && !FRAME_HAS_VERTICAL_SCROLL_BARS (f))
1139 {
1140 int x0, x1, y0, y1;
1141
1142 window_box_edges (w, -1, &x0, &y0, &x1, &y1);
1143 x1 += FRAME_X_RIGHT_FLAGS_AREA_WIDTH (f);
1144 y1 -= 1;
1145
1146 XDrawLine (FRAME_MAC_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_MAC_WINDOW (f),
1147 f->output_data.mac->normal_gc, x1, y0, x1, y1);
1148 }
1149}
1150
1151
1152/* End update of window W (which is equal to updated_window).
1153
1154 Draw vertical borders between horizontally adjacent windows, and
1155 display W's cursor if CURSOR_ON_P is non-zero.
1156
1157 MOUSE_FACE_OVERWRITTEN_P non-zero means that some row containing
1158 glyphs in mouse-face were overwritten. In that case we have to
1159 make sure that the mouse-highlight is properly redrawn.
1160
1161 W may be a menu bar pseudo-window in case we don't have X toolkit
1162 support. Such windows don't have a cursor, so don't display it
1163 here. */
1164
1165void
1166x_update_window_end (w, cursor_on_p, mouse_face_overwritten_p)
1167 struct window *w;
1168 int cursor_on_p, mouse_face_overwritten_p;
1169{
1170 if (!w->pseudo_window_p)
1171 {
1172 struct mac_display_info *dpyinfo
1173 = FRAME_MAC_DISPLAY_INFO (XFRAME (w->frame));
1174
1175 BLOCK_INPUT;
1176
1177 /* If a row with mouse-face was overwritten, arrange for
1178 XTframe_up_to_date to redisplay the mouse highlight. */
1179 if (mouse_face_overwritten_p)
1180 {
1181 dpyinfo->mouse_face_beg_row = dpyinfo->mouse_face_beg_col = -1;
1182 dpyinfo->mouse_face_end_row = dpyinfo->mouse_face_end_col = -1;
1183 dpyinfo->mouse_face_window = Qnil;
1184 }
1185
1186 if (cursor_on_p)
1187 x_display_and_set_cursor (w, 1, output_cursor.hpos,
1188 output_cursor.vpos,
1189 output_cursor.x, output_cursor.y);
1190
1191 x_draw_vertical_border (w);
1192 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
1193 }
1194
1195 updated_window = NULL;
1196}
1197
1198
1199/* End update of frame F. This function is installed as a hook in
1200 update_end. */
1201
1202void
1203x_update_end (f)
1204 struct frame *f;
1205{
1206 /* Reset the background color of Mac OS Window to that of the frame after
1207 update so that it is used by Mac Toolbox to clear the update region before
1208 an update event is generated. */
1209 SetPort (FRAME_MAC_WINDOW (f));
1210 mac_set_backcolor (FRAME_BACKGROUND_PIXEL (f));
1211
1212 /* Mouse highlight may be displayed again. */
1213 FRAME_MAC_DISPLAY_INFO (f)->mouse_face_defer = 0;
1214
1215 BLOCK_INPUT;
1216 XFlush (FRAME_MAC_DISPLAY (f));
1217 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
1218}
1219
1220
1221/* This function is called from various places in xdisp.c whenever a
1222 complete update has been performed. The global variable
1223 updated_window is not available here. */
1224
1225void
1226XTframe_up_to_date (f)
1227 struct frame *f;
1228{
1229 if (FRAME_X_P (f))
1230 {
1231 struct mac_display_info *dpyinfo = FRAME_MAC_DISPLAY_INFO (f);
1232
1233 if (dpyinfo->mouse_face_deferred_gc
1234 || f == dpyinfo->mouse_face_mouse_frame)
1235 {
1236 BLOCK_INPUT;
1237 if (dpyinfo->mouse_face_mouse_frame)
1238 note_mouse_highlight (dpyinfo->mouse_face_mouse_frame,
1239 dpyinfo->mouse_face_mouse_x,
1240 dpyinfo->mouse_face_mouse_y);
1241 dpyinfo->mouse_face_deferred_gc = 0;
1242 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
1243 }
1244 }
1245}
1246
1247
1248/* Draw truncation mark bitmaps, continuation mark bitmaps, overlay
1249 arrow bitmaps, or clear the areas where they would be displayed
1250 before DESIRED_ROW is made current. The window being updated is
1251 found in updated_window. This function It is called from
1252 update_window_line only if it is known that there are differences
1253 between bitmaps to be drawn between current row and DESIRED_ROW. */
1254
1255void
1256x_after_update_window_line (desired_row)
1257 struct glyph_row *desired_row;
1258{
1259 struct window *w = updated_window;
1260
1261 xassert (w);
1262
1263 if (!desired_row->mode_line_p && !w->pseudo_window_p)
1264 {
1265 BLOCK_INPUT;
1266 x_draw_row_bitmaps (w, desired_row);
1267
1268 /* When a window has disappeared, make sure that no rest of
1269 full-width rows stays visible in the internal border. */
1270 if (windows_or_buffers_changed)
1271 {
1272 struct frame *f = XFRAME (w->frame);
1273 int width = FRAME_INTERNAL_BORDER_WIDTH (f);
1274 int height = desired_row->visible_height;
1275 int x = (window_box_right (w, -1)
1276 + FRAME_X_RIGHT_FLAGS_AREA_WIDTH (f));
1277 int y = WINDOW_TO_FRAME_PIXEL_Y (w, max (0, desired_row->y));
1278
1279 XClearArea (FRAME_MAC_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_MAC_WINDOW (f),
1280 x, y, width, height, 0);
1281 }
1282
1283 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
1284 }
1285}
1286
1287
1288/* Draw the bitmap WHICH in one of the areas to the left or right of
1289 window W. ROW is the glyph row for which to display the bitmap; it
1290 determines the vertical position at which the bitmap has to be
1291 drawn. */
1292
1293static void
1294x_draw_bitmap (w, row, which)
1295 struct window *w;
1296 struct glyph_row *row;
1297 enum bitmap_type which;
1298{
1299 struct frame *f = XFRAME (WINDOW_FRAME (w));
1300 Display *display = FRAME_MAC_DISPLAY (f);
1301 WindowPtr window = FRAME_MAC_WINDOW (f);
1302 int x, y, wd, h, dy;
1303 unsigned char *bits;
1304 BitMap bitmap;
1305 XGCValues gcv;
1306 struct face *face;
1307
1308 /* Must clip because of partially visible lines. */
1309 x_clip_to_row (w, row, 1);
1310
1311 switch (which)
1312 {
1313 case LEFT_TRUNCATION_BITMAP:
1314 wd = left_width;
1315 h = left_height;
1316 bits = left_bits;
1317 x = (WINDOW_TO_FRAME_PIXEL_X (w, 0)
1318 - wd
1319 - (FRAME_X_LEFT_FLAGS_AREA_WIDTH (f) - wd) / 2);
1320 break;
1321
1322 case OVERLAY_ARROW_BITMAP:
1323 wd = left_width;
1324 h = left_height;
1325 bits = ov_bits;
1326 x = (WINDOW_TO_FRAME_PIXEL_X (w, 0)
1327 - wd
1328 - (FRAME_X_LEFT_FLAGS_AREA_WIDTH (f) - wd) / 2);
1329 break;
1330
1331 case RIGHT_TRUNCATION_BITMAP:
1332 wd = right_width;
1333 h = right_height;
1334 bits = right_bits;
1335 x = window_box_right (w, -1);
1336 x += (FRAME_X_RIGHT_FLAGS_AREA_WIDTH (f) - wd) / 2;
1337 break;
1338
1339 case CONTINUED_LINE_BITMAP:
1340 wd = right_width;
1341 h = right_height;
1342 bits = continued_bits;
1343 x = window_box_right (w, -1);
1344 x += (FRAME_X_RIGHT_FLAGS_AREA_WIDTH (f) - wd) / 2;
1345 break;
1346
1347 case CONTINUATION_LINE_BITMAP:
1348 wd = continuation_width;
1349 h = continuation_height;
1350 bits = continuation_bits;
1351 x = (WINDOW_TO_FRAME_PIXEL_X (w, 0)
1352 - wd
1353 - (FRAME_X_LEFT_FLAGS_AREA_WIDTH (f) - wd) / 2);
1354 break;
1355
1356 case ZV_LINE_BITMAP:
1357 wd = zv_width;
1358 h = zv_height;
1359 bits = zv_bits;
1360 x = (WINDOW_TO_FRAME_PIXEL_X (w, 0)
1361 - wd
1362 - (FRAME_X_LEFT_FLAGS_AREA_WIDTH (f) - wd) / 2);
1363 break;
1364
1365 default:
1366 abort ();
1367 }
1368
1369 /* Convert to frame coordinates. Set dy to the offset in the row to
1370 start drawing the bitmap. */
1371 y = WINDOW_TO_FRAME_PIXEL_Y (w, row->y);
1372 dy = (row->height - h) / 2;
1373
1374 /* Draw the bitmap. I believe these small pixmaps can be cached
1375 by the server. */
1376 face = FACE_FROM_ID (f, BITMAP_AREA_FACE_ID);
1377
1378 mac_create_bitmap_from_bitmap_data (&bitmap, bits, wd, h);
1379 gcv.foreground = face->foreground;
1380 gcv.background = face->background;
1381
1382 mac_draw_bitmap (display, window, &gcv, x, y + dy, &bitmap);
1383
1384 mac_free_bitmap (&bitmap);
1385 mac_reset_clipping (display, window);
1386}
1387
1388
1389/* Draw flags bitmaps for glyph row ROW on window W. Call this
1390 function with input blocked. */
1391
1392static void
1393x_draw_row_bitmaps (w, row)
1394 struct window *w;
1395 struct glyph_row *row;
1396{
1397 struct frame *f = XFRAME (w->frame);
1398 enum bitmap_type bitmap;
1399 struct face *face;
1400 int header_line_height = -1;
1401
1402 xassert (interrupt_input_blocked);
1403
1404 /* If row is completely invisible, because of vscrolling, we
1405 don't have to draw anything. */
1406 if (row->visible_height <= 0)
1407 return;
1408
1409 face = FACE_FROM_ID (f, BITMAP_AREA_FACE_ID);
1410 PREPARE_FACE_FOR_DISPLAY (f, face);
1411
1412 /* Decide which bitmap to draw at the left side. */
1413 if (row->overlay_arrow_p)
1414 bitmap = OVERLAY_ARROW_BITMAP;
1415 else if (row->truncated_on_left_p)
1416 bitmap = LEFT_TRUNCATION_BITMAP;
1417 else if (MATRIX_ROW_CONTINUATION_LINE_P (row))
1418 bitmap = CONTINUATION_LINE_BITMAP;
1419 else if (row->indicate_empty_line_p)
1420 bitmap = ZV_LINE_BITMAP;
1421 else
1422 bitmap = NO_BITMAP;
1423
1424 /* Clear flags area if no bitmap to draw or if bitmap doesn't fill
1425 the flags area. */
1426 if (bitmap == NO_BITMAP
1427 || FRAME_FLAGS_BITMAP_WIDTH (f) < FRAME_X_LEFT_FLAGS_AREA_WIDTH (f)
1428 || row->height > FRAME_FLAGS_BITMAP_HEIGHT (f))
1429 {
1430 /* If W has a vertical border to its left, don't draw over it. */
1431 int border = ((XFASTINT (w->left) > 0
1432 && !FRAME_HAS_VERTICAL_SCROLL_BARS (f))
1433 ? 1 : 0);
1434 int left = window_box_left (w, -1);
1435
1436 if (header_line_height < 0)
1437 header_line_height = WINDOW_DISPLAY_HEADER_LINE_HEIGHT (w);
1438
1439#if 0 /* MAC_TODO: stipple */
1440 /* In case the same realized face is used for bitmap areas and
1441 for something displayed in the text (e.g. face `region' on
1442 mono-displays, the fill style may have been changed to
1443 FillSolid in x_draw_glyph_string_background. */
1444 if (face->stipple)
1445 XSetFillStyle (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), face->gc, FillOpaqueStippled);
1446 else
1447 XSetForeground (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), face->gc, face->background);
1448
1449 XFillRectangle (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_X_WINDOW (f),
1450 face->gc,
1451 (left
1452 - FRAME_X_LEFT_FLAGS_AREA_WIDTH (f)
1453 + border),
1454 WINDOW_TO_FRAME_PIXEL_Y (w, max (header_line_height,
1455 row->y)),
1456 FRAME_X_LEFT_FLAGS_AREA_WIDTH (f) - border,
1457 row->visible_height);
1458 if (!face->stipple)
1459 XSetForeground (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), face->gc, face->foreground);
1460#endif
1461 {
1462 XGCValues gcv;
1463 gcv.foreground = face->background;
1464 XFillRectangle (FRAME_MAC_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_MAC_WINDOW (f),
1465 &gcv,
1466 (left
1467 - FRAME_X_LEFT_FLAGS_AREA_WIDTH (f)
1468 + border),
1469 WINDOW_TO_FRAME_PIXEL_Y (w, max (header_line_height,
1470 row->y)),
1471 FRAME_X_LEFT_FLAGS_AREA_WIDTH (f) - border,
1472 row->visible_height);
1473 }
1474
1475 }
1476
1477 /* Draw the left bitmap. */
1478 if (bitmap != NO_BITMAP)
1479 x_draw_bitmap (w, row, bitmap);
1480
1481 /* Decide which bitmap to draw at the right side. */
1482 if (row->truncated_on_right_p)
1483 bitmap = RIGHT_TRUNCATION_BITMAP;
1484 else if (row->continued_p)
1485 bitmap = CONTINUED_LINE_BITMAP;
1486 else
1487 bitmap = NO_BITMAP;
1488
1489 /* Clear flags area if no bitmap to draw of if bitmap doesn't fill
1490 the flags area. */
1491 if (bitmap == NO_BITMAP
1492 || FRAME_FLAGS_BITMAP_WIDTH (f) < FRAME_X_RIGHT_FLAGS_AREA_WIDTH (f)
1493 || row->height > FRAME_FLAGS_BITMAP_HEIGHT (f))
1494 {
1495 int right = window_box_right (w, -1);
1496
1497 if (header_line_height < 0)
1498 header_line_height = WINDOW_DISPLAY_HEADER_LINE_HEIGHT (w);
1499
1500#if 0 /* MAC_TODO: stipple */
1501 /* In case the same realized face is used for bitmap areas and
1502 for something displayed in the text (e.g. face `region' on
1503 mono-displays, the fill style may have been changed to
1504 FillSolid in x_draw_glyph_string_background. */
1505 if (face->stipple)
1506 XSetFillStyle (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), face->gc, FillOpaqueStippled);
1507 else
1508 XSetForeground (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), face->gc, face->background);
1509 XFillRectangle (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_X_WINDOW (f),
1510 face->gc,
1511 right,
1512 WINDOW_TO_FRAME_PIXEL_Y (w, max (header_line_height,
1513 row->y)),
1514 FRAME_X_RIGHT_FLAGS_AREA_WIDTH (f),
1515 row->visible_height);
1516 if (!face->stipple)
1517 XSetForeground (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), face->gc, face->foreground);
1518#endif
1519 {
1520 XGCValues gcv;
1521 gcv.foreground = face->background;
1522 XFillRectangle (FRAME_MAC_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_MAC_WINDOW (f),
1523 &gcv,
1524 right,
1525 WINDOW_TO_FRAME_PIXEL_Y (w, max (header_line_height,
1526 row->y)),
1527 FRAME_X_RIGHT_FLAGS_AREA_WIDTH (f),
1528 row->visible_height);
1529 }
1530
1531 }
1532
1533 /* Draw the right bitmap. */
1534 if (bitmap != NO_BITMAP)
1535 x_draw_bitmap (w, row, bitmap);
1536}
1537
1538\f
1539/***********************************************************************
1540 Line Highlighting
1541 ***********************************************************************/
1542
1543/* External interface to control of standout mode. Not used for X
1544 frames. Aborts when called. */
1545
1546void
1547XTreassert_line_highlight (new, vpos)
1548 int new, vpos;
1549{
1550 abort ();
1551}
1552
1553
1554/* Call this when about to modify line at position VPOS and change
1555 whether it is highlighted. Not used for X frames. Aborts when
1556 called. */
1557
1558void
1559x_change_line_highlight (new_highlight, vpos, y, first_unused_hpos)
1560 int new_highlight, vpos, y, first_unused_hpos;
1561{
1562 abort ();
1563}
1564
1565
1566/* This is called when starting Emacs and when restarting after
1567 suspend. When starting Emacs, no X window is mapped. And nothing
1568 must be done to Emacs's own window if it is suspended (though that
1569 rarely happens). */
1570
1571void
1572XTset_terminal_modes ()
1573{
1574}
1575
1576/* This is called when exiting or suspending Emacs. Exiting will make
1577 the X-windows go away, and suspending requires no action. */
1578
1579void
1580XTreset_terminal_modes ()
1581{
1582}
1583
1584
1585\f
1586/***********************************************************************
1587 Output Cursor
1588 ***********************************************************************/
1589
1590/* Set the global variable output_cursor to CURSOR. All cursor
1591 positions are relative to updated_window. */
1592
1593static void
1594set_output_cursor (cursor)
1595 struct cursor_pos *cursor;
1596{
1597 output_cursor.hpos = cursor->hpos;
1598 output_cursor.vpos = cursor->vpos;
1599 output_cursor.x = cursor->x;
1600 output_cursor.y = cursor->y;
1601}
1602
1603
1604/* Set a nominal cursor position.
1605
1606 HPOS and VPOS are column/row positions in a window glyph matrix. X
1607 and Y are window text area relative pixel positions.
1608
1609 If this is done during an update, updated_window will contain the
1610 window that is being updated and the position is the future output
1611 cursor position for that window. If updated_window is null, use
1612 selected_window and display the cursor at the given position. */
1613
1614void
1615XTcursor_to (vpos, hpos, y, x)
1616 int vpos, hpos, y, x;
1617{
1618 struct window *w;
1619
1620 /* If updated_window is not set, work on selected_window. */
1621 if (updated_window)
1622 w = updated_window;
1623 else
1624 w = XWINDOW (selected_window);
1625
1626 /* Set the output cursor. */
1627 output_cursor.hpos = hpos;
1628 output_cursor.vpos = vpos;
1629 output_cursor.x = x;
1630 output_cursor.y = y;
1631
1632 /* If not called as part of an update, really display the cursor.
1633 This will also set the cursor position of W. */
1634 if (updated_window == NULL)
1635 {
1636 BLOCK_INPUT;
1637 x_display_cursor (w, 1, hpos, vpos, x, y);
1638 XFlush (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (SELECTED_FRAME ()));
1639 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
1640 }
1641}
1642
1643
1644\f
1645/***********************************************************************
1646 Display Iterator
1647 ***********************************************************************/
1648
1649/* Function prototypes of this page. */
1650
1651static struct face *x_get_glyph_face_and_encoding P_ ((struct frame *,
1652 struct glyph *,
1653 XChar2b *,
1654 int *));
1655static struct face *x_get_char_face_and_encoding P_ ((struct frame *, int,
1656 int, XChar2b *, int));
1657static XCharStruct *x_per_char_metric P_ ((XFontStruct *, XChar2b *));
1658static void x_encode_char P_ ((int, XChar2b *, struct font_info *));
1659static void x_append_glyph P_ ((struct it *));
1660static void x_append_composite_glyph P_ ((struct it *));
1661static void x_append_stretch_glyph P_ ((struct it *it, Lisp_Object,
1662 int, int, double));
1663static void x_produce_glyphs P_ ((struct it *));
1664static void x_produce_image_glyph P_ ((struct it *it));
1665
1666
1667/* Return a pointer to per-char metric information in FONT of a
1668 character pointed by B which is a pointer to an XChar2b. */
1669
1670#define PER_CHAR_METRIC(font, b) \
1671 ((font)->per_char \
1672 ? ((font)->per_char + (b)->byte2 - (font)->min_char_or_byte2 \
1673 + (((font)->min_byte1 || (font)->max_byte1) \
1674 ? (((b)->byte1 - (font)->min_byte1) \
1675 * ((font)->max_char_or_byte2 - (font)->min_char_or_byte2 + 1)) \
1676 : 0)) \
1677 : &((font)->max_bounds))
1678
1679
1680/* Get metrics of character CHAR2B in FONT. Value is null if CHAR2B
1681 is not contained in the font. */
1682
1683static INLINE XCharStruct *
1684x_per_char_metric (font, char2b)
1685 XFontStruct *font;
1686 XChar2b *char2b;
1687{
1688 /* The result metric information. */
1689 XCharStruct *pcm = NULL;
1690
1691 xassert (font && char2b);
1692
1693 if (font->per_char != NULL)
1694 {
1695 if (font->min_byte1 == 0 && font->max_byte1 == 0)
1696 {
1697 /* min_char_or_byte2 specifies the linear character index
1698 corresponding to the first element of the per_char array,
1699 max_char_or_byte2 is the index of the last character. A
1700 character with non-zero CHAR2B->byte1 is not in the font.
1701 A character with byte2 less than min_char_or_byte2 or
1702 greater max_char_or_byte2 is not in the font. */
1703 if (char2b->byte1 == 0
1704 && char2b->byte2 >= font->min_char_or_byte2
1705 && char2b->byte2 <= font->max_char_or_byte2)
1706 pcm = font->per_char + char2b->byte2 - font->min_char_or_byte2;
1707 }
1708 else
1709 {
1710 /* If either min_byte1 or max_byte1 are nonzero, both
1711 min_char_or_byte2 and max_char_or_byte2 are less than
1712 256, and the 2-byte character index values corresponding
1713 to the per_char array element N (counting from 0) are:
1714
1715 byte1 = N/D + min_byte1
1716 byte2 = N\D + min_char_or_byte2
1717
1718 where:
1719
1720 D = max_char_or_byte2 - min_char_or_byte2 + 1
1721 / = integer division
1722 \ = integer modulus */
1723 if (char2b->byte1 >= font->min_byte1
1724 && char2b->byte1 <= font->max_byte1
1725 && char2b->byte2 >= font->min_char_or_byte2
1726 && char2b->byte2 <= font->max_char_or_byte2)
1727 {
1728 pcm = (font->per_char
1729 + ((font->max_char_or_byte2 - font->min_char_or_byte2 + 1)
1730 * (char2b->byte1 - font->min_byte1))
1731 + (char2b->byte2 - font->min_char_or_byte2));
1732 }
1733 }
1734 }
1735 else
1736 {
1737 /* If the per_char pointer is null, all glyphs between the first
1738 and last character indexes inclusive have the same
1739 information, as given by both min_bounds and max_bounds. */
1740 if (char2b->byte2 >= font->min_char_or_byte2
1741 && char2b->byte2 <= font->max_char_or_byte2)
1742 pcm = &font->max_bounds;
1743 }
1744
1745 return ((pcm == NULL
1746 || (pcm->width == 0 && (pcm->rbearing - pcm->lbearing) == 0))
1747 ? NULL : pcm);
1748}
1749
1750
1751/* Encode CHAR2B using encoding information from FONT_INFO. CHAR2B is
1752 the two-byte form of C. Encoding is returned in *CHAR2B. */
1753
1754static INLINE void
1755x_encode_char (c, char2b, font_info)
1756 int c;
1757 XChar2b *char2b;
1758 struct font_info *font_info;
1759{
1760 int charset = CHAR_CHARSET (c);
1761 XFontStruct *font = font_info->font;
1762
1763 /* FONT_INFO may define a scheme by which to encode byte1 and byte2.
1764 This may be either a program in a special encoder language or a
1765 fixed encoding. */
1766 if (font_info->font_encoder)
1767 {
1768 /* It's a program. */
1769 struct ccl_program *ccl = font_info->font_encoder;
1770
1771 if (CHARSET_DIMENSION (charset) == 1)
1772 {
1773 ccl->reg[0] = charset;
1774 ccl->reg[1] = char2b->byte2;
1775 }
1776 else
1777 {
1778 ccl->reg[0] = charset;
1779 ccl->reg[1] = char2b->byte1;
1780 ccl->reg[2] = char2b->byte2;
1781 }
1782
1783 ccl_driver (ccl, NULL, NULL, 0, 0, NULL);
1784
1785 /* We assume that MSBs are appropriately set/reset by CCL
1786 program. */
1787 if (font->max_byte1 == 0) /* 1-byte font */
1788 char2b->byte1 = 0, char2b->byte2 = ccl->reg[1];
1789 else
1790 char2b->byte1 = ccl->reg[1], char2b->byte2 = ccl->reg[2];
1791 }
1792 else if (font_info->encoding[charset])
1793 {
1794 /* Fixed encoding scheme. See fontset.h for the meaning of the
1795 encoding numbers. */
1796 int enc = font_info->encoding[charset];
1797
1798 if ((enc == 1 || enc == 2)
1799 && CHARSET_DIMENSION (charset) == 2)
1800 char2b->byte1 |= 0x80;
1801
1802 if (enc == 1 || enc == 3)
1803 char2b->byte2 |= 0x80;
1804
1805 if (enc == 4)
1806 {
1807 int sjis1, sjis2;
1808
1809 ENCODE_SJIS (char2b->byte1, char2b->byte2, sjis1, sjis2);
1810 char2b->byte1 = sjis1;
1811 char2b->byte2 = sjis2;
1812 }
1813 }
1814}
1815
1816
1817/* Get face and two-byte form of character C in face FACE_ID on frame
1818 F. The encoding of C is returned in *CHAR2B. MULTIBYTE_P non-zero
1819 means we want to display multibyte text. Value is a pointer to a
1820 realized face that is ready for display. */
1821
1822static INLINE struct face *
1823x_get_char_face_and_encoding (f, c, face_id, char2b, multibyte_p)
1824 struct frame *f;
1825 int c, face_id;
1826 XChar2b *char2b;
1827 int multibyte_p;
1828{
1829 struct face *face = FACE_FROM_ID (f, face_id);
1830
1831 if (!multibyte_p)
1832 {
1833 /* Unibyte case. We don't have to encode, but we have to make
1834 sure to use a face suitable for unibyte. */
1835 char2b->byte1 = 0;
1836 char2b->byte2 = c;
1837 face_id = FACE_FOR_CHAR (f, face, c);
1838 face = FACE_FROM_ID (f, face_id);
1839 }
1840 else if (c < 128 && face_id < BASIC_FACE_ID_SENTINEL)
1841 {
1842 /* Case of ASCII in a face known to fit ASCII. */
1843 char2b->byte1 = 0;
1844 char2b->byte2 = c;
1845 }
1846 else
1847 {
1848 int c1, c2, charset;
1849
1850 /* Split characters into bytes. If c2 is -1 afterwards, C is
1851 really a one-byte character so that byte1 is zero. */
1852 SPLIT_CHAR (c, charset, c1, c2);
1853 if (c2 > 0)
1854 char2b->byte1 = c1, char2b->byte2 = c2;
1855 else
1856 char2b->byte1 = 0, char2b->byte2 = c1;
1857
1858 /* Maybe encode the character in *CHAR2B. */
1859 if (face->font != NULL)
1860 {
1861 struct font_info *font_info
1862 = FONT_INFO_FROM_ID (f, face->font_info_id);
1863 if (font_info)
1864 x_encode_char (c, char2b, font_info);
1865 }
1866 }
1867
1868 /* Make sure X resources of the face are allocated. */
1869 xassert (face != NULL);
1870 PREPARE_FACE_FOR_DISPLAY (f, face);
1871
1872 return face;
1873}
1874
1875
1876/* Get face and two-byte form of character glyph GLYPH on frame F.
1877 The encoding of GLYPH->u.ch is returned in *CHAR2B. Value is
1878 a pointer to a realized face that is ready for display. */
1879
1880static INLINE struct face *
1881x_get_glyph_face_and_encoding (f, glyph, char2b, two_byte_p)
1882 struct frame *f;
1883 struct glyph *glyph;
1884 XChar2b *char2b;
1885 int *two_byte_p;
1886{
1887 struct face *face;
1888
1889 xassert (glyph->type == CHAR_GLYPH);
1890 face = FACE_FROM_ID (f, glyph->face_id);
1891
1892 if (two_byte_p)
1893 *two_byte_p = 0;
1894
1895 if (!glyph->multibyte_p)
1896 {
1897 /* Unibyte case. We don't have to encode, but we have to make
1898 sure to use a face suitable for unibyte. */
1899 char2b->byte1 = 0;
1900 char2b->byte2 = glyph->u.ch;
1901 }
1902 else if (glyph->u.ch < 128
1903 && glyph->face_id < BASIC_FACE_ID_SENTINEL)
1904 {
1905 /* Case of ASCII in a face known to fit ASCII. */
1906 char2b->byte1 = 0;
1907 char2b->byte2 = glyph->u.ch;
1908 }
1909 else
1910 {
1911 int c1, c2, charset;
1912
1913 /* Split characters into bytes. If c2 is -1 afterwards, C is
1914 really a one-byte character so that byte1 is zero. */
1915 SPLIT_CHAR (glyph->u.ch, charset, c1, c2);
1916 if (c2 > 0)
1917 char2b->byte1 = c1, char2b->byte2 = c2;
1918 else
1919 char2b->byte1 = 0, char2b->byte2 = c1;
1920
1921 /* Maybe encode the character in *CHAR2B. */
1922 if (charset != CHARSET_ASCII)
1923 {
1924 struct font_info *font_info
1925 = FONT_INFO_FROM_ID (f, face->font_info_id);
1926 if (font_info)
1927 {
1928 x_encode_char (glyph->u.ch, char2b, font_info);
1929 if (two_byte_p)
1930 *two_byte_p
1931 = ((XFontStruct *) (font_info->font))->max_byte1 > 0;
1932 }
1933 }
1934 }
1935
1936 /* Make sure X resources of the face are allocated. */
1937 xassert (face != NULL);
1938 PREPARE_FACE_FOR_DISPLAY (f, face);
1939 return face;
1940}
1941
1942
1943/* Store one glyph for IT->char_to_display in IT->glyph_row.
1944 Called from x_produce_glyphs when IT->glyph_row is non-null. */
1945
1946static INLINE void
1947x_append_glyph (it)
1948 struct it *it;
1949{
1950 struct glyph *glyph;
1951 enum glyph_row_area area = it->area;
1952
1953 xassert (it->glyph_row);
1954 xassert (it->char_to_display != '\n' && it->char_to_display != '\t');
1955
1956 glyph = it->glyph_row->glyphs[area] + it->glyph_row->used[area];
1957 if (glyph < it->glyph_row->glyphs[area + 1])
1958 {
1959 glyph->charpos = CHARPOS (it->position);
1960 glyph->object = it->object;
1961 glyph->pixel_width = it->pixel_width;
1962 glyph->voffset = it->voffset;
1963 glyph->type = CHAR_GLYPH;
1964 glyph->multibyte_p = it->multibyte_p;
1965 glyph->left_box_line_p = it->start_of_box_run_p;
1966 glyph->right_box_line_p = it->end_of_box_run_p;
1967 glyph->overlaps_vertically_p = (it->phys_ascent > it->ascent
1968 || it->phys_descent > it->descent);
1969 glyph->padding_p = 0;
1970 glyph->glyph_not_available_p = it->glyph_not_available_p;
1971 glyph->face_id = it->face_id;
1972 glyph->u.ch = it->char_to_display;
1973 ++it->glyph_row->used[area];
1974 }
1975}
1976
1977/* Store one glyph for the composition IT->cmp_id in IT->glyph_row.
1978 Called from x_produce_glyphs when IT->glyph_row is non-null. */
1979
1980static INLINE void
1981x_append_composite_glyph (it)
1982 struct it *it;
1983{
1984 struct glyph *glyph;
1985 enum glyph_row_area area = it->area;
1986
1987 xassert (it->glyph_row);
1988
1989 glyph = it->glyph_row->glyphs[area] + it->glyph_row->used[area];
1990 if (glyph < it->glyph_row->glyphs[area + 1])
1991 {
1992 glyph->charpos = CHARPOS (it->position);
1993 glyph->object = it->object;
1994 glyph->pixel_width = it->pixel_width;
1995 glyph->voffset = it->voffset;
1996 glyph->type = COMPOSITE_GLYPH;
1997 glyph->multibyte_p = it->multibyte_p;
1998 glyph->left_box_line_p = it->start_of_box_run_p;
1999 glyph->right_box_line_p = it->end_of_box_run_p;
2000 glyph->overlaps_vertically_p = (it->phys_ascent > it->ascent
2001 || it->phys_descent > it->descent);
2002 glyph->padding_p = 0;
2003 glyph->glyph_not_available_p = 0;
2004 glyph->face_id = it->face_id;
2005 glyph->u.cmp_id = it->cmp_id;
2006 ++it->glyph_row->used[area];
2007 }
2008}
2009
2010
2011/* Change IT->ascent and IT->height according to the setting of
2012 IT->voffset. */
2013
2014static INLINE void
2015take_vertical_position_into_account (it)
2016 struct it *it;
2017{
2018 if (it->voffset)
2019 {
2020 if (it->voffset < 0)
2021 /* Increase the ascent so that we can display the text higher
2022 in the line. */
2023 it->ascent += abs (it->voffset);
2024 else
2025 /* Increase the descent so that we can display the text lower
2026 in the line. */
2027 it->descent += it->voffset;
2028 }
2029}
2030
2031
2032/* Produce glyphs/get display metrics for the image IT is loaded with.
2033 See the description of struct display_iterator in dispextern.h for
2034 an overview of struct display_iterator. */
2035
2036static void
2037x_produce_image_glyph (it)
2038 struct it *it;
2039{
2040 struct image *img;
2041 struct face *face;
2042
2043 xassert (it->what == IT_IMAGE);
2044
2045 face = FACE_FROM_ID (it->f, it->face_id);
2046 img = IMAGE_FROM_ID (it->f, it->image_id);
2047 xassert (img);
2048
2049 /* Make sure X resources of the face and image are loaded. */
2050 PREPARE_FACE_FOR_DISPLAY (it->f, face);
2051 prepare_image_for_display (it->f, img);
2052
2053 it->ascent = it->phys_ascent = image_ascent (img, face);
2054 it->descent = it->phys_descent = img->height + 2 * img->margin - it->ascent;
2055 it->pixel_width = img->width + 2 * img->margin;
2056
2057 it->nglyphs = 1;
2058
2059 if (face->box != FACE_NO_BOX)
2060 {
2061 it->ascent += face->box_line_width;
2062 it->descent += face->box_line_width;
2063
2064 if (it->start_of_box_run_p)
2065 it->pixel_width += face->box_line_width;
2066 if (it->end_of_box_run_p)
2067 it->pixel_width += face->box_line_width;
2068 }
2069
2070 take_vertical_position_into_account (it);
2071
2072 if (it->glyph_row)
2073 {
2074 struct glyph *glyph;
2075 enum glyph_row_area area = it->area;
2076
2077 glyph = it->glyph_row->glyphs[area] + it->glyph_row->used[area];
2078 if (glyph < it->glyph_row->glyphs[area + 1])
2079 {
2080 glyph->charpos = CHARPOS (it->position);
2081 glyph->object = it->object;
2082 glyph->pixel_width = it->pixel_width;
2083 glyph->voffset = it->voffset;
2084 glyph->type = IMAGE_GLYPH;
2085 glyph->multibyte_p = it->multibyte_p;
2086 glyph->left_box_line_p = it->start_of_box_run_p;
2087 glyph->right_box_line_p = it->end_of_box_run_p;
2088 glyph->overlaps_vertically_p = 0;
2089 glyph->padding_p = 0;
2090 glyph->glyph_not_available_p = 0;
2091 glyph->face_id = it->face_id;
2092 glyph->u.img_id = img->id;
2093 ++it->glyph_row->used[area];
2094 }
2095 }
2096}
2097
2098
2099/* Append a stretch glyph to IT->glyph_row. OBJECT is the source
2100 of the glyph, WIDTH and HEIGHT are the width and height of the
2101 stretch. ASCENT is the percentage/100 of HEIGHT to use for the
2102 ascent of the glyph (0 <= ASCENT <= 1). */
2103
2104static void
2105x_append_stretch_glyph (it, object, width, height, ascent)
2106 struct it *it;
2107 Lisp_Object object;
2108 int width, height;
2109 double ascent;
2110{
2111 struct glyph *glyph;
2112 enum glyph_row_area area = it->area;
2113
2114 xassert (ascent >= 0 && ascent <= 1);
2115
2116 glyph = it->glyph_row->glyphs[area] + it->glyph_row->used[area];
2117 if (glyph < it->glyph_row->glyphs[area + 1])
2118 {
2119 glyph->charpos = CHARPOS (it->position);
2120 glyph->object = object;
2121 glyph->pixel_width = width;
2122 glyph->voffset = it->voffset;
2123 glyph->type = STRETCH_GLYPH;
2124 glyph->multibyte_p = it->multibyte_p;
2125 glyph->left_box_line_p = it->start_of_box_run_p;
2126 glyph->right_box_line_p = it->end_of_box_run_p;
2127 glyph->overlaps_vertically_p = 0;
2128 glyph->padding_p = 0;
2129 glyph->glyph_not_available_p = 0;
2130 glyph->face_id = it->face_id;
2131 glyph->u.stretch.ascent = height * ascent;
2132 glyph->u.stretch.height = height;
2133 ++it->glyph_row->used[area];
2134 }
2135}
2136
2137
2138/* Produce a stretch glyph for iterator IT. IT->object is the value
2139 of the glyph property displayed. The value must be a list
2140 `(space KEYWORD VALUE ...)' with the following KEYWORD/VALUE pairs
2141 being recognized:
2142
2143 1. `:width WIDTH' specifies that the space should be WIDTH *
2144 canonical char width wide. WIDTH may be an integer or floating
2145 point number.
2146
2147 2. `:relative-width FACTOR' specifies that the width of the stretch
2148 should be computed from the width of the first character having the
2149 `glyph' property, and should be FACTOR times that width.
2150
2151 3. `:align-to HPOS' specifies that the space should be wide enough
2152 to reach HPOS, a value in canonical character units.
2153
2154 Exactly one of the above pairs must be present.
2155
2156 4. `:height HEIGHT' specifies that the height of the stretch produced
2157 should be HEIGHT, measured in canonical character units.
2158
2159 5. `:relative-height FACTOR' specifies that the height of the the
2160 stretch should be FACTOR times the height of the characters having
2161 the glyph property.
2162
2163 Either none or exactly one of 4 or 5 must be present.
2164
2165 6. `:ascent ASCENT' specifies that ASCENT percent of the height
2166 of the stretch should be used for the ascent of the stretch.
2167 ASCENT must be in the range 0 <= ASCENT <= 100. */
2168
2169#define NUMVAL(X) \
2170 ((INTEGERP (X) || FLOATP (X)) \
2171 ? XFLOATINT (X) \
2172 : - 1)
2173
2174
2175static void
2176x_produce_stretch_glyph (it)
2177 struct it *it;
2178{
2179 /* (space :width WIDTH :height HEIGHT. */
2180#if GLYPH_DEBUG
2181 extern Lisp_Object Qspace;
2182#endif
2183 extern Lisp_Object QCwidth, QCheight, QCascent;
2184 extern Lisp_Object QCrelative_width, QCrelative_height;
2185 extern Lisp_Object QCalign_to;
2186 Lisp_Object prop, plist;
2187 double width = 0, height = 0, ascent = 0;
2188 struct face *face = FACE_FROM_ID (it->f, it->face_id);
2189 XFontStruct *font = face->font ? face->font : FRAME_FONT (it->f);
2190
2191 PREPARE_FACE_FOR_DISPLAY (it->f, face);
2192
2193 /* List should start with `space'. */
2194 xassert (CONSP (it->object) && EQ (XCAR (it->object), Qspace));
2195 plist = XCDR (it->object);
2196
2197 /* Compute the width of the stretch. */
2198 if (prop = Fplist_get (plist, QCwidth),
2199 NUMVAL (prop) > 0)
2200 /* Absolute width `:width WIDTH' specified and valid. */
2201 width = NUMVAL (prop) * CANON_X_UNIT (it->f);
2202 else if (prop = Fplist_get (plist, QCrelative_width),
2203 NUMVAL (prop) > 0)
2204 {
2205 /* Relative width `:relative-width FACTOR' specified and valid.
2206 Compute the width of the characters having the `glyph'
2207 property. */
2208 struct it it2;
2209 unsigned char *p = BYTE_POS_ADDR (IT_BYTEPOS (*it));
2210
2211 it2 = *it;
2212 if (it->multibyte_p)
2213 {
2214 int maxlen = ((IT_BYTEPOS (*it) >= GPT ? ZV : GPT)
2215 - IT_BYTEPOS (*it));
2216 it2.c = STRING_CHAR_AND_LENGTH (p, maxlen, it2.len);
2217 }
2218 else
2219 it2.c = *p, it2.len = 1;
2220
2221 it2.glyph_row = NULL;
2222 it2.what = IT_CHARACTER;
2223 x_produce_glyphs (&it2);
2224 width = NUMVAL (prop) * it2.pixel_width;
2225 }
2226 else if (prop = Fplist_get (plist, QCalign_to),
2227 NUMVAL (prop) > 0)
2228 width = NUMVAL (prop) * CANON_X_UNIT (it->f) - it->current_x;
2229 else
2230 /* Nothing specified -> width defaults to canonical char width. */
2231 width = CANON_X_UNIT (it->f);
2232
2233 /* Compute height. */
2234 if (prop = Fplist_get (plist, QCheight),
2235 NUMVAL (prop) > 0)
2236 height = NUMVAL (prop) * CANON_Y_UNIT (it->f);
2237 else if (prop = Fplist_get (plist, QCrelative_height),
2238 NUMVAL (prop) > 0)
2239 height = FONT_HEIGHT (font) * NUMVAL (prop);
2240 else
2241 height = FONT_HEIGHT (font);
2242
2243 /* Compute percentage of height used for ascent. If
2244 `:ascent ASCENT' is present and valid, use that. Otherwise,
2245 derive the ascent from the font in use. */
2246 if (prop = Fplist_get (plist, QCascent),
2247 NUMVAL (prop) > 0 && NUMVAL (prop) <= 100)
2248 ascent = NUMVAL (prop) / 100.0;
2249 else
2250 ascent = (double) font->ascent / FONT_HEIGHT (font);
2251
2252 if (width <= 0)
2253 width = 1;
2254 if (height <= 0)
2255 height = 1;
2256
2257 if (it->glyph_row)
2258 {
2259 Lisp_Object object = it->stack[it->sp - 1].string;
2260 if (!STRINGP (object))
2261 object = it->w->buffer;
2262 x_append_stretch_glyph (it, object, width, height, ascent);
2263 }
2264
2265 it->pixel_width = width;
2266 it->ascent = it->phys_ascent = height * ascent;
2267 it->descent = it->phys_descent = height - it->ascent;
2268 it->nglyphs = 1;
2269
2270 if (face->box != FACE_NO_BOX)
2271 {
2272 it->ascent += face->box_line_width;
2273 it->descent += face->box_line_width;
2274
2275 if (it->start_of_box_run_p)
2276 it->pixel_width += face->box_line_width;
2277 if (it->end_of_box_run_p)
2278 it->pixel_width += face->box_line_width;
2279 }
2280
2281 take_vertical_position_into_account (it);
2282}
2283
2284/* Return proper value to be used as baseline offset of font that has
2285 ASCENT and DESCENT to draw characters by the font at the vertical
2286 center of the line of frame F.
2287
2288 Here, out task is to find the value of BOFF in the following figure;
2289
2290 -------------------------+-----------+-
2291 -+-+---------+-+ | |
2292 | | | | | |
2293 | | | | F_ASCENT F_HEIGHT
2294 | | | ASCENT | |
2295 HEIGHT | | | | |
2296 | | |-|-+------+-----------|------- baseline
2297 | | | | BOFF | |
2298 | |---------|-+-+ | |
2299 | | | DESCENT | |
2300 -+-+---------+-+ F_DESCENT |
2301 -------------------------+-----------+-
2302
2303 -BOFF + DESCENT + (F_HEIGHT - HEIGHT) / 2 = F_DESCENT
2304 BOFF = DESCENT + (F_HEIGHT - HEIGHT) / 2 - F_DESCENT
2305 DESCENT = FONT->descent
2306 HEIGHT = FONT_HEIGHT (FONT)
2307 F_DESCENT = (F->output_data.x->font->descent
2308 - F->output_data.x->baseline_offset)
2309 F_HEIGHT = FRAME_LINE_HEIGHT (F)
2310*/
2311
2312#define VCENTER_BASELINE_OFFSET(FONT, F) \
2313 ((FONT)->descent \
2314 + (FRAME_LINE_HEIGHT ((F)) - FONT_HEIGHT ((FONT))) / 2 \
2315 - ((F)->output_data.mac->font->descent - (F)->output_data.mac->baseline_offset))
2316
2317/* Produce glyphs/get display metrics for the display element IT is
2318 loaded with. See the description of struct display_iterator in
2319 dispextern.h for an overview of struct display_iterator. */
2320
2321void
2322x_produce_glyphs (it)
2323 struct it *it;
2324{
2325 it->glyph_not_available_p = 0;
2326
2327 if (it->what == IT_CHARACTER)
2328 {
2329 XChar2b char2b;
2330 XFontStruct *font;
2331 struct face *face = FACE_FROM_ID (it->f, it->face_id);
2332 XCharStruct *pcm;
2333 int font_not_found_p;
2334 struct font_info *font_info;
2335 int boff; /* baseline offset */
2336
2337 /* Maybe translate single-byte characters to multibyte, or the
2338 other way. */
2339 it->char_to_display = it->c;
2340 if (!ASCII_BYTE_P (it->c))
2341 {
2342 if (unibyte_display_via_language_environment
2343 && SINGLE_BYTE_CHAR_P (it->c)
2344 && (it->c >= 0240
2345 || !NILP (Vnonascii_translation_table)))
2346 {
2347 it->char_to_display = unibyte_char_to_multibyte (it->c);
2348 it->face_id = FACE_FOR_CHAR (it->f, face, it->char_to_display);
2349 face = FACE_FROM_ID (it->f, it->face_id);
2350 }
2351 else if (!SINGLE_BYTE_CHAR_P (it->c)
2352 && !it->multibyte_p)
2353 {
2354 it->char_to_display = multibyte_char_to_unibyte (it->c, Qnil);
2355 it->face_id = FACE_FOR_CHAR (it->f, face, it->char_to_display);
2356 face = FACE_FROM_ID (it->f, it->face_id);
2357 }
2358 }
2359
2360 /* Get font to use. Encode IT->char_to_display. */
2361 x_get_char_face_and_encoding (it->f, it->char_to_display,
2362 it->face_id, &char2b,
2363 it->multibyte_p);
2364 font = face->font;
2365
2366 /* When no suitable font found, use the default font. */
2367 font_not_found_p = font == NULL;
2368 if (font_not_found_p)
2369 {
2370 font = FRAME_FONT (it->f);
2371 boff = it->f->output_data.mac->baseline_offset;
2372 font_info = NULL;
2373 }
2374 else
2375 {
2376 font_info = FONT_INFO_FROM_ID (it->f, face->font_info_id);
2377 boff = font_info->baseline_offset;
2378 if (font_info->vertical_centering)
2379 boff = VCENTER_BASELINE_OFFSET (font, it->f) - boff;
2380 }
2381
2382 if (it->char_to_display >= ' '
2383 && (!it->multibyte_p || it->char_to_display < 128))
2384 {
2385 /* Either unibyte or ASCII. */
2386 int stretched_p;
2387
2388 it->nglyphs = 1;
2389
2390 pcm = x_per_char_metric (font, &char2b);
2391 it->ascent = font->ascent + boff;
2392 it->descent = font->descent - boff;
2393
2394 if (pcm)
2395 {
2396 it->phys_ascent = pcm->ascent + boff;
2397 it->phys_descent = pcm->descent - boff;
2398 it->pixel_width = pcm->width;
2399 }
2400 else
2401 {
2402 it->glyph_not_available_p = 1;
2403 it->phys_ascent = font->ascent + boff;
2404 it->phys_descent = font->descent - boff;
2405 it->pixel_width = FONT_WIDTH (font);
2406 }
2407
2408 /* If this is a space inside a region of text with
2409 `space-width' property, change its width. */
2410 stretched_p = it->char_to_display == ' ' && !NILP (it->space_width);
2411 if (stretched_p)
2412 it->pixel_width *= XFLOATINT (it->space_width);
2413
2414 /* If face has a box, add the box thickness to the character
2415 height. If character has a box line to the left and/or
2416 right, add the box line width to the character's width. */
2417 if (face->box != FACE_NO_BOX)
2418 {
2419 int thick = face->box_line_width;
2420
2421 it->ascent += thick;
2422 it->descent += thick;
2423
2424 if (it->start_of_box_run_p)
2425 it->pixel_width += thick;
2426 if (it->end_of_box_run_p)
2427 it->pixel_width += thick;
2428 }
2429
2430 /* If face has an overline, add the height of the overline
2431 (1 pixel) and a 1 pixel margin to the character height. */
2432 if (face->overline_p)
2433 it->ascent += 2;
2434
2435 take_vertical_position_into_account (it);
2436
2437 /* If we have to actually produce glyphs, do it. */
2438 if (it->glyph_row)
2439 {
2440 if (stretched_p)
2441 {
2442 /* Translate a space with a `space-width' property
2443 into a stretch glyph. */
2444 double ascent = (double) font->ascent / FONT_HEIGHT (font);
2445 x_append_stretch_glyph (it, it->object, it->pixel_width,
2446 it->ascent + it->descent, ascent);
2447 }
2448 else
2449 x_append_glyph (it);
2450
2451 /* If characters with lbearing or rbearing are displayed
2452 in this line, record that fact in a flag of the
2453 glyph row. This is used to optimize X output code. */
2454 if (pcm && (pcm->lbearing < 0 || pcm->rbearing > pcm->width))
2455 it->glyph_row->contains_overlapping_glyphs_p = 1;
2456 }
2457 }
2458 else if (it->char_to_display == '\n')
2459 {
2460 /* A newline has no width but we need the height of the line. */
2461 it->pixel_width = 0;
2462 it->nglyphs = 0;
2463 it->ascent = it->phys_ascent = font->ascent + boff;
2464 it->descent = it->phys_descent = font->descent - boff;
2465
2466 if (face->box != FACE_NO_BOX)
2467 {
2468 int thick = face->box_line_width;
2469 it->ascent += thick;
2470 it->descent += thick;
2471 }
2472 }
2473 else if (it->char_to_display == '\t')
2474 {
2475 int tab_width = it->tab_width * CANON_X_UNIT (it->f);
2476 int x = it->current_x + it->continuation_lines_width;
2477 int next_tab_x = ((1 + x + tab_width - 1) / tab_width) * tab_width;
2478
2479 it->pixel_width = next_tab_x - x;
2480 it->nglyphs = 1;
2481 it->ascent = it->phys_ascent = font->ascent + boff;
2482 it->descent = it->phys_descent = font->descent - boff;
2483
2484 if (it->glyph_row)
2485 {
2486 double ascent = (double) it->ascent / (it->ascent + it->descent);
2487 x_append_stretch_glyph (it, it->object, it->pixel_width,
2488 it->ascent + it->descent, ascent);
2489 }
2490 }
2491 else
2492 {
2493 /* A multi-byte character. Assume that the display width of the
2494 character is the width of the character multiplied by the
2495 width of the font. */
2496
2497 /* If we found a font, this font should give us the right
2498 metrics. If we didn't find a font, use the frame's
2499 default font and calculate the width of the character
2500 from the charset width; this is what old redisplay code
2501 did. */
2502 pcm = x_per_char_metric (font, &char2b);
2503 if (font_not_found_p || !pcm)
2504 {
2505 int charset = CHAR_CHARSET (it->char_to_display);
2506
2507 it->glyph_not_available_p = 1;
2508 it->pixel_width = (FONT_WIDTH (FRAME_FONT (it->f))
2509 * CHARSET_WIDTH (charset));
2510 it->phys_ascent = font->ascent + boff;
2511 it->phys_descent = font->descent - boff;
2512 }
2513 else
2514 {
2515 it->pixel_width = pcm->width;
2516 it->phys_ascent = pcm->ascent + boff;
2517 it->phys_descent = pcm->descent - boff;
2518 if (it->glyph_row
2519 && (pcm->lbearing < 0
2520 || pcm->rbearing > pcm->width))
2521 it->glyph_row->contains_overlapping_glyphs_p = 1;
2522 }
2523 it->nglyphs = 1;
2524 it->ascent = font->ascent + boff;
2525 it->descent = font->descent - boff;
2526 if (face->box != FACE_NO_BOX)
2527 {
2528 int thick = face->box_line_width;
2529 it->ascent += thick;
2530 it->descent += thick;
2531
2532 if (it->start_of_box_run_p)
2533 it->pixel_width += thick;
2534 if (it->end_of_box_run_p)
2535 it->pixel_width += thick;
2536 }
2537
2538 /* If face has an overline, add the height of the overline
2539 (1 pixel) and a 1 pixel margin to the character height. */
2540 if (face->overline_p)
2541 it->ascent += 2;
2542
2543 take_vertical_position_into_account (it);
2544
2545 if (it->glyph_row)
2546 x_append_glyph (it);
2547 }
2548 }
2549 else if (it->what == IT_COMPOSITION)
2550 {
2551 /* Note: A composition is represented as one glyph in the
2552 glyph matrix. There are no padding glyphs. */
2553 XChar2b char2b;
2554 XFontStruct *font;
2555 struct face *face = FACE_FROM_ID (it->f, it->face_id);
2556 XCharStruct *pcm;
2557 int font_not_found_p;
2558 struct font_info *font_info;
2559 int boff; /* baseline offset */
2560 struct composition *cmp = composition_table[it->cmp_id];
2561
2562 /* Maybe translate single-byte characters to multibyte. */
2563 it->char_to_display = it->c;
2564 if (unibyte_display_via_language_environment
2565 && SINGLE_BYTE_CHAR_P (it->c)
2566 && (it->c >= 0240
2567 || (it->c >= 0200
2568 && !NILP (Vnonascii_translation_table))))
2569 {
2570 it->char_to_display = unibyte_char_to_multibyte (it->c);
2571 }
2572
2573 /* Get face and font to use. Encode IT->char_to_display. */
2574 it->face_id = FACE_FOR_CHAR (it->f, face, it->char_to_display);
2575 face = FACE_FROM_ID (it->f, it->face_id);
2576 x_get_char_face_and_encoding (it->f, it->char_to_display,
2577 it->face_id, &char2b, it->multibyte_p);
2578 font = face->font;
2579
2580 /* When no suitable font found, use the default font. */
2581 font_not_found_p = font == NULL;
2582 if (font_not_found_p)
2583 {
2584 font = FRAME_FONT (it->f);
2585 boff = it->f->output_data.mac->baseline_offset;
2586 font_info = NULL;
2587 }
2588 else
2589 {
2590 font_info = FONT_INFO_FROM_ID (it->f, face->font_info_id);
2591 boff = font_info->baseline_offset;
2592 if (font_info->vertical_centering)
2593 boff = VCENTER_BASELINE_OFFSET (font, it->f) - boff;
2594 }
2595
2596 /* There are no padding glyphs, so there is only one glyph to
2597 produce for the composition. Important is that pixel_width,
2598 ascent and descent are the values of what is drawn by
2599 draw_glyphs (i.e. the values of the overall glyphs composed). */
2600 it->nglyphs = 1;
2601
2602 /* If we have not yet calculated pixel size data of glyphs of
2603 the composition for the current face font, calculate them
2604 now. Theoretically, we have to check all fonts for the
2605 glyphs, but that requires much time and memory space. So,
2606 here we check only the font of the first glyph. This leads
2607 to incorrect display very rarely, and C-l (recenter) can
2608 correct the display anyway. */
2609 if (cmp->font != (void *) font)
2610 {
2611 /* Ascent and descent of the font of the first character of
2612 this composition (adjusted by baseline offset). Ascent
2613 and descent of overall glyphs should not be less than
2614 them respectively. */
2615 int font_ascent = font->ascent + boff;
2616 int font_descent = font->descent - boff;
2617 /* Bounding box of the overall glyphs. */
2618 int leftmost, rightmost, lowest, highest;
2619 int i, width, ascent, descent;
2620
2621 cmp->font = (void *) font;
2622
2623 /* Initialize the bounding box. */
2624 pcm = x_per_char_metric (font, &char2b);
2625 if (pcm)
2626 {
2627 width = pcm->width;
2628 ascent = pcm->ascent;
2629 descent = pcm->descent;
2630 }
2631 else
2632 {
2633 width = FONT_WIDTH (font);
2634 ascent = font->ascent;
2635 descent = font->descent;
2636 }
2637
2638 rightmost = width;
2639 lowest = - descent + boff;
2640 highest = ascent + boff;
2641 leftmost = 0;
2642
2643 if (font_info
2644 && font_info->default_ascent
2645 && CHAR_TABLE_P (Vuse_default_ascent)
2646 && !NILP (Faref (Vuse_default_ascent,
2647 make_number (it->char_to_display))))
2648 highest = font_info->default_ascent + boff;
2649
2650 /* Draw the first glyph at the normal position. It may be
2651 shifted to right later if some other glyphs are drawn at
2652 the left. */
2653 cmp->offsets[0] = 0;
2654 cmp->offsets[1] = boff;
2655
2656 /* Set cmp->offsets for the remaining glyphs. */
2657 for (i = 1; i < cmp->glyph_len; i++)
2658 {
2659 int left, right, btm, top;
2660 int ch = COMPOSITION_GLYPH (cmp, i);
2661 int face_id = FACE_FOR_CHAR (it->f, face, ch);
2662
2663 face = FACE_FROM_ID (it->f, face_id);
2664 x_get_char_face_and_encoding (it->f, ch, face->id, &char2b,
2665 it->multibyte_p);
2666 font = face->font;
2667 if (font == NULL)
2668 {
2669 font = FRAME_FONT (it->f);
2670 boff = it->f->output_data.mac->baseline_offset;
2671 font_info = NULL;
2672 }
2673 else
2674 {
2675 font_info
2676 = FONT_INFO_FROM_ID (it->f, face->font_info_id);
2677 boff = font_info->baseline_offset;
2678 if (font_info->vertical_centering)
2679 boff = VCENTER_BASELINE_OFFSET (font, it->f) - boff;
2680 }
2681
2682 pcm = x_per_char_metric (font, &char2b);
2683 if (pcm)
2684 {
2685 width = pcm->width;
2686 ascent = pcm->ascent;
2687 descent = pcm->descent;
2688 }
2689 else
2690 {
2691 width = FONT_WIDTH (font);
2692 ascent = font->ascent;
2693 descent = font->descent;
2694 }
2695
2696 if (cmp->method != COMPOSITION_WITH_RULE_ALTCHARS)
2697 {
2698 /* Relative composition with or without
2699 alternate chars. */
2700 left = (leftmost + rightmost - width) / 2;
2701 btm = - descent + boff;
2702 if (font_info && font_info->relative_compose
2703 && (! CHAR_TABLE_P (Vignore_relative_composition)
2704 || NILP (Faref (Vignore_relative_composition,
2705 make_number (ch)))))
2706 {
2707
2708 if (- descent >= font_info->relative_compose)
2709 /* One extra pixel between two glyphs. */
2710 btm = highest + 1;
2711 else if (ascent <= 0)
2712 /* One extra pixel between two glyphs. */
2713 btm = lowest - 1 - ascent - descent;
2714 }
2715 }
2716 else
2717 {
2718 /* A composition rule is specified by an integer
2719 value that encodes global and new reference
2720 points (GREF and NREF). GREF and NREF are
2721 specified by numbers as below:
2722
2723 0---1---2 -- ascent
2724 | |
2725 | |
2726 | |
2727 9--10--11 -- center
2728 | |
2729 ---3---4---5--- baseline
2730 | |
2731 6---7---8 -- descent
2732 */
2733 int rule = COMPOSITION_RULE (cmp, i);
2734 int gref, nref, grefx, grefy, nrefx, nrefy;
2735
2736 COMPOSITION_DECODE_RULE (rule, gref, nref);
2737 grefx = gref % 3, nrefx = nref % 3;
2738 grefy = gref / 3, nrefy = nref / 3;
2739
2740 left = (leftmost
2741 + grefx * (rightmost - leftmost) / 2
2742 - nrefx * width / 2);
2743 btm = ((grefy == 0 ? highest
2744 : grefy == 1 ? 0
2745 : grefy == 2 ? lowest
2746 : (highest + lowest) / 2)
2747 - (nrefy == 0 ? ascent + descent
2748 : nrefy == 1 ? descent - boff
2749 : nrefy == 2 ? 0
2750 : (ascent + descent) / 2));
2751 }
2752
2753 cmp->offsets[i * 2] = left;
2754 cmp->offsets[i * 2 + 1] = btm + descent;
2755
2756 /* Update the bounding box of the overall glyphs. */
2757 right = left + width;
2758 top = btm + descent + ascent;
2759 if (left < leftmost)
2760 leftmost = left;
2761 if (right > rightmost)
2762 rightmost = right;
2763 if (top > highest)
2764 highest = top;
2765 if (btm < lowest)
2766 lowest = btm;
2767 }
2768
2769 /* If there are glyphs whose x-offsets are negative,
2770 shift all glyphs to the right and make all x-offsets
2771 non-negative. */
2772 if (leftmost < 0)
2773 {
2774 for (i = 0; i < cmp->glyph_len; i++)
2775 cmp->offsets[i * 2] -= leftmost;
2776 rightmost -= leftmost;
2777 }
2778
2779 cmp->pixel_width = rightmost;
2780 cmp->ascent = highest;
2781 cmp->descent = - lowest;
2782 if (cmp->ascent < font_ascent)
2783 cmp->ascent = font_ascent;
2784 if (cmp->descent < font_descent)
2785 cmp->descent = font_descent;
2786 }
2787
2788 it->pixel_width = cmp->pixel_width;
2789 it->ascent = it->phys_ascent = cmp->ascent;
2790 it->descent = it->phys_descent = cmp->descent;
2791
2792 if (face->box != FACE_NO_BOX)
2793 {
2794 int thick = face->box_line_width;
2795 it->ascent += thick;
2796 it->descent += thick;
2797
2798 if (it->start_of_box_run_p)
2799 it->pixel_width += thick;
2800 if (it->end_of_box_run_p)
2801 it->pixel_width += thick;
2802 }
2803
2804 /* If face has an overline, add the height of the overline
2805 (1 pixel) and a 1 pixel margin to the character height. */
2806 if (face->overline_p)
2807 it->ascent += 2;
2808
2809 take_vertical_position_into_account (it);
2810
2811 if (it->glyph_row)
2812 x_append_composite_glyph (it);
2813 }
2814 else if (it->what == IT_IMAGE)
2815 x_produce_image_glyph (it);
2816 else if (it->what == IT_STRETCH)
2817 x_produce_stretch_glyph (it);
2818
2819 /* Accumulate dimensions. Note: can't assume that it->descent > 0
2820 because this isn't true for images with `:ascent 100'. */
2821 xassert (it->ascent >= 0 && it->descent >= 0);
2822 if (it->area == TEXT_AREA)
2823 it->current_x += it->pixel_width;
2824
2825 it->descent += it->extra_line_spacing;
2826
2827 it->max_ascent = max (it->max_ascent, it->ascent);
2828 it->max_descent = max (it->max_descent, it->descent);
2829 it->max_phys_ascent = max (it->max_phys_ascent, it->phys_ascent);
2830 it->max_phys_descent = max (it->max_phys_descent, it->phys_descent);
2831}
2832
2833
2834/* Estimate the pixel height of the mode or top line on frame F.
2835 FACE_ID specifies what line's height to estimate. */
2836
2837int
2838x_estimate_mode_line_height (f, face_id)
2839 struct frame *f;
2840 enum face_id face_id;
2841{
2842 int height = 1;
2843
2844 /* This function is called so early when Emacs starts that the face
2845 cache and mode line face are not yet initialized. */
2846 if (FRAME_FACE_CACHE (f))
2847 {
2848 struct face *face = FACE_FROM_ID (f, face_id);
2849 if (face)
2850 height = FONT_HEIGHT (face->font) + 2 * face->box_line_width;
2851 }
2852
2853 return height;
2854}
2855
2856\f
2857/***********************************************************************
2858 Glyph display
2859 ***********************************************************************/
2860
2861/* A sequence of glyphs to be drawn in the same face.
2862
2863 This data structure is not really completely X specific, so it
2864 could possibly, at least partially, be useful for other systems. It
2865 is currently not part of the external redisplay interface because
2866 it's not clear what other systems will need. */
2867
2868struct glyph_string
2869{
2870 /* X-origin of the string. */
2871 int x;
2872
2873 /* Y-origin and y-position of the base line of this string. */
2874 int y, ybase;
2875
2876 /* The width of the string, not including a face extension. */
2877 int width;
2878
2879 /* The width of the string, including a face extension. */
2880 int background_width;
2881
2882 /* The height of this string. This is the height of the line this
2883 string is drawn in, and can be different from the height of the
2884 font the string is drawn in. */
2885 int height;
2886
2887 /* Number of pixels this string overwrites in front of its x-origin.
2888 This number is zero if the string has an lbearing >= 0; it is
2889 -lbearing, if the string has an lbearing < 0. */
2890 int left_overhang;
2891
2892 /* Number of pixels this string overwrites past its right-most
2893 nominal x-position, i.e. x + width. Zero if the string's
2894 rbearing is <= its nominal width, rbearing - width otherwise. */
2895 int right_overhang;
2896
2897 /* The frame on which the glyph string is drawn. */
2898 struct frame *f;
2899
2900 /* The window on which the glyph string is drawn. */
2901 struct window *w;
2902
2903 /* X display and window for convenience. */
2904 Display *display;
2905 Window window;
2906
2907 /* The glyph row for which this string was built. It determines the
2908 y-origin and height of the string. */
2909 struct glyph_row *row;
2910
2911 /* The area within row. */
2912 enum glyph_row_area area;
2913
2914 /* Characters to be drawn, and number of characters. */
2915 XChar2b *char2b;
2916 int nchars;
2917
2918 /* A face-override for drawing cursors, mouse face and similar. */
2919 enum draw_glyphs_face hl;
2920
2921 /* Face in which this string is to be drawn. */
2922 struct face *face;
2923
2924 /* Font in which this string is to be drawn. */
2925 XFontStruct *font;
2926
2927 /* Font info for this string. */
2928 struct font_info *font_info;
2929
2930 /* Non-null means this string describes (part of) a composition.
2931 All characters from char2b are drawn composed. */
2932 struct composition *cmp;
2933
2934 /* Index of this glyph string's first character in the glyph
2935 definition of CMP. If this is zero, this glyph string describes
2936 the first character of a composition. */
2937 int gidx;
2938
2939 /* 1 means this glyph strings face has to be drawn to the right end
2940 of the window's drawing area. */
2941 unsigned extends_to_end_of_line_p : 1;
2942
2943 /* 1 means the background of this string has been drawn. */
2944 unsigned background_filled_p : 1;
2945
2946 /* 1 means glyph string must be drawn with 16-bit functions. */
2947 unsigned two_byte_p : 1;
2948
2949 /* 1 means that the original font determined for drawing this glyph
2950 string could not be loaded. The member `font' has been set to
2951 the frame's default font in this case. */
2952 unsigned font_not_found_p : 1;
2953
2954 /* 1 means that the face in which this glyph string is drawn has a
2955 stipple pattern. */
2956 unsigned stippled_p : 1;
2957
2958 /* 1 means only the foreground of this glyph string must be drawn,
2959 and we should use the physical height of the line this glyph
2960 string appears in as clip rect. */
2961 unsigned for_overlaps_p : 1;
2962
2963 /* The GC to use for drawing this glyph string. */
2964 GC gc;
2965
2966 /* A pointer to the first glyph in the string. This glyph
2967 corresponds to char2b[0]. Needed to draw rectangles if
2968 font_not_found_p is 1. */
2969 struct glyph *first_glyph;
2970
2971 /* Image, if any. */
2972 struct image *img;
2973
2974 struct glyph_string *next, *prev;
2975};
2976
2977
2978#if 0
2979
2980static void
2981x_dump_glyph_string (s)
2982 struct glyph_string *s;
2983{
2984 fprintf (stderr, "glyph string\n");
2985 fprintf (stderr, " x, y, w, h = %d, %d, %d, %d\n",
2986 s->x, s->y, s->width, s->height);
2987 fprintf (stderr, " ybase = %d\n", s->ybase);
2988 fprintf (stderr, " hl = %d\n", s->hl);
2989 fprintf (stderr, " left overhang = %d, right = %d\n",
2990 s->left_overhang, s->right_overhang);
2991 fprintf (stderr, " nchars = %d\n", s->nchars);
2992 fprintf (stderr, " extends to end of line = %d\n",
2993 s->extends_to_end_of_line_p);
2994 fprintf (stderr, " font height = %d\n", FONT_HEIGHT (s->font));
2995 fprintf (stderr, " bg width = %d\n", s->background_width);
2996}
2997
2998#endif /* GLYPH_DEBUG */
2999
3000
3001
3002static void x_append_glyph_string_lists P_ ((struct glyph_string **,
3003 struct glyph_string **,
3004 struct glyph_string *,
3005 struct glyph_string *));
3006static void x_prepend_glyph_string_lists P_ ((struct glyph_string **,
3007 struct glyph_string **,
3008 struct glyph_string *,
3009 struct glyph_string *));
3010static void x_append_glyph_string P_ ((struct glyph_string **,
3011 struct glyph_string **,
3012 struct glyph_string *));
3013static int x_left_overwritten P_ ((struct glyph_string *));
3014static int x_left_overwriting P_ ((struct glyph_string *));
3015static int x_right_overwritten P_ ((struct glyph_string *));
3016static int x_right_overwriting P_ ((struct glyph_string *));
3017static int x_fill_glyph_string P_ ((struct glyph_string *, int, int, int,
3018 int));
3019static void x_init_glyph_string P_ ((struct glyph_string *,
3020 XChar2b *, struct window *,
3021 struct glyph_row *,
3022 enum glyph_row_area, int,
3023 enum draw_glyphs_face));
3024static int x_draw_glyphs P_ ((struct window *, int , struct glyph_row *,
3025 enum glyph_row_area, int, int,
3026 enum draw_glyphs_face, int *, int *, int));
3027static void x_set_glyph_string_clipping P_ ((struct glyph_string *));
3028static void x_set_glyph_string_gc P_ ((struct glyph_string *));
3029static void x_draw_glyph_string_background P_ ((struct glyph_string *,
3030 int));
3031static void x_draw_glyph_string_foreground P_ ((struct glyph_string *));
3032static void x_draw_composite_glyph_string_foreground P_ ((struct glyph_string *));
3033static void x_draw_glyph_string_box P_ ((struct glyph_string *));
3034static void x_draw_glyph_string P_ ((struct glyph_string *));
3035static void x_compute_glyph_string_overhangs P_ ((struct glyph_string *));
3036static void x_set_cursor_gc P_ ((struct glyph_string *));
3037static void x_set_mode_line_face_gc P_ ((struct glyph_string *));
3038static void x_set_mouse_face_gc P_ ((struct glyph_string *));
3039static void x_get_glyph_overhangs P_ ((struct glyph *, struct frame *,
3040 int *, int *));
3041static void x_compute_overhangs_and_x P_ ((struct glyph_string *, int, int));
3042static int x_alloc_lighter_color P_ ((struct frame *, Display *, Colormap,
3043 unsigned long *, double, int));
3044static void x_setup_relief_color P_ ((struct frame *, struct relief *,
3045 double, int, unsigned long));
3046static void x_setup_relief_colors P_ ((struct glyph_string *));
3047static void x_draw_image_glyph_string P_ ((struct glyph_string *));
3048static void x_draw_image_relief P_ ((struct glyph_string *));
3049static void x_draw_image_foreground P_ ((struct glyph_string *));
3050static void x_draw_image_foreground_1 P_ ((struct glyph_string *, Pixmap));
3051static void x_fill_image_glyph_string P_ ((struct glyph_string *));
3052static void x_clear_glyph_string_rect P_ ((struct glyph_string *, int,
3053 int, int, int));
3054static void x_draw_relief_rect P_ ((struct frame *, int, int, int, int,
3055 int, int, int, int, XRectangle *));
3056static void x_draw_box_rect P_ ((struct glyph_string *, int, int, int, int,
3057 int, int, int, XRectangle *));
3058static void x_fix_overlapping_area P_ ((struct window *, struct glyph_row *,
3059 enum glyph_row_area));
3060static int x_fill_stretch_glyph_string P_ ((struct glyph_string *,
3061 struct glyph_row *,
3062 enum glyph_row_area, int, int));
3063
3064#if GLYPH_DEBUG
3065static void x_check_font P_ ((struct frame *, XFontStruct *));
3066#endif
3067
3068
3069/* Append the list of glyph strings with head H and tail T to the list
3070 with head *HEAD and tail *TAIL. Set *HEAD and *TAIL to the result. */
3071
3072static INLINE void
3073x_append_glyph_string_lists (head, tail, h, t)
3074 struct glyph_string **head, **tail;
3075 struct glyph_string *h, *t;
3076{
3077 if (h)
3078 {
3079 if (*head)
3080 (*tail)->next = h;
3081 else
3082 *head = h;
3083 h->prev = *tail;
3084 *tail = t;
3085 }
3086}
3087
3088
3089/* Prepend the list of glyph strings with head H and tail T to the
3090 list with head *HEAD and tail *TAIL. Set *HEAD and *TAIL to the
3091 result. */
3092
3093static INLINE void
3094x_prepend_glyph_string_lists (head, tail, h, t)
3095 struct glyph_string **head, **tail;
3096 struct glyph_string *h, *t;
3097{
3098 if (h)
3099 {
3100 if (*head)
3101 (*head)->prev = t;
3102 else
3103 *tail = t;
3104 t->next = *head;
3105 *head = h;
3106 }
3107}
3108
3109
3110/* Append glyph string S to the list with head *HEAD and tail *TAIL.
3111 Set *HEAD and *TAIL to the resulting list. */
3112
3113static INLINE void
3114x_append_glyph_string (head, tail, s)
3115 struct glyph_string **head, **tail;
3116 struct glyph_string *s;
3117{
3118 s->next = s->prev = NULL;
3119 x_append_glyph_string_lists (head, tail, s, s);
3120}
3121
3122
3123/* Set S->gc to a suitable GC for drawing glyph string S in cursor
3124 face. */
3125
3126static void
3127x_set_cursor_gc (s)
3128 struct glyph_string *s;
3129{
3130 if (s->font == FRAME_FONT (s->f)
3131 && s->face->background == FRAME_BACKGROUND_PIXEL (s->f)
3132 && s->face->foreground == FRAME_FOREGROUND_PIXEL (s->f)
3133 && !s->cmp)
3134 s->gc = s->f->output_data.mac->cursor_gc;
3135 else
3136 {
3137 /* Cursor on non-default face: must merge. */
3138 XGCValues xgcv;
3139 unsigned long mask;
3140
3141 xgcv.background = s->f->output_data.mac->cursor_pixel;
3142 xgcv.foreground = s->face->background;
3143
3144 /* If the glyph would be invisible, try a different foreground. */
3145 if (xgcv.foreground == xgcv.background)
3146 xgcv.foreground = s->face->foreground;
3147 if (xgcv.foreground == xgcv.background)
3148 xgcv.foreground = s->f->output_data.mac->cursor_foreground_pixel;
3149 if (xgcv.foreground == xgcv.background)
3150 xgcv.foreground = s->face->foreground;
3151
3152 /* Make sure the cursor is distinct from text in this face. */
3153 if (xgcv.background == s->face->background
3154 && xgcv.foreground == s->face->foreground)
3155 {
3156 xgcv.background = s->face->foreground;
3157 xgcv.foreground = s->face->background;
3158 }
3159
3160 IF_DEBUG (x_check_font (s->f, s->font));
3161 xgcv.font = s->font;
3162 mask = GCForeground | GCBackground | GCFont;
3163
3164 if (FRAME_MAC_DISPLAY_INFO (s->f)->scratch_cursor_gc)
3165 XChangeGC (s->display, FRAME_MAC_DISPLAY_INFO (s->f)->scratch_cursor_gc,
3166 mask, &xgcv);
3167 else
3168 FRAME_MAC_DISPLAY_INFO (s->f)->scratch_cursor_gc
3169 = XCreateGC (s->display, s->window, mask, &xgcv);
3170
3171 s->gc = FRAME_MAC_DISPLAY_INFO (s->f)->scratch_cursor_gc;
3172 }
3173}
3174
3175
3176/* Set up S->gc of glyph string S for drawing text in mouse face. */
3177
3178static void
3179x_set_mouse_face_gc (s)
3180 struct glyph_string *s;
3181{
3182 int face_id;
3183 struct face *face;
3184
3185 /* What face has to be used for the mouse face? */
3186 face_id = FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (s->f)->mouse_face_face_id;
3187 face = FACE_FROM_ID (s->f, face_id);
3188 if (s->first_glyph->type == CHAR_GLYPH)
3189 face_id = FACE_FOR_CHAR (s->f, face, s->first_glyph->u.ch);
3190 else
3191 face_id = FACE_FOR_CHAR (s->f, face, 0);
3192 s->face = FACE_FROM_ID (s->f, face_id);
3193 PREPARE_FACE_FOR_DISPLAY (s->f, s->face);
3194
3195 /* If font in this face is same as S->font, use it. */
3196 if (s->font == s->face->font)
3197 s->gc = s->face->gc;
3198 else
3199 {
3200 /* Otherwise construct scratch_cursor_gc with values from FACE
3201 but font FONT. */
3202 XGCValues xgcv;
3203 unsigned long mask;
3204
3205 xgcv.background = s->face->background;
3206 xgcv.foreground = s->face->foreground;
3207 IF_DEBUG (x_check_font (s->f, s->font));
3208 xgcv.font = s->font;
3209 mask = GCForeground | GCBackground | GCFont;
3210
3211 if (FRAME_MAC_DISPLAY_INFO (s->f)->scratch_cursor_gc)
3212 XChangeGC (s->display, FRAME_MAC_DISPLAY_INFO (s->f)->scratch_cursor_gc,
3213 mask, &xgcv);
3214 else
3215 FRAME_MAC_DISPLAY_INFO (s->f)->scratch_cursor_gc
3216 = XCreateGC (s->display, s->window, mask, &xgcv);
3217
3218 s->gc = FRAME_MAC_DISPLAY_INFO (s->f)->scratch_cursor_gc;
3219 }
3220
3221 xassert (s->gc != 0);
3222}
3223
3224
3225/* Set S->gc of glyph string S to a GC suitable for drawing a mode line.
3226 Faces to use in the mode line have already been computed when the
3227 matrix was built, so there isn't much to do, here. */
3228
3229static INLINE void
3230x_set_mode_line_face_gc (s)
3231 struct glyph_string *s;
3232{
3233 s->gc = s->face->gc;
3234}
3235
3236
3237/* Set S->gc of glyph string S for drawing that glyph string. Set
3238 S->stippled_p to a non-zero value if the face of S has a stipple
3239 pattern. */
3240
3241static INLINE void
3242x_set_glyph_string_gc (s)
3243 struct glyph_string *s;
3244{
3245 PREPARE_FACE_FOR_DISPLAY (s->f, s->face);
3246
3247 if (s->hl == DRAW_NORMAL_TEXT)
3248 {
3249 s->gc = s->face->gc;
3250 s->stippled_p = s->face->stipple != 0;
3251 }
3252 else if (s->hl == DRAW_INVERSE_VIDEO)
3253 {
3254 x_set_mode_line_face_gc (s);
3255 s->stippled_p = s->face->stipple != 0;
3256 }
3257 else if (s->hl == DRAW_CURSOR)
3258 {
3259 x_set_cursor_gc (s);
3260 s->stippled_p = 0;
3261 }
3262 else if (s->hl == DRAW_MOUSE_FACE)
3263 {
3264 x_set_mouse_face_gc (s);
3265 s->stippled_p = s->face->stipple != 0;
3266 }
3267 else if (s->hl == DRAW_IMAGE_RAISED
3268 || s->hl == DRAW_IMAGE_SUNKEN)
3269 {
3270 s->gc = s->face->gc;
3271 s->stippled_p = s->face->stipple != 0;
3272 }
3273 else
3274 {
3275 s->gc = s->face->gc;
3276 s->stippled_p = s->face->stipple != 0;
3277 }
3278
3279 /* GC must have been set. */
3280 xassert (s->gc != 0);
3281}
3282
3283
3284/* Return in *R the clipping rectangle for glyph string S. */
3285
3286static void
3287x_get_glyph_string_clip_rect (s, r)
3288 struct glyph_string *s;
3289 Rect *r;
3290{
3291 int r_height, r_width;
3292
3293 if (s->row->full_width_p)
3294 {
3295 /* Draw full-width. X coordinates are relative to S->w->left. */
3296 int canon_x = CANON_X_UNIT (s->f);
3297
3298 r->left = WINDOW_LEFT_MARGIN (s->w) * canon_x;
3299 r_width = XFASTINT (s->w->width) * canon_x;
3300
3301 if (FRAME_HAS_VERTICAL_SCROLL_BARS (s->f))
3302 {
3303 int width = FRAME_SCROLL_BAR_WIDTH (s->f) * canon_x;
3304 if (FRAME_HAS_VERTICAL_SCROLL_BARS_ON_LEFT (s->f))
3305 r->left -= width;
3306 }
3307
3308 r->left += FRAME_INTERNAL_BORDER_WIDTH (s->f);
3309
3310 /* Unless displaying a mode or menu bar line, which are always
3311 fully visible, clip to the visible part of the row. */
3312 if (s->w->pseudo_window_p)
3313 r_height = s->row->visible_height;
3314 else
3315 r_height = s->height;
3316 }
3317 else
3318 {
3319 /* This is a text line that may be partially visible. */
3320 r->left = WINDOW_AREA_TO_FRAME_PIXEL_X (s->w, s->area, 0);
3321 r_width = window_box_width (s->w, s->area);
3322 r_height = s->row->visible_height;
3323 }
3324
3325 /* Don't use S->y for clipping because it doesn't take partially
3326 visible lines into account. For example, it can be negative for
3327 partially visible lines at the top of a window. */
3328 if (!s->row->full_width_p
3329 && MATRIX_ROW_PARTIALLY_VISIBLE_AT_TOP_P (s->w, s->row))
3330 r->top = WINDOW_DISPLAY_HEADER_LINE_HEIGHT (s->w);
3331 else
3332 r->top = max (0, s->row->y);
3333
3334 /* If drawing a tool-bar window, draw it over the internal border
3335 at the top of the window. */
3336 if (s->w == XWINDOW (s->f->tool_bar_window))
3337 r->top -= s->f->output_data.mac->internal_border_width;
3338
3339 /* If S draws overlapping rows, it's sufficient to use the top and
3340 bottom of the window for clipping because this glyph string
3341 intentionally draws over other lines. */
3342 if (s->for_overlaps_p)
3343 {
3344 r->top = WINDOW_DISPLAY_HEADER_LINE_HEIGHT (s->w);
3345 r_height = window_text_bottom_y (s->w) - r->top;
3346 }
3347
3348 r->top = WINDOW_TO_FRAME_PIXEL_Y (s->w, r->top);
3349
3350 r->bottom = r->top + r_height;
3351 r->right = r->left + r_width;
3352}
3353
3354
3355/* Set clipping for output of glyph string S. S may be part of a mode
3356 line or menu if we don't have X toolkit support. */
3357
3358static INLINE void
3359x_set_glyph_string_clipping (s)
3360 struct glyph_string *s;
3361{
3362 Rect r;
3363 x_get_glyph_string_clip_rect (s, &r);
3364 mac_set_clip_rectangle (s->display, s->window, &r);
3365}
3366
3367
3368/* Compute left and right overhang of glyph string S. If S is a glyph
3369 string for a composition, assume overhangs don't exist. */
3370
3371static INLINE void
3372x_compute_glyph_string_overhangs (s)
3373 struct glyph_string *s;
3374{
3375 if (s->cmp == NULL
3376 && s->first_glyph->type == CHAR_GLYPH)
3377 {
3378 XCharStruct cs;
3379 int direction, font_ascent, font_descent;
3380 XTextExtents16 (s->font, s->char2b, s->nchars, &direction,
3381 &font_ascent, &font_descent, &cs);
3382 s->right_overhang = cs.rbearing > cs.width ? cs.rbearing - cs.width : 0;
3383 s->left_overhang = cs.lbearing < 0 ? -cs.lbearing : 0;
3384 }
3385}
3386
3387
3388/* Compute overhangs and x-positions for glyph string S and its
3389 predecessors, or successors. X is the starting x-position for S.
3390 BACKWARD_P non-zero means process predecessors. */
3391
3392static void
3393x_compute_overhangs_and_x (s, x, backward_p)
3394 struct glyph_string *s;
3395 int x;
3396 int backward_p;
3397{
3398 if (backward_p)
3399 {
3400 while (s)
3401 {
3402 x_compute_glyph_string_overhangs (s);
3403 x -= s->width;
3404 s->x = x;
3405 s = s->prev;
3406 }
3407 }
3408 else
3409 {
3410 while (s)
3411 {
3412 x_compute_glyph_string_overhangs (s);
3413 s->x = x;
3414 x += s->width;
3415 s = s->next;
3416 }
3417 }
3418}
3419
3420
3421/* Set *LEFT and *RIGHT to the left and right overhang of GLYPH on
3422 frame F. Overhangs of glyphs other than type CHAR_GLYPH are
3423 assumed to be zero. */
3424
3425void
3426x_get_glyph_overhangs (glyph, f, left, right)
3427 struct glyph *glyph;
3428 struct frame *f;
3429 int *left, *right;
3430{
3431 *left = *right = 0;
3432
3433 if (glyph->type == CHAR_GLYPH)
3434 {
3435 XFontStruct *font;
3436 struct face *face;
3437 struct font_info *font_info;
3438 XChar2b char2b;
3439 XCharStruct *pcm;
3440
3441 face = x_get_glyph_face_and_encoding (f, glyph, &char2b, NULL);
3442 font = face->font;
3443 font_info = FONT_INFO_FROM_ID (f, face->font_info_id);
3444 if (font
3445 && (pcm = x_per_char_metric (font, &char2b)))
3446 {
3447 if (pcm->rbearing > pcm->width)
3448 *right = pcm->rbearing - pcm->width;
3449 if (pcm->lbearing < 0)
3450 *left = -pcm->lbearing;
3451 }
3452 }
3453}
3454
3455
3456/* Return the index of the first glyph preceding glyph string S that
3457 is overwritten by S because of S's left overhang. Value is -1
3458 if no glyphs are overwritten. */
3459
3460static int
3461x_left_overwritten (s)
3462 struct glyph_string *s;
3463{
3464 int k;
3465
3466 if (s->left_overhang)
3467 {
3468 int x = 0, i;
3469 struct glyph *glyphs = s->row->glyphs[s->area];
3470 int first = s->first_glyph - glyphs;
3471
3472 for (i = first - 1; i >= 0 && x > -s->left_overhang; --i)
3473 x -= glyphs[i].pixel_width;
3474
3475 k = i + 1;
3476 }
3477 else
3478 k = -1;
3479
3480 return k;
3481}
3482
3483
3484/* Return the index of the first glyph preceding glyph string S that
3485 is overwriting S because of its right overhang. Value is -1 if no
3486 glyph in front of S overwrites S. */
3487
3488static int
3489x_left_overwriting (s)
3490 struct glyph_string *s;
3491{
3492 int i, k, x;
3493 struct glyph *glyphs = s->row->glyphs[s->area];
3494 int first = s->first_glyph - glyphs;
3495
3496 k = -1;
3497 x = 0;
3498 for (i = first - 1; i >= 0; --i)
3499 {
3500 int left, right;
3501 x_get_glyph_overhangs (glyphs + i, s->f, &left, &right);
3502 if (x + right > 0)
3503 k = i;
3504 x -= glyphs[i].pixel_width;
3505 }
3506
3507 return k;
3508}
3509
3510
3511/* Return the index of the last glyph following glyph string S that is
3512 not overwritten by S because of S's right overhang. Value is -1 if
3513 no such glyph is found. */
3514
3515static int
3516x_right_overwritten (s)
3517 struct glyph_string *s;
3518{
3519 int k = -1;
3520
3521 if (s->right_overhang)
3522 {
3523 int x = 0, i;
3524 struct glyph *glyphs = s->row->glyphs[s->area];
3525 int first = (s->first_glyph - glyphs) + (s->cmp ? 1 : s->nchars);
3526 int end = s->row->used[s->area];
3527
3528 for (i = first; i < end && s->right_overhang > x; ++i)
3529 x += glyphs[i].pixel_width;
3530
3531 k = i;
3532 }
3533
3534 return k;
3535}
3536
3537
3538/* Return the index of the last glyph following glyph string S that
3539 overwrites S because of its left overhang. Value is negative
3540 if no such glyph is found. */
3541
3542static int
3543x_right_overwriting (s)
3544 struct glyph_string *s;
3545{
3546 int i, k, x;
3547 int end = s->row->used[s->area];
3548 struct glyph *glyphs = s->row->glyphs[s->area];
3549 int first = (s->first_glyph - glyphs) + (s->cmp ? 1 : s->nchars);
3550
3551 k = -1;
3552 x = 0;
3553 for (i = first; i < end; ++i)
3554 {
3555 int left, right;
3556 x_get_glyph_overhangs (glyphs + i, s->f, &left, &right);
3557 if (x - left < 0)
3558 k = i;
3559 x += glyphs[i].pixel_width;
3560 }
3561
3562 return k;
3563}
3564
3565
3566/* Fill rectangle X, Y, W, H with background color of glyph string S. */
3567
3568static INLINE void
3569x_clear_glyph_string_rect (s, x, y, w, h)
3570 struct glyph_string *s;
3571 int x, y, w, h;
3572{
3573 XGCValues xgcv;
3574
3575 xgcv.foreground = s->gc->background;
3576 XFillRectangle (s->display, s->window, &xgcv, x, y, w, h);
3577}
3578
3579
3580/* Draw the background of glyph_string S. If S->background_filled_p
3581 is non-zero don't draw it. FORCE_P non-zero means draw the
3582 background even if it wouldn't be drawn normally. This is used
3583 when a string preceding S draws into the background of S, or S
3584 contains the first component of a composition. */
3585
3586static void
3587x_draw_glyph_string_background (s, force_p)
3588 struct glyph_string *s;
3589 int force_p;
3590{
3591 /* Nothing to do if background has already been drawn or if it
3592 shouldn't be drawn in the first place. */
3593 if (!s->background_filled_p)
3594 {
3595#if 0 /* MAC_TODO: stipple */
3596 if (s->stippled_p)
3597 {
3598 /* Fill background with a stipple pattern. */
3599 XSetFillStyle (s->display, s->gc, FillOpaqueStippled);
3600 XFillRectangle (s->display, s->window, s->gc, s->x,
3601 s->y + s->face->box_line_width,
3602 s->background_width,
3603 s->height - 2 * s->face->box_line_width);
3604 XSetFillStyle (s->display, s->gc, FillSolid);
3605 s->background_filled_p = 1;
3606 }
3607 else
3608#endif
3609 if (FONT_HEIGHT (s->font) < s->height - 2 * s->face->box_line_width
3610 || s->font_not_found_p
3611 || s->extends_to_end_of_line_p
3612 || force_p)
3613 {
3614 x_clear_glyph_string_rect (s, s->x, s->y + s->face->box_line_width,
3615 s->background_width,
3616 s->height - 2 * s->face->box_line_width);
3617 s->background_filled_p = 1;
3618 }
3619 }
3620}
3621
3622
3623/* Draw the foreground of glyph string S. */
3624
3625static void
3626x_draw_glyph_string_foreground (s)
3627 struct glyph_string *s;
3628{
3629 int i, x;
3630
3631 /* If first glyph of S has a left box line, start drawing the text
3632 of S to the right of that box line. */
3633 if (s->face->box != FACE_NO_BOX
3634 && s->first_glyph->left_box_line_p)
3635 x = s->x + s->face->box_line_width;
3636 else
3637 x = s->x;
3638
3639 /* Draw characters of S as rectangles if S's font could not be
3640 loaded. */
3641 if (s->font_not_found_p)
3642 {
3643 for (i = 0; i < s->nchars; ++i)
3644 {
3645 struct glyph *g = s->first_glyph + i;
3646 mac_draw_rectangle (s->display, s->window,
3647 s->gc, x, s->y, g->pixel_width - 1,
3648 s->height - 1);
3649 x += g->pixel_width;
3650 }
3651 }
3652 else
3653 {
3654 char *char1b = (char *) s->char2b;
3655 int boff = s->font_info->baseline_offset;
3656
3657 if (s->font_info->vertical_centering)
3658 boff = VCENTER_BASELINE_OFFSET (s->font, s->f) - boff;
3659
3660 /* If we can use 8-bit functions, condense S->char2b. */
3661 if (!s->two_byte_p)
3662 for (i = 0; i < s->nchars; ++i)
3663 char1b[i] = s->char2b[i].byte2;
3664
3665 /* Draw text with XDrawString if background has already been
3666 filled. Otherwise, use XDrawImageString. (Note that
3667 XDrawImageString is usually faster than XDrawString.) Always
3668 use XDrawImageString when drawing the cursor so that there is
3669 no chance that characters under a box cursor are invisible. */
3670 if (s->for_overlaps_p
3671 || (s->background_filled_p && s->hl != DRAW_CURSOR))
3672 {
3673 /* Draw characters with 16-bit or 8-bit functions. */
3674 if (s->two_byte_p)
3675 XDrawString16 (s->display, s->window, s->gc, x,
3676 s->ybase - boff, s->char2b, s->nchars);
3677 else
3678 XDrawString (s->display, s->window, s->gc, x,
3679 s->ybase - boff, char1b, s->nchars);
3680 }
3681 else
3682 {
3683 if (s->two_byte_p)
3684 XDrawImageString16 (s->display, s->window, s->gc, x,
3685 s->ybase - boff, s->char2b, s->nchars);
3686 else
3687 XDrawImageString (s->display, s->window, s->gc, x,
3688 s->ybase - boff, char1b, s->nchars);
3689 }
3690 }
3691}
3692
3693/* Draw the foreground of composite glyph string S. */
3694
3695static void
3696x_draw_composite_glyph_string_foreground (s)
3697 struct glyph_string *s;
3698{
3699 int i, x;
3700
3701 /* If first glyph of S has a left box line, start drawing the text
3702 of S to the right of that box line. */
3703 if (s->face->box != FACE_NO_BOX
3704 && s->first_glyph->left_box_line_p)
3705 x = s->x + s->face->box_line_width;
3706 else
3707 x = s->x;
3708
3709 /* S is a glyph string for a composition. S->gidx is the index of
3710 the first character drawn for glyphs of this composition.
3711 S->gidx == 0 means we are drawing the very first character of
3712 this composition. */
3713
3714 /* Draw a rectangle for the composition if the font for the very
3715 first character of the composition could not be loaded. */
3716 if (s->font_not_found_p)
3717 {
3718 if (s->gidx == 0)
3719 mac_draw_rectangle (s->display, s->window, s->gc, x, s->y,
3720 s->width - 1, s->height - 1);
3721 }
3722 else
3723 {
3724 for (i = 0; i < s->nchars; i++, ++s->gidx)
3725 XDrawString16 (s->display, s->window, s->gc,
3726 x + s->cmp->offsets[s->gidx * 2],
3727 s->ybase - s->cmp->offsets[s->gidx * 2 + 1],
3728 s->char2b + i, 1);
3729 }
3730}
3731
3732
3733#ifdef USE_X_TOOLKIT
3734
3735static struct frame *x_frame_of_widget P_ ((Widget));
3736
3737
3738/* Return the frame on which widget WIDGET is used.. Abort if frame
3739 cannot be determined. */
3740
3741static struct frame *
3742x_frame_of_widget (widget)
3743 Widget widget;
3744{
3745 struct x_display_info *dpyinfo;
3746 Lisp_Object tail;
3747 struct frame *f;
3748
3749 dpyinfo = x_display_info_for_display (XtDisplay (widget));
3750
3751 /* Find the top-level shell of the widget. Note that this function
3752 can be called when the widget is not yet realized, so XtWindow
3753 (widget) == 0. That's the reason we can't simply use
3754 x_any_window_to_frame. */
3755 while (!XtIsTopLevelShell (widget))
3756 widget = XtParent (widget);
3757
3758 /* Look for a frame with that top-level widget. Allocate the color
3759 on that frame to get the right gamma correction value. */
3760 for (tail = Vframe_list; GC_CONSP (tail); tail = XCDR (tail))
3761 if (GC_FRAMEP (XCAR (tail))
3762 && (f = XFRAME (XCAR (tail)),
3763 (f->output_data.nothing != 1
3764 && FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f) == dpyinfo))
3765 && f->output_data.x->widget == widget)
3766 return f;
3767
3768 abort ();
3769}
3770
3771
3772/* Allocate the color COLOR->pixel on the screen and display of
3773 widget WIDGET in colormap CMAP. If an exact match cannot be
3774 allocated, try the nearest color available. Value is non-zero
3775 if successful. This is called from lwlib. */
3776
3777int
3778x_alloc_nearest_color_for_widget (widget, cmap, color)
3779 Widget widget;
3780 Colormap cmap;
3781 XColor *color;
3782{
3783 struct frame *f = x_frame_of_widget (widget);
3784 return x_alloc_nearest_color (f, cmap, color);
3785}
3786
3787
3788#endif /* USE_X_TOOLKIT */
3789
3790#if 0
3791
3792/* Allocate the color COLOR->pixel on SCREEN of DISPLAY, colormap
3793 CMAP. If an exact match can't be allocated, try the nearest color
3794 available. Value is non-zero if successful. Set *COLOR to the
3795 color allocated. */
3796
3797int
3798x_alloc_nearest_color (f, cmap, color)
3799 struct frame *f;
3800 Colormap cmap;
3801 XColor *color;
3802{
3803 Display *display = FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f);
3804 Screen *screen = FRAME_X_SCREEN (f);
3805 int rc;
3806
3807 gamma_correct (f, color);
3808 rc = XAllocColor (display, cmap, color);
3809 if (rc == 0)
3810 {
3811 /* If we got to this point, the colormap is full, so we're going
3812 to try to get the next closest color. The algorithm used is
3813 a least-squares matching, which is what X uses for closest
3814 color matching with StaticColor visuals. */
3815 int nearest, i;
3816 unsigned long nearest_delta = ~0;
3817 int ncells = XDisplayCells (display, XScreenNumberOfScreen (screen));
3818 XColor *cells = (XColor *) alloca (ncells * sizeof *cells);
3819
3820 for (i = 0; i < ncells; ++i)
3821 cells[i].pixel = i;
3822 XQueryColors (display, cmap, cells, ncells);
3823
3824 for (nearest = i = 0; i < ncells; ++i)
3825 {
3826 long dred = (color->red >> 8) - (cells[i].red >> 8);
3827 long dgreen = (color->green >> 8) - (cells[i].green >> 8);
3828 long dblue = (color->blue >> 8) - (cells[i].blue >> 8);
3829 unsigned long delta = dred * dred + dgreen * dgreen + dblue * dblue;
3830
3831 if (delta < nearest_delta)
3832 {
3833 nearest = i;
3834 nearest_delta = delta;
3835 }
3836 }
3837
3838 color->red = cells[nearest].red;
3839 color->green = cells[nearest].green;
3840 color->blue = cells[nearest].blue;
3841 rc = XAllocColor (display, cmap, color);
3842 }
3843
3844#ifdef DEBUG_X_COLORS
3845 if (rc)
3846 register_color (color->pixel);
3847#endif /* DEBUG_X_COLORS */
3848
3849 return rc;
3850}
3851
3852
3853/* Allocate color PIXEL on frame F. PIXEL must already be allocated.
3854 It's necessary to do this instead of just using PIXEL directly to
3855 get color reference counts right. */
3856
3857unsigned long
3858x_copy_color (f, pixel)
3859 struct frame *f;
3860 unsigned long pixel;
3861{
3862 XColor color;
3863
3864 color.pixel = pixel;
3865 BLOCK_INPUT;
3866 XQueryColor (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_X_COLORMAP (f), &color);
3867 XAllocColor (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_X_COLORMAP (f), &color);
3868 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
3869#ifdef DEBUG_X_COLORS
3870 register_color (pixel);
3871#endif
3872 return color.pixel;
3873}
3874
3875
3876/* Allocate color PIXEL on display DPY. PIXEL must already be allocated.
3877 It's necessary to do this instead of just using PIXEL directly to
3878 get color reference counts right. */
3879
3880unsigned long
3881x_copy_dpy_color (dpy, cmap, pixel)
3882 Display *dpy;
3883 Colormap cmap;
3884 unsigned long pixel;
3885{
3886 XColor color;
3887
3888 color.pixel = pixel;
3889 BLOCK_INPUT;
3890 XQueryColor (dpy, cmap, &color);
3891 XAllocColor (dpy, cmap, &color);
3892 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
3893#ifdef DEBUG_X_COLORS
3894 register_color (pixel);
3895#endif
3896 return color.pixel;
3897}
3898
3899#endif
3900
3901/* Allocate a color which is lighter or darker than *COLOR by FACTOR
3902 or DELTA. Try a color with RGB values multiplied by FACTOR first.
3903 If this produces the same color as COLOR, try a color where all RGB
3904 values have DELTA added. Return the allocated color in *COLOR.
3905 DISPLAY is the X display, CMAP is the colormap to operate on.
3906 Value is non-zero if successful. */
3907
3908static int
3909mac_alloc_lighter_color (f, color, factor, delta)
3910 struct frame *f;
3911 unsigned long *color;
3912 double factor;
3913 int delta;
3914{
3915 unsigned long new;
3916
3917 /* Change RGB values by specified FACTOR. Avoid overflow! */
3918 xassert (factor >= 0);
3919 new = RGB_TO_ULONG (min (0xff, (int) (factor * RED_FROM_ULONG (*color))),
3920 min (0xff, (int) (factor * GREEN_FROM_ULONG (*color))),
3921 min (0xff, (int) (factor * BLUE_FROM_ULONG (*color))));
3922 if (new == *color)
3923 new = RGB_TO_ULONG (max (0, min (0xff, (int) (delta + RED_FROM_ULONG (*color)))),
3924 max (0, min (0xff, (int) (delta + GREEN_FROM_ULONG (*color)))),
3925 max (0, min (0xff, (int) (delta + BLUE_FROM_ULONG (*color)))));
3926
3927 /* MAC_TODO: Map to palette and retry with delta if same? */
3928 /* MAC_TODO: Free colors (if using palette)? */
3929
3930 if (new == *color)
3931 return 0;
3932
3933 *color = new;
3934
3935 return 1;
3936}
3937
3938
3939/* Set up the foreground color for drawing relief lines of glyph
3940 string S. RELIEF is a pointer to a struct relief containing the GC
3941 with which lines will be drawn. Use a color that is FACTOR or
3942 DELTA lighter or darker than the relief's background which is found
3943 in S->f->output_data.x->relief_background. If such a color cannot
3944 be allocated, use DEFAULT_PIXEL, instead. */
3945
3946static void
3947x_setup_relief_color (f, relief, factor, delta, default_pixel)
3948 struct frame *f;
3949 struct relief *relief;
3950 double factor;
3951 int delta;
3952 unsigned long default_pixel;
3953{
3954 XGCValues xgcv;
3955 struct mac_output *di = f->output_data.mac;
3956 unsigned long mask = GCForeground;
3957 unsigned long pixel;
3958 unsigned long background = di->relief_background;
3959 struct mac_display_info *dpyinfo = FRAME_MAC_DISPLAY_INFO (f);
3960
3961 /* MAC_TODO: Free colors (if using palette)? */
3962
3963 /* Allocate new color. */
3964 xgcv.foreground = default_pixel;
3965 pixel = background;
3966 if (mac_alloc_lighter_color (f, &pixel, factor, delta))
3967 {
3968 relief->allocated_p = 1;
3969 xgcv.foreground = relief->pixel = pixel;
3970 }
3971
3972 if (relief->gc == 0)
3973 {
3974#if 0 /* MAC_TODO: stipple */
3975 xgcv.stipple = dpyinfo->gray;
3976 mask |= GCStipple;
3977#endif
3978 relief->gc = XCreateGC (NULL, FRAME_MAC_WINDOW (f), mask, &xgcv);
3979 }
3980 else
3981 XChangeGC (NULL, relief->gc, mask, &xgcv);
3982}
3983
3984
3985/* Set up colors for the relief lines around glyph string S. */
3986
3987static void
3988x_setup_relief_colors (s)
3989 struct glyph_string *s;
3990{
3991 struct mac_output *di = s->f->output_data.mac;
3992 unsigned long color;
3993
3994 if (s->face->use_box_color_for_shadows_p)
3995 color = s->face->box_color;
3996 else
3997 {
3998 XGCValues xgcv;
3999
4000 /* Get the background color of the face. */
4001 XGetGCValues (s->display, s->gc, GCBackground, &xgcv);
4002 color = xgcv.background;
4003 }
4004
4005 if (di->white_relief.gc == 0
4006 || color != di->relief_background)
4007 {
4008 di->relief_background = color;
4009 x_setup_relief_color (s->f, &di->white_relief, 1.2, 0x8000,
4010 WHITE_PIX_DEFAULT (s->f));
4011 x_setup_relief_color (s->f, &di->black_relief, 0.6, 0x4000,
4012 BLACK_PIX_DEFAULT (s->f));
4013 }
4014}
4015
4016
4017/* Draw a relief on frame F inside the rectangle given by LEFT_X,
4018 TOP_Y, RIGHT_X, and BOTTOM_Y. WIDTH is the thickness of the relief
4019 to draw, it must be >= 0. RAISED_P non-zero means draw a raised
4020 relief. LEFT_P non-zero means draw a relief on the left side of
4021 the rectangle. RIGHT_P non-zero means draw a relief on the right
4022 side of the rectangle. CLIP_RECT is the clipping rectangle to use
4023 when drawing. */
4024
4025static void
4026x_draw_relief_rect (f, left_x, top_y, right_x, bottom_y, width,
4027 raised_p, left_p, right_p, clip_rect)
4028 struct frame *f;
4029 int left_x, top_y, right_x, bottom_y, left_p, right_p, raised_p;
4030 Rect *clip_rect;
4031{
4032 int i;
4033 GC gc;
4034
4035 if (raised_p)
4036 gc = f->output_data.mac->white_relief.gc;
4037 else
4038 gc = f->output_data.mac->black_relief.gc;
4039 mac_set_clip_rectangle (FRAME_MAC_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_MAC_WINDOW (f), clip_rect);
4040
4041 /* Top. */
4042 for (i = 0; i < width; ++i)
4043 XDrawLine (FRAME_MAC_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_MAC_WINDOW (f), gc,
4044 left_x + i * left_p, top_y + i,
4045 right_x + 1 - i * right_p, top_y + i);
4046
4047 /* Left. */
4048 if (left_p)
4049 for (i = 0; i < width; ++i)
4050 XDrawLine (FRAME_MAC_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_MAC_WINDOW (f), gc,
4051 left_x + i, top_y + i, left_x + i, bottom_y - i);
4052
4053 mac_reset_clipping (FRAME_MAC_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_MAC_WINDOW (f));
4054 if (raised_p)
4055 gc = f->output_data.mac->black_relief.gc;
4056 else
4057 gc = f->output_data.mac->white_relief.gc;
4058 mac_set_clip_rectangle (FRAME_MAC_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_MAC_WINDOW (f), clip_rect);
4059
4060 /* Bottom. */
4061 for (i = 0; i < width; ++i)
4062 XDrawLine (FRAME_MAC_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_MAC_WINDOW (f), gc,
4063 left_x + i * left_p, bottom_y - i,
4064 right_x + 1 - i * right_p, bottom_y - i);
4065
4066 /* Right. */
4067 if (right_p)
4068 for (i = 0; i < width; ++i)
4069 XDrawLine (FRAME_MAC_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_MAC_WINDOW (f), gc,
4070 right_x - i, top_y + i + 1, right_x - i, bottom_y - i);
4071
4072 mac_reset_clipping (FRAME_MAC_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_MAC_WINDOW (f));
4073}
4074
4075
4076/* Draw a box on frame F inside the rectangle given by LEFT_X, TOP_Y,
4077 RIGHT_X, and BOTTOM_Y. WIDTH is the thickness of the lines to
4078 draw, it must be >= 0. LEFT_P non-zero means draw a line on the
4079 left side of the rectangle. RIGHT_P non-zero means draw a line
4080 on the right side of the rectangle. CLIP_RECT is the clipping
4081 rectangle to use when drawing. */
4082
4083static void
4084x_draw_box_rect (s, left_x, top_y, right_x, bottom_y, width,
4085 left_p, right_p, clip_rect)
4086 struct glyph_string *s;
4087 int left_x, top_y, right_x, bottom_y, left_p, right_p;
4088 Rect *clip_rect;
4089{
4090 XGCValues xgcv;
4091
4092 xgcv.foreground = s->face->box_color;
4093 mac_set_clip_rectangle (s->display, s->window, clip_rect);
4094
4095 /* Top. */
4096 XFillRectangle (s->display, s->window, &xgcv,
4097 left_x, top_y, right_x - left_x, width);
4098
4099 /* Left. */
4100 if (left_p)
4101 XFillRectangle (s->display, s->window, &xgcv,
4102 left_x, top_y, width, bottom_y - top_y);
4103
4104 /* Bottom. */
4105 XFillRectangle (s->display, s->window, &xgcv,
4106 left_x, bottom_y - width, right_x - left_x, width);
4107
4108 /* Right. */
4109 if (right_p)
4110 XFillRectangle (s->display, s->window, &xgcv,
4111 right_x - width, top_y, width, bottom_y - top_y);
4112
4113 mac_reset_clipping (s->display, s->window);
4114}
4115
4116
4117/* Draw a box around glyph string S. */
4118
4119static void
4120x_draw_glyph_string_box (s)
4121 struct glyph_string *s;
4122{
4123 int width, left_x, right_x, top_y, bottom_y, last_x, raised_p;
4124 int left_p, right_p;
4125 struct glyph *last_glyph;
4126 Rect clip_rect;
4127
4128 last_x = window_box_right (s->w, s->area);
4129 if (s->row->full_width_p
4130 && !s->w->pseudo_window_p)
4131 {
4132 last_x += FRAME_X_RIGHT_FLAGS_AREA_WIDTH (s->f);
4133 if (FRAME_HAS_VERTICAL_SCROLL_BARS_ON_RIGHT (s->f))
4134 last_x += FRAME_SCROLL_BAR_WIDTH (s->f) * CANON_X_UNIT (s->f);
4135 }
4136
4137 /* The glyph that may have a right box line. */
4138 last_glyph = (s->cmp || s->img
4139 ? s->first_glyph
4140 : s->first_glyph + s->nchars - 1);
4141
4142 width = s->face->box_line_width;
4143 raised_p = s->face->box == FACE_RAISED_BOX;
4144 left_x = s->x;
4145 right_x = ((s->row->full_width_p
4146 ? last_x - 1
4147 : min (last_x, s->x + s->background_width) - 1));
4148 top_y = s->y;
4149 bottom_y = top_y + s->height - 1;
4150
4151 left_p = (s->first_glyph->left_box_line_p
4152 || (s->hl == DRAW_MOUSE_FACE
4153 && (s->prev == NULL
4154 || s->prev->hl != s->hl)));
4155 right_p = (last_glyph->right_box_line_p
4156 || (s->hl == DRAW_MOUSE_FACE
4157 && (s->next == NULL
4158 || s->next->hl != s->hl)));
4159
4160 x_get_glyph_string_clip_rect (s, &clip_rect);
4161
4162 if (s->face->box == FACE_SIMPLE_BOX)
4163 x_draw_box_rect (s, left_x, top_y, right_x, bottom_y, width,
4164 left_p, right_p, &clip_rect);
4165 else
4166 {
4167 x_setup_relief_colors (s);
4168 x_draw_relief_rect (s->f, left_x, top_y, right_x, bottom_y,
4169 width, raised_p, left_p, right_p, &clip_rect);
4170 }
4171}
4172
4173
4174/* Draw foreground of image glyph string S. */
4175
4176static void
4177x_draw_image_foreground (s)
4178 struct glyph_string *s;
4179{
4180 int x;
4181 int y = s->ybase - image_ascent (s->img, s->face);
4182
4183 /* If first glyph of S has a left box line, start drawing it to the
4184 right of that line. */
4185 if (s->face->box != FACE_NO_BOX
4186 && s->first_glyph->left_box_line_p)
4187 x = s->x + s->face->box_line_width;
4188 else
4189 x = s->x;
4190
4191 /* If there is a margin around the image, adjust x- and y-position
4192 by that margin. */
4193 if (s->img->margin)
4194 {
4195 x += s->img->margin;
4196 y += s->img->margin;
4197 }
4198
4199 if (s->img->pixmap)
4200 {
4201#if 0 /* MAC_TODO: image mask */
4202 if (s->img->mask)
4203 {
4204 /* We can't set both a clip mask and use XSetClipRectangles
4205 because the latter also sets a clip mask. We also can't
4206 trust on the shape extension to be available
4207 (XShapeCombineRegion). So, compute the rectangle to draw
4208 manually. */
4209 unsigned long mask = (GCClipMask | GCClipXOrigin | GCClipYOrigin
4210 | GCFunction);
4211 XGCValues xgcv;
4212 XRectangle clip_rect, image_rect, r;
4213
4214 xgcv.clip_mask = s->img->mask;
4215 xgcv.clip_x_origin = x;
4216 xgcv.clip_y_origin = y;
4217 xgcv.function = GXcopy;
4218 XChangeGC (s->display, s->gc, mask, &xgcv);
4219
4220 x_get_glyph_string_clip_rect (s, &clip_rect);
4221 image_rect.x = x;
4222 image_rect.y = y;
4223 image_rect.width = s->img->width;
4224 image_rect.height = s->img->height;
4225 if (x_intersect_rectangles (&clip_rect, &image_rect, &r))
4226 XCopyArea (s->display, s->img->pixmap, s->window, s->gc,
4227 r.x - x, r.y - y, r.width, r.height, r.x, r.y);
4228 }
4229 else
4230#endif
4231 {
4232 mac_copy_area (s->display, s->img->pixmap, s->window, s->gc,
4233 0, 0, s->img->width, s->img->height, x, y);
4234
4235 /* When the image has a mask, we can expect that at
4236 least part of a mouse highlight or a block cursor will
4237 be visible. If the image doesn't have a mask, make
4238 a block cursor visible by drawing a rectangle around
4239 the image. I believe it's looking better if we do
4240 nothing here for mouse-face. */
4241 if (s->hl == DRAW_CURSOR)
4242 mac_draw_rectangle (s->display, s->window, s->gc, x, y,
4243 s->img->width - 1, s->img->height - 1);
4244 }
4245 }
4246 else
4247 /* Draw a rectangle if image could not be loaded. */
4248 mac_draw_rectangle (s->display, s->window, s->gc, x, y,
4249 s->img->width - 1, s->img->height - 1);
4250}
4251
4252
4253/* Draw a relief around the image glyph string S. */
4254
4255static void
4256x_draw_image_relief (s)
4257 struct glyph_string *s;
4258{
4259 int x0, y0, x1, y1, thick, raised_p;
4260 Rect r;
4261 int x;
4262 int y = s->ybase - image_ascent (s->img, s->face);
4263
4264 /* If first glyph of S has a left box line, start drawing it to the
4265 right of that line. */
4266 if (s->face->box != FACE_NO_BOX
4267 && s->first_glyph->left_box_line_p)
4268 x = s->x + s->face->box_line_width;
4269 else
4270 x = s->x;
4271
4272 /* If there is a margin around the image, adjust x- and y-position
4273 by that margin. */
4274 if (s->img->margin)
4275 {
4276 x += s->img->margin;
4277 y += s->img->margin;
4278 }
4279
4280 if (s->hl == DRAW_IMAGE_SUNKEN
4281 || s->hl == DRAW_IMAGE_RAISED)
4282 {
4283 thick = tool_bar_button_relief > 0 ? tool_bar_button_relief : 3;
4284 raised_p = s->hl == DRAW_IMAGE_RAISED;
4285 }
4286 else
4287 {
4288 thick = abs (s->img->relief);
4289 raised_p = s->img->relief > 0;
4290 }
4291
4292 x0 = x - thick;
4293 y0 = y - thick;
4294 x1 = x + s->img->width + thick - 1;
4295 y1 = y + s->img->height + thick - 1;
4296
4297 x_setup_relief_colors (s);
4298 x_get_glyph_string_clip_rect (s, &r);
4299 x_draw_relief_rect (s->f, x0, y0, x1, y1, thick, raised_p, 1, 1, &r);
4300}
4301
4302
4303/* Draw the foreground of image glyph string S to PIXMAP. */
4304
4305static void
4306x_draw_image_foreground_1 (s, pixmap)
4307 struct glyph_string *s;
4308 Pixmap pixmap;
4309{
4310 int x;
4311 int y = s->ybase - s->y - image_ascent (s->img, s->face);
4312
4313 /* If first glyph of S has a left box line, start drawing it to the
4314 right of that line. */
4315 if (s->face->box != FACE_NO_BOX
4316 && s->first_glyph->left_box_line_p)
4317 x = s->face->box_line_width;
4318 else
4319 x = 0;
4320
4321 /* If there is a margin around the image, adjust x- and y-position
4322 by that margin. */
4323 if (s->img->margin)
4324 {
4325 x += s->img->margin;
4326 y += s->img->margin;
4327 }
4328
4329 if (s->img->pixmap)
4330 {
4331#if 0 /* MAC_TODO: image mask */
4332 if (s->img->mask)
4333 {
4334 /* We can't set both a clip mask and use XSetClipRectangles
4335 because the latter also sets a clip mask. We also can't
4336 trust on the shape extension to be available
4337 (XShapeCombineRegion). So, compute the rectangle to draw
4338 manually. */
4339 unsigned long mask = (GCClipMask | GCClipXOrigin | GCClipYOrigin
4340 | GCFunction);
4341 XGCValues xgcv;
4342
4343 xgcv.clip_mask = s->img->mask;
4344 xgcv.clip_x_origin = x;
4345 xgcv.clip_y_origin = y;
4346 xgcv.function = GXcopy;
4347 XChangeGC (s->display, s->gc, mask, &xgcv);
4348
4349 XCopyArea (s->display, s->img->pixmap, pixmap, s->gc,
4350 0, 0, s->img->width, s->img->height, x, y);
4351 XSetClipMask (s->display, s->gc, None);
4352 }
4353 else
4354#endif
4355 {
4356 mac_copy_area_to_pixmap (s->display, s->img->pixmap, pixmap, s->gc,
4357 0, 0, s->img->width, s->img->height, x, y);
4358
4359 /* When the image has a mask, we can expect that at
4360 least part of a mouse highlight or a block cursor will
4361 be visible. If the image doesn't have a mask, make
4362 a block cursor visible by drawing a rectangle around
4363 the image. I believe it's looking better if we do
4364 nothing here for mouse-face. */
4365 if (s->hl == DRAW_CURSOR)
4366 mac_draw_rectangle_to_pixmap (s->display, pixmap, s->gc, x, y,
4367 s->img->width - 1, s->img->height - 1);
4368 }
4369 }
4370 else
4371 /* Draw a rectangle if image could not be loaded. */
4372 mac_draw_rectangle_to_pixmap (s->display, pixmap, s->gc, x, y,
4373 s->img->width - 1, s->img->height - 1);
4374}
4375
4376
4377/* Draw part of the background of glyph string S. X, Y, W, and H
4378 give the rectangle to draw. */
4379
4380static void
4381x_draw_glyph_string_bg_rect (s, x, y, w, h)
4382 struct glyph_string *s;
4383 int x, y, w, h;
4384{
4385#if 0 /* MAC_TODO: stipple */
4386 if (s->stippled_p)
4387 {
4388 /* Fill background with a stipple pattern. */
4389 XSetFillStyle (s->display, s->gc, FillOpaqueStippled);
4390 XFillRectangle (s->display, s->window, s->gc, x, y, w, h);
4391 XSetFillStyle (s->display, s->gc, FillSolid);
4392 }
4393 else
4394#endif
4395 x_clear_glyph_string_rect (s, x, y, w, h);
4396}
4397
4398
4399/* Draw image glyph string S.
4400
4401 s->y
4402 s->x +-------------------------
4403 | s->face->box
4404 |
4405 | +-------------------------
4406 | | s->img->margin
4407 | |
4408 | | +-------------------
4409 | | | the image
4410
4411 */
4412
4413static void
4414x_draw_image_glyph_string (s)
4415 struct glyph_string *s;
4416{
4417 int x, y;
4418 int box_line_width = s->face->box_line_width;
4419 int margin = s->img->margin;
4420 int height;
4421 Pixmap pixmap = 0;
4422
4423 height = s->height - 2 * box_line_width;
4424
4425 /* Fill background with face under the image. Do it only if row is
4426 taller than image or if image has a clip mask to reduce
4427 flickering. */
4428 s->stippled_p = s->face->stipple != 0;
4429 if (height > s->img->height
4430 || margin
4431#if 0 /* MAC_TODO: image mask */
4432 || s->img->mask
4433#endif
4434 || s->img->pixmap == 0
4435 || s->width != s->background_width)
4436 {
4437 if (box_line_width && s->first_glyph->left_box_line_p)
4438 x = s->x + box_line_width;
4439 else
4440 x = s->x;
4441
4442 y = s->y + box_line_width;
4443
4444#if 0 /* MAC_TODO: image mask */
4445 if (s->img->mask)
4446 {
4447 /* Create a pixmap as large as the glyph string Fill it with
4448 the background color. Copy the image to it, using its
4449 mask. Copy the temporary pixmap to the display. */
4450 Screen *screen = FRAME_X_SCREEN (s->f);
4451 int depth = DefaultDepthOfScreen (screen);
4452
4453 /* Create a pixmap as large as the glyph string. */
4454 pixmap = XCreatePixmap (s->display, s->window,
4455 s->background_width,
4456 s->height, depth);
4457
4458 /* Don't clip in the following because we're working on the
4459 pixmap. */
4460 XSetClipMask (s->display, s->gc, None);
4461
4462 /* Fill the pixmap with the background color/stipple. */
4463 if (s->stippled_p)
4464 {
4465 /* Fill background with a stipple pattern. */
4466 XSetFillStyle (s->display, s->gc, FillOpaqueStippled);
4467 XFillRectangle (s->display, pixmap, s->gc,
4468 0, 0, s->background_width, s->height);
4469 XSetFillStyle (s->display, s->gc, FillSolid);
4470 }
4471 else
4472 {
4473 XGCValues xgcv;
4474 XGetGCValues (s->display, s->gc, GCForeground | GCBackground,
4475 &xgcv);
4476 XSetForeground (s->display, s->gc, xgcv.background);
4477 XFillRectangle (s->display, pixmap, s->gc,
4478 0, 0, s->background_width, s->height);
4479 XSetForeground (s->display, s->gc, xgcv.foreground);
4480 }
4481 }
4482 else
4483#endif
4484 /* Implementation idea: Is it possible to construct a mask?
4485 We could look at the color at the margins of the image, and
4486 say that this color is probably the background color of the
4487 image. */
4488 x_draw_glyph_string_bg_rect (s, x, y, s->background_width, height);
4489
4490 s->background_filled_p = 1;
4491 }
4492
4493 /* Draw the foreground. */
4494 if (pixmap != 0)
4495 {
4496 x_draw_image_foreground_1 (s, pixmap);
4497 x_set_glyph_string_clipping (s);
4498 mac_copy_area (s->display, pixmap, s->window, s->gc,
4499 0, 0, s->background_width, s->height, s->x, s->y);
4500 XFreePixmap (s->display, pixmap);
4501 }
4502 else
4503 x_draw_image_foreground (s);
4504
4505 /* If we must draw a relief around the image, do it. */
4506 if (s->img->relief
4507 || s->hl == DRAW_IMAGE_RAISED
4508 || s->hl == DRAW_IMAGE_SUNKEN)
4509 x_draw_image_relief (s);
4510}
4511
4512
4513/* Draw stretch glyph string S. */
4514
4515static void
4516x_draw_stretch_glyph_string (s)
4517 struct glyph_string *s;
4518{
4519 xassert (s->first_glyph->type == STRETCH_GLYPH);
4520 s->stippled_p = s->face->stipple != 0;
4521
4522 if (s->hl == DRAW_CURSOR
4523 && !x_stretch_cursor_p)
4524 {
4525 /* If `x-stretch-block-cursor' is nil, don't draw a block cursor
4526 as wide as the stretch glyph. */
4527 int width = min (CANON_X_UNIT (s->f), s->background_width);
4528
4529 /* Draw cursor. */
4530 x_draw_glyph_string_bg_rect (s, s->x, s->y, width, s->height);
4531
4532 /* Clear rest using the GC of the original non-cursor face. */
4533 if (width < s->background_width)
4534 {
4535 GC gc = s->face->gc;
4536 int x = s->x + width, y = s->y;
4537 int w = s->background_width - width, h = s->height;
4538 Rect r;
4539
4540 x_get_glyph_string_clip_rect (s, &r);
4541 mac_set_clip_rectangle (s->display, s->window, &r);
4542
4543#if 0 /* MAC_TODO: stipple */
4544 if (s->face->stipple)
4545 {
4546 /* Fill background with a stipple pattern. */
4547 XSetFillStyle (s->display, gc, FillOpaqueStippled);
4548 XFillRectangle (s->display, s->window, gc, x, y, w, h);
4549 XSetFillStyle (s->display, gc, FillSolid);
4550 }
4551 else
4552#endif
4553 {
4554 XGCValues xgcv;
4555 XGetGCValues (s->display, gc, GCForeground | GCBackground, &xgcv);
4556 XSetForeground (s->display, gc, xgcv.background);
4557 XFillRectangle (s->display, s->window, gc, x, y, w, h);
4558 XSetForeground (s->display, gc, xgcv.foreground);
4559 }
4560 }
4561 }
4562 else
4563 x_draw_glyph_string_bg_rect (s, s->x, s->y, s->background_width,
4564 s->height);
4565
4566 s->background_filled_p = 1;
4567}
4568
4569
4570/* Draw glyph string S. */
4571
4572static void
4573x_draw_glyph_string (s)
4574 struct glyph_string *s;
4575{
4576 /* If S draws into the background of its successor, draw the
4577 background of the successor first so that S can draw into it.
4578 This makes S->next use XDrawString instead of XDrawImageString. */
4579 if (s->next && s->right_overhang && !s->for_overlaps_p)
4580 {
4581 xassert (s->next->img == NULL);
4582 x_set_glyph_string_gc (s->next);
4583 x_set_glyph_string_clipping (s->next);
4584 x_draw_glyph_string_background (s->next, 1);
4585 }
4586
4587 /* Set up S->gc, set clipping and draw S. */
4588 x_set_glyph_string_gc (s);
4589 x_set_glyph_string_clipping (s);
4590
4591 switch (s->first_glyph->type)
4592 {
4593 case IMAGE_GLYPH:
4594 x_draw_image_glyph_string (s);
4595 break;
4596
4597 case STRETCH_GLYPH:
4598 x_draw_stretch_glyph_string (s);
4599 break;
4600
4601 case CHAR_GLYPH:
4602 if (s->for_overlaps_p)
4603 s->background_filled_p = 1;
4604 else
4605 x_draw_glyph_string_background (s, 0);
4606 x_draw_glyph_string_foreground (s);
4607 break;
4608
4609 case COMPOSITE_GLYPH:
4610 if (s->for_overlaps_p || s->gidx > 0)
4611 s->background_filled_p = 1;
4612 else
4613 x_draw_glyph_string_background (s, 1);
4614 x_draw_composite_glyph_string_foreground (s);
4615 break;
4616
4617 default:
4618 abort ();
4619 }
4620
4621 if (!s->for_overlaps_p)
4622 {
4623 /* Draw underline. */
4624 if (s->face->underline_p)
4625 {
4626 unsigned long h = 1;
4627 unsigned long dy = s->height - h;
4628
4629 if (s->face->underline_defaulted_p)
4630 XFillRectangle (s->display, s->window, s->gc, s->x, s->y + dy,
4631 s->width, h);
4632 else
4633 {
4634 XGCValues xgcv;
4635 XGetGCValues (s->display, s->gc, GCForeground, &xgcv);
4636 XSetForeground (s->display, s->gc, s->face->underline_color);
4637 XFillRectangle (s->display, s->window, s->gc, s->x, s->y + dy,
4638 s->width, h);
4639 XSetForeground (s->display, s->gc, xgcv.foreground);
4640 }
4641 }
4642
4643 /* Draw overline. */
4644 if (s->face->overline_p)
4645 {
4646 unsigned long dy = 0, h = 1;
4647
4648 if (s->face->overline_color_defaulted_p)
4649 XFillRectangle (s->display, s->window, s->gc, s->x, s->y + dy,
4650 s->width, h);
4651 else
4652 {
4653 XGCValues xgcv;
4654 XGetGCValues (s->display, s->gc, GCForeground, &xgcv);
4655 XSetForeground (s->display, s->gc, s->face->overline_color);
4656 XFillRectangle (s->display, s->window, s->gc, s->x, s->y + dy,
4657 s->width, h);
4658 XSetForeground (s->display, s->gc, xgcv.foreground);
4659 }
4660 }
4661
4662 /* Draw strike-through. */
4663 if (s->face->strike_through_p)
4664 {
4665 unsigned long h = 1;
4666 unsigned long dy = (s->height - h) / 2;
4667
4668 if (s->face->strike_through_color_defaulted_p)
4669 XFillRectangle (s->display, s->window, s->gc, s->x, s->y + dy,
4670 s->width, h);
4671 else
4672 {
4673 XGCValues xgcv;
4674 XGetGCValues (s->display, s->gc, GCForeground, &xgcv);
4675 XSetForeground (s->display, s->gc, s->face->strike_through_color);
4676 XFillRectangle (s->display, s->window, s->gc, s->x, s->y + dy,
4677 s->width, h);
4678 XSetForeground (s->display, s->gc, xgcv.foreground);
4679 }
4680 }
4681
4682 /* Draw relief. */
4683 if (s->face->box != FACE_NO_BOX)
4684 x_draw_glyph_string_box (s);
4685 }
4686
4687 /* Reset clipping. */
4688 mac_reset_clipping (s->display, s->window);
4689}
4690
4691
4692static int x_fill_composite_glyph_string P_ ((struct glyph_string *,
4693 struct face **, int));
4694
4695
4696/* Fill glyph string S with composition components specified by S->cmp.
4697
4698 FACES is an array of faces for all components of this composition.
4699 S->gidx is the index of the first component for S.
4700 OVERLAPS_P non-zero means S should draw the foreground only, and
4701 use its physical height for clipping.
4702
4703 Value is the index of a component not in S. */
4704
4705static int
4706x_fill_composite_glyph_string (s, faces, overlaps_p)
4707 struct glyph_string *s;
4708 struct face **faces;
4709 int overlaps_p;
4710{
4711 int i;
4712
4713 xassert (s);
4714
4715 s->for_overlaps_p = overlaps_p;
4716
4717 s->face = faces[s->gidx];
4718 s->font = s->face->font;
4719 s->font_info = FONT_INFO_FROM_ID (s->f, s->face->font_info_id);
4720
4721 /* For all glyphs of this composition, starting at the offset
4722 S->gidx, until we reach the end of the definition or encounter a
4723 glyph that requires the different face, add it to S. */
4724 ++s->nchars;
4725 for (i = s->gidx + 1; i < s->cmp->glyph_len && faces[i] == s->face; ++i)
4726 ++s->nchars;
4727
4728 /* All glyph strings for the same composition has the same width,
4729 i.e. the width set for the first component of the composition. */
4730
4731 s->width = s->first_glyph->pixel_width;
4732
4733 /* If the specified font could not be loaded, use the frame's
4734 default font, but record the fact that we couldn't load it in
4735 the glyph string so that we can draw rectangles for the
4736 characters of the glyph string. */
4737 if (s->font == NULL)
4738 {
4739 s->font_not_found_p = 1;
4740 s->font = FRAME_FONT (s->f);
4741 }
4742
4743 /* Adjust base line for subscript/superscript text. */
4744 s->ybase += s->first_glyph->voffset;
4745
4746 xassert (s->face && s->face->gc);
4747
4748 /* This glyph string must always be drawn with 16-bit functions. */
4749 s->two_byte_p = 1;
4750
4751 return s->gidx + s->nchars;
4752}
4753
4754
4755/* Fill glyph string S from a sequence of character glyphs.
4756
4757 FACE_ID is the face id of the string. START is the index of the
4758 first glyph to consider, END is the index of the last + 1.
4759 OVERLAPS_P non-zero means S should draw the foreground only, and
4760 use its physical height for clipping.
4761
4762 Value is the index of the first glyph not in S. */
4763
4764static int
4765x_fill_glyph_string (s, face_id, start, end, overlaps_p)
4766 struct glyph_string *s;
4767 int face_id;
4768 int start, end, overlaps_p;
4769{
4770 struct glyph *glyph, *last;
4771 int voffset;
4772 int glyph_not_available_p;
4773
4774 xassert (s->f == XFRAME (s->w->frame));
4775 xassert (s->nchars == 0);
4776 xassert (start >= 0 && end > start);
4777
4778 s->for_overlaps_p = overlaps_p,
4779 glyph = s->row->glyphs[s->area] + start;
4780 last = s->row->glyphs[s->area] + end;
4781 voffset = glyph->voffset;
4782
4783 glyph_not_available_p = glyph->glyph_not_available_p;
4784
4785 while (glyph < last
4786 && glyph->type == CHAR_GLYPH
4787 && glyph->voffset == voffset
4788 /* Same face id implies same font, nowadays. */
4789 && glyph->face_id == face_id
4790 && glyph->glyph_not_available_p == glyph_not_available_p)
4791 {
4792 int two_byte_p;
4793
4794 s->face = x_get_glyph_face_and_encoding (s->f, glyph,
4795 s->char2b + s->nchars,
4796 &two_byte_p);
4797 s->two_byte_p = two_byte_p;
4798 ++s->nchars;
4799 xassert (s->nchars <= end - start);
4800 s->width += glyph->pixel_width;
4801 ++glyph;
4802 }
4803
4804 s->font = s->face->font;
4805 s->font_info = FONT_INFO_FROM_ID (s->f, s->face->font_info_id);
4806
4807 /* If the specified font could not be loaded, use the frame's font,
4808 but record the fact that we couldn't load it in
4809 S->font_not_found_p so that we can draw rectangles for the
4810 characters of the glyph string. */
4811 if (s->font == NULL || glyph_not_available_p)
4812 {
4813 s->font_not_found_p = 1;
4814 s->font = FRAME_FONT (s->f);
4815 }
4816
4817 /* Adjust base line for subscript/superscript text. */
4818 s->ybase += voffset;
4819
4820 xassert (s->face && s->face->gc);
4821 return glyph - s->row->glyphs[s->area];
4822}
4823
4824
4825/* Fill glyph string S from image glyph S->first_glyph. */
4826
4827static void
4828x_fill_image_glyph_string (s)
4829 struct glyph_string *s;
4830{
4831 xassert (s->first_glyph->type == IMAGE_GLYPH);
4832 s->img = IMAGE_FROM_ID (s->f, s->first_glyph->u.img_id);
4833 xassert (s->img);
4834 s->face = FACE_FROM_ID (s->f, s->first_glyph->face_id);
4835 s->font = s->face->font;
4836 s->width = s->first_glyph->pixel_width;
4837
4838 /* Adjust base line for subscript/superscript text. */
4839 s->ybase += s->first_glyph->voffset;
4840}
4841
4842
4843/* Fill glyph string S from a sequence of stretch glyphs.
4844
4845 ROW is the glyph row in which the glyphs are found, AREA is the
4846 area within the row. START is the index of the first glyph to
4847 consider, END is the index of the last + 1.
4848
4849 Value is the index of the first glyph not in S. */
4850
4851static int
4852x_fill_stretch_glyph_string (s, row, area, start, end)
4853 struct glyph_string *s;
4854 struct glyph_row *row;
4855 enum glyph_row_area area;
4856 int start, end;
4857{
4858 struct glyph *glyph, *last;
4859 int voffset, face_id;
4860
4861 xassert (s->first_glyph->type == STRETCH_GLYPH);
4862
4863 glyph = s->row->glyphs[s->area] + start;
4864 last = s->row->glyphs[s->area] + end;
4865 face_id = glyph->face_id;
4866 s->face = FACE_FROM_ID (s->f, face_id);
4867 s->font = s->face->font;
4868 s->font_info = FONT_INFO_FROM_ID (s->f, s->face->font_info_id);
4869 s->width = glyph->pixel_width;
4870 voffset = glyph->voffset;
4871
4872 for (++glyph;
4873 (glyph < last
4874 && glyph->type == STRETCH_GLYPH
4875 && glyph->voffset == voffset
4876 && glyph->face_id == face_id);
4877 ++glyph)
4878 s->width += glyph->pixel_width;
4879
4880 /* Adjust base line for subscript/superscript text. */
4881 s->ybase += voffset;
4882
4883 xassert (s->face && s->face->gc);
4884 return glyph - s->row->glyphs[s->area];
4885}
4886
4887
4888/* Initialize glyph string S. CHAR2B is a suitably allocated vector
4889 of XChar2b structures for S; it can't be allocated in
4890 x_init_glyph_string because it must be allocated via `alloca'. W
4891 is the window on which S is drawn. ROW and AREA are the glyph row
4892 and area within the row from which S is constructed. START is the
4893 index of the first glyph structure covered by S. HL is a
4894 face-override for drawing S. */
4895
4896static void
4897x_init_glyph_string (s, char2b, w, row, area, start, hl)
4898 struct glyph_string *s;
4899 XChar2b *char2b;
4900 struct window *w;
4901 struct glyph_row *row;
4902 enum glyph_row_area area;
4903 int start;
4904 enum draw_glyphs_face hl;
4905{
4906 bzero (s, sizeof *s);
4907 s->w = w;
4908 s->f = XFRAME (w->frame);
4909 s->display = FRAME_MAC_DISPLAY (s->f);
4910 s->window = FRAME_MAC_WINDOW (s->f);
4911 s->char2b = char2b;
4912 s->hl = hl;
4913 s->row = row;
4914 s->area = area;
4915 s->first_glyph = row->glyphs[area] + start;
4916 s->height = row->height;
4917 s->y = WINDOW_TO_FRAME_PIXEL_Y (w, row->y);
4918
4919 /* Display the internal border below the tool-bar window. */
4920 if (s->w == XWINDOW (s->f->tool_bar_window))
4921 s->y -= s->f->output_data.mac->internal_border_width;
4922
4923 s->ybase = s->y + row->ascent;
4924}
4925
4926
4927/* Set background width of glyph string S. START is the index of the
4928 first glyph following S. LAST_X is the right-most x-position + 1
4929 in the drawing area. */
4930
4931static INLINE void
4932x_set_glyph_string_background_width (s, start, last_x)
4933 struct glyph_string *s;
4934 int start;
4935 int last_x;
4936{
4937 /* If the face of this glyph string has to be drawn to the end of
4938 the drawing area, set S->extends_to_end_of_line_p. */
4939 struct face *default_face = FACE_FROM_ID (s->f, DEFAULT_FACE_ID);
4940
4941 if (start == s->row->used[s->area]
4942 && s->hl == DRAW_NORMAL_TEXT
4943 && ((s->area == TEXT_AREA && s->row->fill_line_p)
4944 || s->face->background != default_face->background
4945 || s->face->stipple != default_face->stipple))
4946 s->extends_to_end_of_line_p = 1;
4947
4948 /* If S extends its face to the end of the line, set its
4949 background_width to the distance to the right edge of the drawing
4950 area. */
4951 if (s->extends_to_end_of_line_p)
4952 s->background_width = last_x - s->x + 1;
4953 else
4954 s->background_width = s->width;
4955}
4956
4957
4958/* Add a glyph string for a stretch glyph to the list of strings
4959 between HEAD and TAIL. START is the index of the stretch glyph in
4960 row area AREA of glyph row ROW. END is the index of the last glyph
4961 in that glyph row area. X is the current output position assigned
4962 to the new glyph string constructed. HL overrides that face of the
4963 glyph; e.g. it is DRAW_CURSOR if a cursor has to be drawn. LAST_X
4964 is the right-most x-position of the drawing area. */
4965
4966/* SunOS 4 bundled cc, barfed on continuations in the arg lists here
4967 and below -- keep them on one line. */
4968#define BUILD_STRETCH_GLYPH_STRING(W, ROW, AREA, START, END, HEAD, TAIL, HL, X, LAST_X) \
4969 do \
4970 { \
4971 s = (struct glyph_string *) alloca (sizeof *s); \
4972 x_init_glyph_string (s, NULL, W, ROW, AREA, START, HL); \
4973 START = x_fill_stretch_glyph_string (s, ROW, AREA, START, END); \
4974 x_append_glyph_string (&HEAD, &TAIL, s); \
4975 s->x = (X); \
4976 } \
4977 while (0)
4978
4979
4980/* Add a glyph string for an image glyph to the list of strings
4981 between HEAD and TAIL. START is the index of the image glyph in
4982 row area AREA of glyph row ROW. END is the index of the last glyph
4983 in that glyph row area. X is the current output position assigned
4984 to the new glyph string constructed. HL overrides that face of the
4985 glyph; e.g. it is DRAW_CURSOR if a cursor has to be drawn. LAST_X
4986 is the right-most x-position of the drawing area. */
4987
4988#define BUILD_IMAGE_GLYPH_STRING(W, ROW, AREA, START, END, HEAD, TAIL, HL, X, LAST_X) \
4989 do \
4990 { \
4991 s = (struct glyph_string *) alloca (sizeof *s); \
4992 x_init_glyph_string (s, NULL, W, ROW, AREA, START, HL); \
4993 x_fill_image_glyph_string (s); \
4994 x_append_glyph_string (&HEAD, &TAIL, s); \
4995 ++START; \
4996 s->x = (X); \
4997 } \
4998 while (0)
4999
5000
5001/* Add a glyph string for a sequence of character glyphs to the list
5002 of strings between HEAD and TAIL. START is the index of the first
5003 glyph in row area AREA of glyph row ROW that is part of the new
5004 glyph string. END is the index of the last glyph in that glyph row
5005 area. X is the current output position assigned to the new glyph
5006 string constructed. HL overrides that face of the glyph; e.g. it
5007 is DRAW_CURSOR if a cursor has to be drawn. LAST_X is the
5008 right-most x-position of the drawing area. */
5009
5010#define BUILD_CHAR_GLYPH_STRINGS(W, ROW, AREA, START, END, HEAD, TAIL, HL, X, LAST_X, OVERLAPS_P) \
5011 do \
5012 { \
5013 int c, face_id; \
5014 XChar2b *char2b; \
5015 \
5016 c = (ROW)->glyphs[AREA][START].u.ch; \
5017 face_id = (ROW)->glyphs[AREA][START].face_id; \
5018 \
5019 s = (struct glyph_string *) alloca (sizeof *s); \
5020 char2b = (XChar2b *) alloca ((END - START) * sizeof *char2b); \
5021 x_init_glyph_string (s, char2b, W, ROW, AREA, START, HL); \
5022 x_append_glyph_string (&HEAD, &TAIL, s); \
5023 s->x = (X); \
5024 START = x_fill_glyph_string (s, face_id, START, END, \
5025 OVERLAPS_P); \
5026 } \
5027 while (0)
5028
5029
5030/* Add a glyph string for a composite sequence to the list of strings
5031 between HEAD and TAIL. START is the index of the first glyph in
5032 row area AREA of glyph row ROW that is part of the new glyph
5033 string. END is the index of the last glyph in that glyph row area.
5034 X is the current output position assigned to the new glyph string
5035 constructed. HL overrides that face of the glyph; e.g. it is
5036 DRAW_CURSOR if a cursor has to be drawn. LAST_X is the right-most
5037 x-position of the drawing area. */
5038
5039#define BUILD_COMPOSITE_GLYPH_STRING(W, ROW, AREA, START, END, HEAD, TAIL, HL, X, LAST_X, OVERLAPS_P) \
5040 do { \
5041 int cmp_id = (ROW)->glyphs[AREA][START].u.cmp_id; \
5042 int face_id = (ROW)->glyphs[AREA][START].face_id; \
5043 struct face *base_face = FACE_FROM_ID (XFRAME (w->frame), face_id); \
5044 struct composition *cmp = composition_table[cmp_id]; \
5045 int glyph_len = cmp->glyph_len; \
5046 XChar2b *char2b; \
5047 struct face **faces; \
5048 struct glyph_string *first_s = NULL; \
5049 int n; \
5050 \
5051 base_face = base_face->ascii_face; \
5052 char2b = (XChar2b *) alloca ((sizeof *char2b) * glyph_len); \
5053 faces = (struct face **) alloca ((sizeof *faces) * glyph_len); \
5054 /* At first, fill in `char2b' and `faces'. */ \
5055 for (n = 0; n < glyph_len; n++) \
5056 { \
5057 int c = COMPOSITION_GLYPH (cmp, n); \
5058 int this_face_id = FACE_FOR_CHAR (XFRAME (w->frame), base_face, c); \
5059 faces[n] = FACE_FROM_ID (XFRAME (w->frame), this_face_id); \
5060 x_get_char_face_and_encoding (XFRAME (w->frame), c, \
5061 this_face_id, char2b + n, 1); \
5062 } \
5063 \
5064 /* Make glyph_strings for each glyph sequence that is drawable by \
5065 the same face, and append them to HEAD/TAIL. */ \
5066 for (n = 0; n < cmp->glyph_len;) \
5067 { \
5068 s = (struct glyph_string *) alloca (sizeof *s); \
5069 x_init_glyph_string (s, char2b + n, W, ROW, AREA, START, HL); \
5070 x_append_glyph_string (&(HEAD), &(TAIL), s); \
5071 s->cmp = cmp; \
5072 s->gidx = n; \
5073 s->x = (X); \
5074 \
5075 if (n == 0) \
5076 first_s = s; \
5077 \
5078 n = x_fill_composite_glyph_string (s, faces, OVERLAPS_P); \
5079 } \
5080 \
5081 ++START; \
5082 s = first_s; \
5083 } while (0)
5084
5085
5086/* Build a list of glyph strings between HEAD and TAIL for the glyphs
5087 of AREA of glyph row ROW on window W between indices START and END.
5088 HL overrides the face for drawing glyph strings, e.g. it is
5089 DRAW_CURSOR to draw a cursor. X and LAST_X are start and end
5090 x-positions of the drawing area.
5091
5092 This is an ugly monster macro construct because we must use alloca
5093 to allocate glyph strings (because x_draw_glyphs can be called
5094 asynchronously). */
5095
5096#define BUILD_GLYPH_STRINGS(W, ROW, AREA, START, END, HEAD, TAIL, HL, X, LAST_X, OVERLAPS_P) \
5097 do \
5098 { \
5099 HEAD = TAIL = NULL; \
5100 while (START < END) \
5101 { \
5102 struct glyph *first_glyph = (ROW)->glyphs[AREA] + START; \
5103 switch (first_glyph->type) \
5104 { \
5105 case CHAR_GLYPH: \
5106 BUILD_CHAR_GLYPH_STRINGS (W, ROW, AREA, START, END, HEAD, \
5107 TAIL, HL, X, LAST_X, \
5108 OVERLAPS_P); \
5109 break; \
5110 \
5111 case COMPOSITE_GLYPH: \
5112 BUILD_COMPOSITE_GLYPH_STRING (W, ROW, AREA, START, END, \
5113 HEAD, TAIL, HL, X, LAST_X,\
5114 OVERLAPS_P); \
5115 break; \
5116 \
5117 case STRETCH_GLYPH: \
5118 BUILD_STRETCH_GLYPH_STRING (W, ROW, AREA, START, END, \
5119 HEAD, TAIL, HL, X, LAST_X); \
5120 break; \
5121 \
5122 case IMAGE_GLYPH: \
5123 BUILD_IMAGE_GLYPH_STRING (W, ROW, AREA, START, END, HEAD, \
5124 TAIL, HL, X, LAST_X); \
5125 break; \
5126 \
5127 default: \
5128 abort (); \
5129 } \
5130 \
5131 x_set_glyph_string_background_width (s, START, LAST_X); \
5132 (X) += s->width; \
5133 } \
5134 } \
5135 while (0)
5136
5137
5138/* Draw glyphs between START and END in AREA of ROW on window W,
5139 starting at x-position X. X is relative to AREA in W. HL is a
5140 face-override with the following meaning:
5141
5142 DRAW_NORMAL_TEXT draw normally
5143 DRAW_CURSOR draw in cursor face
5144 DRAW_MOUSE_FACE draw in mouse face.
5145 DRAW_INVERSE_VIDEO draw in mode line face
5146 DRAW_IMAGE_SUNKEN draw an image with a sunken relief around it
5147 DRAW_IMAGE_RAISED draw an image with a raised relief around it
5148
5149 If REAL_START is non-null, return in *REAL_START the real starting
5150 position for display. This can be different from START in case
5151 overlapping glyphs must be displayed. If REAL_END is non-null,
5152 return in *REAL_END the real end position for display. This can be
5153 different from END in case overlapping glyphs must be displayed.
5154
5155 If OVERLAPS_P is non-zero, draw only the foreground of characters
5156 and clip to the physical height of ROW.
5157
5158 Value is the x-position reached, relative to AREA of W. */
5159
5160static int
5161x_draw_glyphs (w, x, row, area, start, end, hl, real_start, real_end,
5162 overlaps_p)
5163 struct window *w;
5164 int x;
5165 struct glyph_row *row;
5166 enum glyph_row_area area;
5167 int start, end;
5168 enum draw_glyphs_face hl;
5169 int *real_start, *real_end;
5170 int overlaps_p;
5171{
5172 struct glyph_string *head, *tail;
5173 struct glyph_string *s;
5174 int last_x, area_width;
5175 int x_reached;
5176 int i, j;
5177
5178 /* Let's rather be paranoid than getting a SEGV. */
5179 start = max (0, start);
5180 end = min (end, row->used[area]);
5181 if (real_start)
5182 *real_start = start;
5183 if (real_end)
5184 *real_end = end;
5185
5186 /* Translate X to frame coordinates. Set last_x to the right
5187 end of the drawing area. */
5188 if (row->full_width_p)
5189 {
5190 /* X is relative to the left edge of W, without scroll bars
5191 or flag areas. */
5192 struct frame *f = XFRAME (w->frame);
5193 /* int width = FRAME_FLAGS_AREA_WIDTH (f); */
5194 int window_left_x = WINDOW_LEFT_MARGIN (w) * CANON_X_UNIT (f);
5195
5196 x += window_left_x;
5197 area_width = XFASTINT (w->width) * CANON_X_UNIT (f);
5198 last_x = window_left_x + area_width;
5199
5200 if (FRAME_HAS_VERTICAL_SCROLL_BARS (f))
5201 {
5202 int width = FRAME_SCROLL_BAR_WIDTH (f) * CANON_X_UNIT (f);
5203 if (FRAME_HAS_VERTICAL_SCROLL_BARS_ON_RIGHT (f))
5204 last_x += width;
5205 else
5206 x -= width;
5207 }
5208
5209 x += FRAME_INTERNAL_BORDER_WIDTH (f);
5210 last_x -= FRAME_INTERNAL_BORDER_WIDTH (f);
5211 }
5212 else
5213 {
5214 x = WINDOW_AREA_TO_FRAME_PIXEL_X (w, area, x);
5215 area_width = window_box_width (w, area);
5216 last_x = WINDOW_AREA_TO_FRAME_PIXEL_X (w, area, area_width);
5217 }
5218
5219 /* Build a doubly-linked list of glyph_string structures between
5220 head and tail from what we have to draw. Note that the macro
5221 BUILD_GLYPH_STRINGS will modify its start parameter. That's
5222 the reason we use a separate variable `i'. */
5223 i = start;
5224 BUILD_GLYPH_STRINGS (w, row, area, i, end, head, tail, hl, x, last_x,
5225 overlaps_p);
5226 if (tail)
5227 x_reached = tail->x + tail->background_width;
5228 else
5229 x_reached = x;
5230
5231 /* If there are any glyphs with lbearing < 0 or rbearing > width in
5232 the row, redraw some glyphs in front or following the glyph
5233 strings built above. */
5234 if (!overlaps_p && row->contains_overlapping_glyphs_p)
5235 {
5236 int dummy_x = 0;
5237 struct glyph_string *h, *t;
5238
5239 /* Compute overhangs for all glyph strings. */
5240 for (s = head; s; s = s->next)
5241 x_compute_glyph_string_overhangs (s);
5242
5243 /* Prepend glyph strings for glyphs in front of the first glyph
5244 string that are overwritten because of the first glyph
5245 string's left overhang. The background of all strings
5246 prepended must be drawn because the first glyph string
5247 draws over it. */
5248 i = x_left_overwritten (head);
5249 if (i >= 0)
5250 {
5251 j = i;
5252 BUILD_GLYPH_STRINGS (w, row, area, j, start, h, t,
5253 DRAW_NORMAL_TEXT, dummy_x, last_x,
5254 overlaps_p);
5255 start = i;
5256 if (real_start)
5257 *real_start = start;
5258 x_compute_overhangs_and_x (t, head->x, 1);
5259 x_prepend_glyph_string_lists (&head, &tail, h, t);
5260 }
5261
5262 /* Prepend glyph strings for glyphs in front of the first glyph
5263 string that overwrite that glyph string because of their
5264 right overhang. For these strings, only the foreground must
5265 be drawn, because it draws over the glyph string at `head'.
5266 The background must not be drawn because this would overwrite
5267 right overhangs of preceding glyphs for which no glyph
5268 strings exist. */
5269 i = x_left_overwriting (head);
5270 if (i >= 0)
5271 {
5272 BUILD_GLYPH_STRINGS (w, row, area, i, start, h, t,
5273 DRAW_NORMAL_TEXT, dummy_x, last_x,
5274 overlaps_p);
5275 for (s = h; s; s = s->next)
5276 s->background_filled_p = 1;
5277 if (real_start)
5278 *real_start = i;
5279 x_compute_overhangs_and_x (t, head->x, 1);
5280 x_prepend_glyph_string_lists (&head, &tail, h, t);
5281 }
5282
5283 /* Append glyphs strings for glyphs following the last glyph
5284 string tail that are overwritten by tail. The background of
5285 these strings has to be drawn because tail's foreground draws
5286 over it. */
5287 i = x_right_overwritten (tail);
5288 if (i >= 0)
5289 {
5290 BUILD_GLYPH_STRINGS (w, row, area, end, i, h, t,
5291 DRAW_NORMAL_TEXT, x, last_x,
5292 overlaps_p);
5293 x_compute_overhangs_and_x (h, tail->x + tail->width, 0);
5294 x_append_glyph_string_lists (&head, &tail, h, t);
5295 if (real_end)
5296 *real_end = i;
5297 }
5298
5299 /* Append glyph strings for glyphs following the last glyph
5300 string tail that overwrite tail. The foreground of such
5301 glyphs has to be drawn because it writes into the background
5302 of tail. The background must not be drawn because it could
5303 paint over the foreground of following glyphs. */
5304 i = x_right_overwriting (tail);
5305 if (i >= 0)
5306 {
5307 BUILD_GLYPH_STRINGS (w, row, area, end, i, h, t,
5308 DRAW_NORMAL_TEXT, x, last_x,
5309 overlaps_p);
5310 for (s = h; s; s = s->next)
5311 s->background_filled_p = 1;
5312 x_compute_overhangs_and_x (h, tail->x + tail->width, 0);
5313 x_append_glyph_string_lists (&head, &tail, h, t);
5314 if (real_end)
5315 *real_end = i;
5316 }
5317 }
5318
5319 /* Draw all strings. */
5320 for (s = head; s; s = s->next)
5321 x_draw_glyph_string (s);
5322
5323 /* Value is the x-position up to which drawn, relative to AREA of W.
5324 This doesn't include parts drawn because of overhangs. */
5325 x_reached = FRAME_TO_WINDOW_PIXEL_X (w, x_reached);
5326 if (!row->full_width_p)
5327 {
5328 if (area > LEFT_MARGIN_AREA)
5329 x_reached -= window_box_width (w, LEFT_MARGIN_AREA);
5330 if (area > TEXT_AREA)
5331 x_reached -= window_box_width (w, TEXT_AREA);
5332 }
5333 return x_reached;
5334}
5335
5336
5337/* Fix the display of area AREA of overlapping row ROW in window W. */
5338
5339void
5340x_fix_overlapping_area (w, row, area)
5341 struct window *w;
5342 struct glyph_row *row;
5343 enum glyph_row_area area;
5344{
5345 int i, x;
5346
5347 BLOCK_INPUT;
5348
5349 if (area == LEFT_MARGIN_AREA)
5350 x = 0;
5351 else if (area == TEXT_AREA)
5352 x = row->x + window_box_width (w, LEFT_MARGIN_AREA);
5353 else
5354 x = (window_box_width (w, LEFT_MARGIN_AREA)
5355 + window_box_width (w, TEXT_AREA));
5356
5357 for (i = 0; i < row->used[area];)
5358 {
5359 if (row->glyphs[area][i].overlaps_vertically_p)
5360 {
5361 int start = i, start_x = x;
5362
5363 do
5364 {
5365 x += row->glyphs[area][i].pixel_width;
5366 ++i;
5367 }
5368 while (i < row->used[area]
5369 && row->glyphs[area][i].overlaps_vertically_p);
5370
5371 x_draw_glyphs (w, start_x, row, area, start, i,
5372 (row->inverse_p
5373 ? DRAW_INVERSE_VIDEO : DRAW_NORMAL_TEXT),
5374 NULL, NULL, 1);
5375 }
5376 else
5377 {
5378 x += row->glyphs[area][i].pixel_width;
5379 ++i;
5380 }
5381 }
5382
5383 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
5384}
5385
5386
5387/* Output LEN glyphs starting at START at the nominal cursor position.
5388 Advance the nominal cursor over the text. The global variable
5389 updated_window contains the window being updated, updated_row is
5390 the glyph row being updated, and updated_area is the area of that
5391 row being updated. */
5392
5393void
5394x_write_glyphs (start, len)
5395 struct glyph *start;
5396 int len;
5397{
5398 int x, hpos, real_start, real_end;
5399
5400 xassert (updated_window && updated_row);
5401 BLOCK_INPUT;
5402
5403 /* Write glyphs. */
5404
5405 hpos = start - updated_row->glyphs[updated_area];
5406 x = x_draw_glyphs (updated_window, output_cursor.x,
5407 updated_row, updated_area,
5408 hpos, hpos + len,
5409 (updated_row->inverse_p
5410 ? DRAW_INVERSE_VIDEO : DRAW_NORMAL_TEXT),
5411 &real_start, &real_end, 0);
5412
5413 /* If we drew over the cursor, note that it is not visible any more. */
5414 note_overwritten_text_cursor (updated_window, real_start,
5415 real_end - real_start);
5416
5417 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
5418
5419 /* Advance the output cursor. */
5420 output_cursor.hpos += len;
5421 output_cursor.x = x;
5422}
5423
5424
5425/* Insert LEN glyphs from START at the nominal cursor position. */
5426
5427void
5428x_insert_glyphs (start, len)
5429 struct glyph *start;
5430 register int len;
5431{
5432 struct frame *f;
5433 struct window *w;
5434 int line_height, shift_by_width, shifted_region_width;
5435 struct glyph_row *row;
5436 struct glyph *glyph;
5437 int frame_x, frame_y, hpos, real_start, real_end;
5438
5439 xassert (updated_window && updated_row);
5440 BLOCK_INPUT;
5441 w = updated_window;
5442 f = XFRAME (WINDOW_FRAME (w));
5443
5444 /* Get the height of the line we are in. */
5445 row = updated_row;
5446 line_height = row->height;
5447
5448 /* Get the width of the glyphs to insert. */
5449 shift_by_width = 0;
5450 for (glyph = start; glyph < start + len; ++glyph)
5451 shift_by_width += glyph->pixel_width;
5452
5453 /* Get the width of the region to shift right. */
5454 shifted_region_width = (window_box_width (w, updated_area)
5455 - output_cursor.x
5456 - shift_by_width);
5457
5458 /* Shift right. */
5459 frame_x = WINDOW_TO_FRAME_PIXEL_X (w, output_cursor.x);
5460 frame_y = WINDOW_TO_FRAME_PIXEL_Y (w, output_cursor.y);
5461
5462 mac_scroll_area (FRAME_MAC_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_MAC_WINDOW (f),
5463 f->output_data.mac->normal_gc,
5464 frame_x, frame_y,
5465 shifted_region_width, line_height,
5466 frame_x + shift_by_width, frame_y);
5467
5468 /* Write the glyphs. */
5469 hpos = start - row->glyphs[updated_area];
5470 x_draw_glyphs (w, output_cursor.x, row, updated_area, hpos, hpos + len,
5471 DRAW_NORMAL_TEXT, &real_start, &real_end, 0);
5472 note_overwritten_text_cursor (w, real_start, real_end - real_start);
5473
5474 /* Advance the output cursor. */
5475 output_cursor.hpos += len;
5476 output_cursor.x += shift_by_width;
5477 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
5478}
5479
5480
5481/* Delete N glyphs at the nominal cursor position. Not implemented
5482 for X frames. */
5483
5484void
5485x_delete_glyphs (n)
5486 register int n;
5487{
5488 abort ();
5489}
5490
5491
5492/* Erase the current text line from the nominal cursor position
5493 (inclusive) to pixel column TO_X (exclusive). The idea is that
5494 everything from TO_X onward is already erased.
5495
5496 TO_X is a pixel position relative to updated_area of
5497 updated_window. TO_X == -1 means clear to the end of this area. */
5498
5499void
5500x_clear_end_of_line (to_x)
5501 int to_x;
5502{
5503 struct frame *f;
5504 struct window *w = updated_window;
5505 int max_x, min_y, max_y;
5506 int from_x, from_y, to_y;
5507
5508 xassert (updated_window && updated_row);
5509 f = XFRAME (w->frame);
5510
5511 if (updated_row->full_width_p)
5512 {
5513 max_x = XFASTINT (w->width) * CANON_X_UNIT (f);
5514 if (FRAME_HAS_VERTICAL_SCROLL_BARS (f)
5515 && !w->pseudo_window_p)
5516 max_x += FRAME_SCROLL_BAR_WIDTH (f) * CANON_X_UNIT (f);
5517 }
5518 else
5519 max_x = window_box_width (w, updated_area);
5520 max_y = window_text_bottom_y (w);
5521
5522 /* TO_X == 0 means don't do anything. TO_X < 0 means clear to end
5523 of window. For TO_X > 0, truncate to end of drawing area. */
5524 if (to_x == 0)
5525 return;
5526 else if (to_x < 0)
5527 to_x = max_x;
5528 else
5529 to_x = min (to_x, max_x);
5530
5531 to_y = min (max_y, output_cursor.y + updated_row->height);
5532
5533 /* Notice if the cursor will be cleared by this operation. */
5534 if (!updated_row->full_width_p)
5535 note_overwritten_text_cursor (w, output_cursor.hpos, -1);
5536
5537 from_x = output_cursor.x;
5538
5539 /* Translate to frame coordinates. */
5540 if (updated_row->full_width_p)
5541 {
5542 from_x = WINDOW_TO_FRAME_PIXEL_X (w, from_x);
5543 to_x = WINDOW_TO_FRAME_PIXEL_X (w, to_x);
5544 }
5545 else
5546 {
5547 from_x = WINDOW_AREA_TO_FRAME_PIXEL_X (w, updated_area, from_x);
5548 to_x = WINDOW_AREA_TO_FRAME_PIXEL_X (w, updated_area, to_x);
5549 }
5550
5551 min_y = WINDOW_DISPLAY_HEADER_LINE_HEIGHT (w);
5552 from_y = WINDOW_TO_FRAME_PIXEL_Y (w, max (min_y, output_cursor.y));
5553 to_y = WINDOW_TO_FRAME_PIXEL_Y (w, to_y);
5554
5555 /* Prevent inadvertently clearing to end of the X window. */
5556 if (to_x > from_x && to_y > from_y)
5557 {
5558 BLOCK_INPUT;
5559 XClearArea (FRAME_MAC_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_MAC_WINDOW (f),
5560 from_x, from_y, to_x - from_x, to_y - from_y,
5561 0);
5562 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
5563 }
5564}
5565
5566
5567/* Clear entire frame. If updating_frame is non-null, clear that
5568 frame. Otherwise clear the selected frame. */
5569
5570void
5571x_clear_frame ()
5572{
5573 struct frame *f;
5574
5575 if (updating_frame)
5576 f = updating_frame;
5577 else
5578 f = SELECTED_FRAME ();
5579
5580 /* Clearing the frame will erase any cursor, so mark them all as no
5581 longer visible. */
5582 mark_window_cursors_off (XWINDOW (FRAME_ROOT_WINDOW (f)));
5583 output_cursor.hpos = output_cursor.vpos = 0;
5584 output_cursor.x = -1;
5585
5586 /* We don't set the output cursor here because there will always
5587 follow an explicit cursor_to. */
5588 BLOCK_INPUT;
5589 XClearWindow (FRAME_MAC_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_MAC_WINDOW (f));
5590
5591#if 0 /* Clearing frame on Mac OS clears scroll bars. */
5592 /* We have to clear the scroll bars, too. If we have changed
5593 colors or something like that, then they should be notified. */
5594 x_scroll_bar_clear (f);
5595#endif
5596
5597 XFlush (FRAME_MAC_DISPLAY (f));
5598 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
5599}
5600
5601
5602\f
5603/* Invert the middle quarter of the frame for .15 sec. */
5604
5605/* We use the select system call to do the waiting, so we have to make
5606 sure it's available. If it isn't, we just won't do visual bells. */
5607
5608#if defined (HAVE_TIMEVAL) && defined (HAVE_SELECT)
5609
5610/* Subtract the `struct timeval' values X and Y, storing the result in
5611 *RESULT. Return 1 if the difference is negative, otherwise 0. */
5612
5613static int
5614timeval_subtract (result, x, y)
5615 struct timeval *result, x, y;
5616{
5617 /* Perform the carry for the later subtraction by updating y. This
5618 is safer because on some systems the tv_sec member is unsigned. */
5619 if (x.tv_usec < y.tv_usec)
5620 {
5621 int nsec = (y.tv_usec - x.tv_usec) / 1000000 + 1;
5622 y.tv_usec -= 1000000 * nsec;
5623 y.tv_sec += nsec;
5624 }
5625
5626 if (x.tv_usec - y.tv_usec > 1000000)
5627 {
5628 int nsec = (y.tv_usec - x.tv_usec) / 1000000;
5629 y.tv_usec += 1000000 * nsec;
5630 y.tv_sec -= nsec;
5631 }
5632
5633 /* Compute the time remaining to wait. tv_usec is certainly
5634 positive. */
5635 result->tv_sec = x.tv_sec - y.tv_sec;
5636 result->tv_usec = x.tv_usec - y.tv_usec;
5637
5638 /* Return indication of whether the result should be considered
5639 negative. */
5640 return x.tv_sec < y.tv_sec;
5641}
5642
5643void
5644XTflash (f)
5645 struct frame *f;
5646{
5647 BLOCK_INPUT;
5648
5649 FlashMenuBar (0);
5650
5651 {
5652 struct timeval wakeup;
5653
5654 EMACS_GET_TIME (wakeup);
5655
5656 /* Compute time to wait until, propagating carry from usecs. */
5657 wakeup.tv_usec += 150000;
5658 wakeup.tv_sec += (wakeup.tv_usec / 1000000);
5659 wakeup.tv_usec %= 1000000;
5660
5661 /* Keep waiting until past the time wakeup. */
5662 while (1)
5663 {
5664 struct timeval timeout;
5665
5666 EMACS_GET_TIME (timeout);
5667
5668 /* In effect, timeout = wakeup - timeout.
5669 Break if result would be negative. */
5670 if (timeval_subtract (&timeout, wakeup, timeout))
5671 break;
5672
5673 /* Try to wait that long--but we might wake up sooner. */
5674 select (0, NULL, NULL, NULL, &timeout);
5675 }
5676 }
5677
5678 FlashMenuBar (0);
5679
5680 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
5681}
5682
5683#endif /* defined (HAVE_TIMEVAL) && defined (HAVE_SELECT) */
5684
5685
5686/* Make audible bell. */
5687
5688void
5689XTring_bell ()
5690{
5691 struct frame *f = SELECTED_FRAME ();
5692
5693#if defined (HAVE_TIMEVAL) && defined (HAVE_SELECT)
5694 if (visible_bell)
5695 XTflash (f);
5696 else
5697#endif
5698 {
5699 BLOCK_INPUT;
5700 SysBeep (1);
5701 XFlush (FRAME_MAC_DISPLAY (f));
5702 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
5703 }
5704}
5705
5706
5707\f
5708/* Specify how many text lines, from the top of the window,
5709 should be affected by insert-lines and delete-lines operations.
5710 This, and those operations, are used only within an update
5711 that is bounded by calls to x_update_begin and x_update_end. */
5712
5713void
5714XTset_terminal_window (n)
5715 register int n;
5716{
5717 /* This function intentionally left blank. */
5718}
5719
5720
5721\f
5722/***********************************************************************
5723 Line Dance
5724 ***********************************************************************/
5725
5726/* Perform an insert-lines or delete-lines operation, inserting N
5727 lines or deleting -N lines at vertical position VPOS. */
5728
5729void
5730x_ins_del_lines (vpos, n)
5731 int vpos, n;
5732{
5733 abort ();
5734}
5735
5736
5737/* Scroll part of the display as described by RUN. */
5738
5739void
5740x_scroll_run (w, run)
5741 struct window *w;
5742 struct run *run;
5743{
5744 struct frame *f = XFRAME (w->frame);
5745 int x, y, width, height, from_y, to_y, bottom_y;
5746
5747 /* Get frame-relative bounding box of the text display area of W,
5748 without mode lines. Include in this box the flags areas to the
5749 left and right of W. */
5750 window_box (w, -1, &x, &y, &width, &height);
5751 width += FRAME_X_FLAGS_AREA_WIDTH (f);
5752 x -= FRAME_X_LEFT_FLAGS_AREA_WIDTH (f);
5753
5754 from_y = WINDOW_TO_FRAME_PIXEL_Y (w, run->current_y);
5755 to_y = WINDOW_TO_FRAME_PIXEL_Y (w, run->desired_y);
5756 bottom_y = y + height;
5757
5758 if (to_y < from_y)
5759 {
5760 /* Scrolling up. Make sure we don't copy part of the mode
5761 line at the bottom. */
5762 if (from_y + run->height > bottom_y)
5763 height = bottom_y - from_y;
5764 else
5765 height = run->height;
5766 }
5767 else
5768 {
5769 /* Scolling down. Make sure we don't copy over the mode line.
5770 at the bottom. */
5771 if (to_y + run->height > bottom_y)
5772 height = bottom_y - to_y;
5773 else
5774 height = run->height;
5775 }
5776
5777 BLOCK_INPUT;
5778
5779 /* Cursor off. Will be switched on again in x_update_window_end. */
5780 updated_window = w;
5781 x_clear_cursor (w);
5782
5783 mac_scroll_area (FRAME_MAC_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_MAC_WINDOW (f),
5784 f->output_data.mac->normal_gc,
5785 x, from_y,
5786 width, height,
5787 x, to_y);
5788
5789 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
5790}
5791
5792
5793\f
5794/***********************************************************************
5795 Exposure Events
5796 ***********************************************************************/
5797
5798/* Redisplay an exposed area of frame F. X and Y are the upper-left
5799 corner of the exposed rectangle. W and H are width and height of
5800 the exposed area. All are pixel values. W or H zero means redraw
5801 the entire frame. */
5802
5803static void
5804expose_frame (f, x, y, w, h)
5805 struct frame *f;
5806 int x, y, w, h;
5807{
5808 Rect r;
5809
5810 TRACE ((stderr, "expose_frame "));
5811
5812 /* No need to redraw if frame will be redrawn soon. */
5813 if (FRAME_GARBAGED_P (f))
5814 {
5815 TRACE ((stderr, " garbaged\n"));
5816 return;
5817 }
5818
5819 /* MAC_TODO: this is a kludge, but if scroll bars are not activated
5820 or deactivated here, for unknown reasons, activated scroll bars
5821 are shown in deactivated frames in some instances. */
5822 if (f == FRAME_MAC_DISPLAY_INFO (f)->x_focus_frame)
5823 activate_scroll_bars (f);
5824 else
5825 deactivate_scroll_bars (f);
5826
5827 /* If basic faces haven't been realized yet, there is no point in
5828 trying to redraw anything. This can happen when we get an expose
5829 event while Emacs is starting, e.g. by moving another window. */
5830 if (FRAME_FACE_CACHE (f) == NULL
5831 || FRAME_FACE_CACHE (f)->used < BASIC_FACE_ID_SENTINEL)
5832 {
5833 TRACE ((stderr, " no faces\n"));
5834 return;
5835 }
5836
5837 if (w == 0 || h == 0)
5838 {
5839 r.left = r.top = 0;
5840 r.right = CANON_X_UNIT (f) * f->width;
5841 r.bottom = CANON_Y_UNIT (f) * f->height;
5842 }
5843 else
5844 {
5845 r.left = x;
5846 r.top = y;
5847 r.right = x + w;
5848 r.bottom = y + h;
5849 }
5850
5851 TRACE ((stderr, "(%d, %d, %d, %d)\n", r.left, r.top, r.right, r.bottom));
5852 expose_window_tree (XWINDOW (f->root_window), &r);
5853
5854 if (WINDOWP (f->tool_bar_window))
5855 {
5856 struct window *w = XWINDOW (f->tool_bar_window);
5857 Rect window_rect;
5858 Rect intersection_rect;
5859 int window_x, window_y, window_width, window_height;
5860
5861
5862 window_box (w, -1, &window_x, &window_y, &window_width, &window_height);
5863 window_rect.left = window_x;
5864 window_rect.top = window_y;
5865 window_rect.right = window_x + window_width;
5866 window_rect.bottom = window_y + window_height;
5867
5868 if (x_intersect_rectangles (&r, &window_rect, &intersection_rect))
5869 expose_window (w, &intersection_rect);
5870 }
5871
5872#ifndef USE_X_TOOLKIT
5873 if (WINDOWP (f->menu_bar_window))
5874 {
5875 struct window *w = XWINDOW (f->menu_bar_window);
5876 Rect window_rect;
5877 Rect intersection_rect;
5878 int window_x, window_y, window_width, window_height;
5879
5880
5881 window_box (w, -1, &window_x, &window_y, &window_width, &window_height);
5882 window_rect.left = window_x;
5883 window_rect.top = window_y;
5884 window_rect.right = window_x + window_width;
5885 window_rect.bottom = window_y + window_height;
5886
5887 if (x_intersect_rectangles (&r, &window_rect, &intersection_rect))
5888 expose_window (w, &intersection_rect);
5889 }
5890#endif /* not USE_X_TOOLKIT */
5891}
5892
5893
5894/* Redraw (parts) of all windows in the window tree rooted at W that
5895 intersect R. R contains frame pixel coordinates. */
5896
5897static void
5898expose_window_tree (w, r)
5899 struct window *w;
5900 Rect *r;
5901{
5902 while (w)
5903 {
5904 if (!NILP (w->hchild))
5905 expose_window_tree (XWINDOW (w->hchild), r);
5906 else if (!NILP (w->vchild))
5907 expose_window_tree (XWINDOW (w->vchild), r);
5908 else
5909 {
5910 Rect window_rect;
5911 Rect intersection_rect;
5912 struct frame *f = XFRAME (w->frame);
5913 int window_x, window_y, window_width, window_height;
5914
5915 /* Frame-relative pixel rectangle of W. */
5916 window_box (w, -1, &window_x, &window_y, &window_width,
5917 &window_height);
5918 window_rect.left
5919 = (window_x
5920 - FRAME_X_LEFT_FLAGS_AREA_WIDTH (f)
5921 - FRAME_LEFT_SCROLL_BAR_WIDTH (f) * CANON_Y_UNIT (f));
5922 window_rect.top = window_y;
5923 window_rect.right = window_rect.left
5924 + (window_width
5925 + FRAME_X_FLAGS_AREA_WIDTH (f)
5926 + FRAME_SCROLL_BAR_WIDTH (f) * CANON_X_UNIT (f));
5927 window_rect.bottom = window_rect.top
5928 + window_height + CURRENT_MODE_LINE_HEIGHT (w);
5929
5930 if (x_intersect_rectangles (r, &window_rect, &intersection_rect))
5931 expose_window (w, &intersection_rect);
5932 }
5933
5934 w = NILP (w->next) ? 0 : XWINDOW (w->next);
5935 }
5936}
5937
5938
5939/* Redraw the part of glyph row area AREA of glyph row ROW on window W
5940 which intersects rectangle R. R is in window-relative coordinates. */
5941
5942static void
5943expose_area (w, row, r, area)
5944 struct window *w;
5945 struct glyph_row *row;
5946 Rect *r;
5947 enum glyph_row_area area;
5948{
5949 int x;
5950 struct glyph *first = row->glyphs[area];
5951 struct glyph *end = row->glyphs[area] + row->used[area];
5952 struct glyph *last;
5953 int first_x;
5954
5955 /* Set x to the window-relative start position for drawing glyphs of
5956 AREA. The first glyph of the text area can be partially visible.
5957 The first glyphs of other areas cannot. */
5958 if (area == LEFT_MARGIN_AREA)
5959 x = 0;
5960 else if (area == TEXT_AREA)
5961 x = row->x + window_box_width (w, LEFT_MARGIN_AREA);
5962 else
5963 x = (window_box_width (w, LEFT_MARGIN_AREA)
5964 + window_box_width (w, TEXT_AREA));
5965
5966 if (area == TEXT_AREA && row->fill_line_p)
5967 /* If row extends face to end of line write the whole line. */
5968 x_draw_glyphs (w, x, row, area,
5969 0, row->used[area],
5970 row->inverse_p ? DRAW_INVERSE_VIDEO : DRAW_NORMAL_TEXT,
5971 NULL, NULL, 0);
5972 else
5973 {
5974 /* Find the first glyph that must be redrawn. */
5975 while (first < end
5976 && x + first->pixel_width < r->left)
5977 {
5978 x += first->pixel_width;
5979 ++first;
5980 }
5981
5982 /* Find the last one. */
5983 last = first;
5984 first_x = x;
5985 while (last < end
5986 && x < r->right)
5987 {
5988 x += last->pixel_width;
5989 ++last;
5990 }
5991
5992 /* Repaint. */
5993 if (last > first)
5994 x_draw_glyphs (w, first_x, row, area,
5995 first - row->glyphs[area],
5996 last - row->glyphs[area],
5997 row->inverse_p ? DRAW_INVERSE_VIDEO : DRAW_NORMAL_TEXT,
5998 NULL, NULL, 0);
5999 }
6000}
6001
6002
6003/* Redraw the parts of the glyph row ROW on window W intersecting
6004 rectangle R. R is in window-relative coordinates. */
6005
6006static void
6007expose_line (w, row, r)
6008 struct window *w;
6009 struct glyph_row *row;
6010 Rect *r;
6011{
6012 xassert (row->enabled_p);
6013
6014 if (row->mode_line_p || w->pseudo_window_p)
6015 x_draw_glyphs (w, 0, row, TEXT_AREA, 0, row->used[TEXT_AREA],
6016 row->inverse_p ? DRAW_INVERSE_VIDEO : DRAW_NORMAL_TEXT,
6017 NULL, NULL, 0);
6018 else
6019 {
6020 if (row->used[LEFT_MARGIN_AREA])
6021 expose_area (w, row, r, LEFT_MARGIN_AREA);
6022 if (row->used[TEXT_AREA])
6023 expose_area (w, row, r, TEXT_AREA);
6024 if (row->used[RIGHT_MARGIN_AREA])
6025 expose_area (w, row, r, RIGHT_MARGIN_AREA);
6026 x_draw_row_bitmaps (w, row);
6027 }
6028}
6029
6030
6031/* Return non-zero if W's cursor intersects rectangle R. */
6032
6033static int
6034x_phys_cursor_in_rect_p (w, r)
6035 struct window *w;
6036 Rect *r;
6037{
6038 Rect cr, result;
6039 struct glyph *cursor_glyph;
6040
6041 cursor_glyph = get_phys_cursor_glyph (w);
6042 if (cursor_glyph)
6043 {
6044 cr.left = w->phys_cursor.x;
6045 cr.top = w->phys_cursor.y;
6046 cr.right = cr.left + cursor_glyph->pixel_width;
6047 cr.bottom = cr.top + w->phys_cursor_height;
6048 return x_intersect_rectangles (&cr, r, &result);
6049 }
6050 else
6051 return 0;
6052}
6053
6054
6055/* Redraw a rectangle of window W. R is a rectangle in window
6056 relative coordinates. Call this function with input blocked. */
6057
6058static void
6059expose_window (w, r)
6060 struct window *w;
6061 Rect *r;
6062{
6063 struct glyph_row *row;
6064 int y;
6065 int yb = window_text_bottom_y (w);
6066 int cursor_cleared_p;
6067
6068 /* If window is not yet fully initialized, do nothing. This can
6069 happen when toolkit scroll bars are used and a window is split.
6070 Reconfiguring the scroll bar will generate an expose for a newly
6071 created window. */
6072 if (w->current_matrix == NULL)
6073 return;
6074
6075 TRACE ((stderr, "expose_window (%d, %d, %d, %d)\n",
6076 r->left, r->top, r->right, r->bottom));
6077
6078 /* Convert to window coordinates. */
6079 r->left = FRAME_TO_WINDOW_PIXEL_X (w, r->left);
6080 r->top = FRAME_TO_WINDOW_PIXEL_Y (w, r->top);
6081 r->right = FRAME_TO_WINDOW_PIXEL_X (w, r->right);
6082 r->bottom = FRAME_TO_WINDOW_PIXEL_Y (w, r->bottom);
6083
6084 /* Turn off the cursor. */
6085 if (!w->pseudo_window_p
6086 && x_phys_cursor_in_rect_p (w, r))
6087 {
6088 x_clear_cursor (w);
6089 cursor_cleared_p = 1;
6090 }
6091 else
6092 cursor_cleared_p = 0;
6093
6094 /* Find the first row intersecting the rectangle R. */
6095 row = w->current_matrix->rows;
6096 y = 0;
6097 while (row->enabled_p
6098 && y < yb
6099 && y + row->height < r->top)
6100 {
6101 y += row->height;
6102 ++row;
6103 }
6104
6105 /* Display the text in the rectangle, one text line at a time. */
6106 while (row->enabled_p
6107 && y < yb
6108 && y < r->bottom)
6109 {
6110 expose_line (w, row, r);
6111 y += row->height;
6112 ++row;
6113 }
6114
6115 /* Display the mode line if there is one. */
6116 if (WINDOW_WANTS_MODELINE_P (w)
6117 && (row = MATRIX_MODE_LINE_ROW (w->current_matrix),
6118 row->enabled_p)
6119 && row->y < r->bottom)
6120 expose_line (w, row, r);
6121
6122 if (!w->pseudo_window_p)
6123 {
6124 /* Draw border between windows. */
6125 x_draw_vertical_border (w);
6126
6127 /* Turn the cursor on again. */
6128 if (cursor_cleared_p)
6129 x_update_window_cursor (w, 1);
6130 }
6131
6132 /* Display scroll bar for this window. */
6133 if (!NILP (w->vertical_scroll_bar))
6134 {
6135 ControlHandle ch
6136 = SCROLL_BAR_CONTROL_HANDLE (XSCROLL_BAR (w->vertical_scroll_bar));
6137
6138 Draw1Control (ch);
6139 }
6140}
6141
6142
6143/* Determine the intersection of two rectangles R1 and R2. Return
6144 the intersection in *RESULT. Value is non-zero if RESULT is not
6145 empty. */
6146
6147static int
6148x_intersect_rectangles (r1, r2, result)
6149 Rect *r1, *r2, *result;
6150{
6151 Rect *left, *right;
6152 Rect *upper, *lower;
6153 int intersection_p = 0;
6154
6155 /* Rerrange so that R1 is the left-most rectangle. */
6156 if (r1->left < r2->left)
6157 left = r1, right = r2;
6158 else
6159 left = r2, right = r1;
6160
6161 /* X0 of the intersection is right.x0, if this is inside R1,
6162 otherwise there is no intersection. */
6163 if (right->left <= left->right)
6164 {
6165 result->left = right->left;
6166
6167 /* The right end of the intersection is the minimum of the
6168 the right ends of left and right. */
6169 result->right = min (left->right, right->right);
6170
6171 /* Same game for Y. */
6172 if (r1->top < r2->top)
6173 upper = r1, lower = r2;
6174 else
6175 upper = r2, lower = r1;
6176
6177 /* The upper end of the intersection is lower.y0, if this is inside
6178 of upper. Otherwise, there is no intersection. */
6179 if (lower->top <= upper->bottom)
6180 {
6181 result->top = lower->top;
6182
6183 /* The lower end of the intersection is the minimum of the lower
6184 ends of upper and lower. */
6185 result->bottom = min (lower->bottom, upper->bottom);
6186 intersection_p = 1;
6187 }
6188 }
6189
6190 return intersection_p;
6191}
6192
6193
6194
6195
6196\f
6197static void
6198frame_highlight (f)
6199 struct frame *f;
6200{
6201 x_update_cursor (f, 1);
6202}
6203
6204static void
6205frame_unhighlight (f)
6206 struct frame *f;
6207{
6208 x_update_cursor (f, 1);
6209}
6210
6211/* The focus has changed. Update the frames as necessary to reflect
6212 the new situation. Note that we can't change the selected frame
6213 here, because the Lisp code we are interrupting might become confused.
6214 Each event gets marked with the frame in which it occurred, so the
6215 Lisp code can tell when the switch took place by examining the events. */
6216
6217static void
6218x_new_focus_frame (dpyinfo, frame)
6219 struct x_display_info *dpyinfo;
6220 struct frame *frame;
6221{
6222 struct frame *old_focus = dpyinfo->x_focus_frame;
6223
6224 if (frame != dpyinfo->x_focus_frame)
6225 {
6226 /* Set this before calling other routines, so that they see
6227 the correct value of x_focus_frame. */
6228 dpyinfo->x_focus_frame = frame;
6229
6230 if (old_focus && old_focus->auto_lower)
6231 x_lower_frame (old_focus);
6232
6233#if 0
6234 selected_frame = frame;
6235 XSETFRAME (XWINDOW (selected_frame->selected_window)->frame,
6236 selected_frame);
6237 Fselect_window (selected_frame->selected_window);
6238 choose_minibuf_frame ();
6239#endif /* ! 0 */
6240
6241 if (dpyinfo->x_focus_frame && dpyinfo->x_focus_frame->auto_raise)
6242 pending_autoraise_frame = dpyinfo->x_focus_frame;
6243 else
6244 pending_autoraise_frame = 0;
6245 }
6246
6247 x_frame_rehighlight (dpyinfo);
6248}
6249
6250/* Handle an event saying the mouse has moved out of an Emacs frame. */
6251
6252static void
6253x_mouse_leave (dpyinfo)
6254 struct x_display_info *dpyinfo;
6255{
6256 x_new_focus_frame (dpyinfo, dpyinfo->x_focus_event_frame);
6257}
6258
6259/* The focus has changed, or we have redirected a frame's focus to
6260 another frame (this happens when a frame uses a surrogate
6261 mini-buffer frame). Shift the highlight as appropriate.
6262
6263 The FRAME argument doesn't necessarily have anything to do with which
6264 frame is being highlighted or un-highlighted; we only use it to find
6265 the appropriate X display info. */
6266
6267void
6268XTframe_rehighlight (frame)
6269 struct frame *frame;
6270{
6271 x_frame_rehighlight (FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (frame));
6272}
6273
6274static void
6275x_frame_rehighlight (dpyinfo)
6276 struct x_display_info *dpyinfo;
6277{
6278 struct frame *old_highlight = dpyinfo->x_highlight_frame;
6279
6280 if (dpyinfo->x_focus_frame)
6281 {
6282 dpyinfo->x_highlight_frame
6283 = ((GC_FRAMEP (FRAME_FOCUS_FRAME (dpyinfo->x_focus_frame)))
6284 ? XFRAME (FRAME_FOCUS_FRAME (dpyinfo->x_focus_frame))
6285 : dpyinfo->x_focus_frame);
6286 if (! FRAME_LIVE_P (dpyinfo->x_highlight_frame))
6287 {
6288 FRAME_FOCUS_FRAME (dpyinfo->x_focus_frame) = Qnil;
6289 dpyinfo->x_highlight_frame = dpyinfo->x_focus_frame;
6290 }
6291 }
6292 else
6293 dpyinfo->x_highlight_frame = 0;
6294
6295 if (dpyinfo->x_highlight_frame != old_highlight)
6296 {
6297 if (old_highlight)
6298 frame_unhighlight (old_highlight);
6299 if (dpyinfo->x_highlight_frame)
6300 frame_highlight (dpyinfo->x_highlight_frame);
6301 }
6302}
6303
6304
6305\f
6306/* Keyboard processing - modifier keys, vendor-specific keysyms, etc. */
6307
6308#if 0
6309/* Initialize mode_switch_bit and modifier_meaning. */
6310static void
6311x_find_modifier_meanings (dpyinfo)
6312 struct x_display_info *dpyinfo;
6313{
6314 int min_code, max_code;
6315 KeySym *syms;
6316 int syms_per_code;
6317 XModifierKeymap *mods;
6318
6319 dpyinfo->meta_mod_mask = 0;
6320 dpyinfo->shift_lock_mask = 0;
6321 dpyinfo->alt_mod_mask = 0;
6322 dpyinfo->super_mod_mask = 0;
6323 dpyinfo->hyper_mod_mask = 0;
6324
6325#ifdef HAVE_X11R4
6326 XDisplayKeycodes (dpyinfo->display, &min_code, &max_code);
6327#else
6328 min_code = dpyinfo->display->min_keycode;
6329 max_code = dpyinfo->display->max_keycode;
6330#endif
6331
6332 syms = XGetKeyboardMapping (dpyinfo->display,
6333 min_code, max_code - min_code + 1,
6334 &syms_per_code);
6335 mods = XGetModifierMapping (dpyinfo->display);
6336
6337 /* Scan the modifier table to see which modifier bits the Meta and
6338 Alt keysyms are on. */
6339 {
6340 int row, col; /* The row and column in the modifier table. */
6341
6342 for (row = 3; row < 8; row++)
6343 for (col = 0; col < mods->max_keypermod; col++)
6344 {
6345 KeyCode code
6346 = mods->modifiermap[(row * mods->max_keypermod) + col];
6347
6348 /* Zeroes are used for filler. Skip them. */
6349 if (code == 0)
6350 continue;
6351
6352 /* Are any of this keycode's keysyms a meta key? */
6353 {
6354 int code_col;
6355
6356 for (code_col = 0; code_col < syms_per_code; code_col++)
6357 {
6358 int sym = syms[((code - min_code) * syms_per_code) + code_col];
6359
6360 switch (sym)
6361 {
6362 case XK_Meta_L:
6363 case XK_Meta_R:
6364 dpyinfo->meta_mod_mask |= (1 << row);
6365 break;
6366
6367 case XK_Alt_L:
6368 case XK_Alt_R:
6369 dpyinfo->alt_mod_mask |= (1 << row);
6370 break;
6371
6372 case XK_Hyper_L:
6373 case XK_Hyper_R:
6374 dpyinfo->hyper_mod_mask |= (1 << row);
6375 break;
6376
6377 case XK_Super_L:
6378 case XK_Super_R:
6379 dpyinfo->super_mod_mask |= (1 << row);
6380 break;
6381
6382 case XK_Shift_Lock:
6383 /* Ignore this if it's not on the lock modifier. */
6384 if ((1 << row) == LockMask)
6385 dpyinfo->shift_lock_mask = LockMask;
6386 break;
6387 }
6388 }
6389 }
6390 }
6391 }
6392
6393 /* If we couldn't find any meta keys, accept any alt keys as meta keys. */
6394 if (! dpyinfo->meta_mod_mask)
6395 {
6396 dpyinfo->meta_mod_mask = dpyinfo->alt_mod_mask;
6397 dpyinfo->alt_mod_mask = 0;
6398 }
6399
6400 /* If some keys are both alt and meta,
6401 make them just meta, not alt. */
6402 if (dpyinfo->alt_mod_mask & dpyinfo->meta_mod_mask)
6403 {
6404 dpyinfo->alt_mod_mask &= ~dpyinfo->meta_mod_mask;
6405 }
6406
6407 XFree ((char *) syms);
6408 XFreeModifiermap (mods);
6409}
6410
6411#endif
6412
6413/* Convert between the modifier bits X uses and the modifier bits
6414 Emacs uses. */
6415
6416static unsigned int
6417x_mac_to_emacs_modifiers (dpyinfo, state)
6418 struct x_display_info *dpyinfo;
6419 unsigned short state;
6420{
6421 return (((state & shiftKey) ? shift_modifier : 0)
6422 | ((state & controlKey) ? ctrl_modifier : 0)
6423 | ((state & cmdKey) ? meta_modifier : 0)
6424 | ((state & optionKey) ? alt_modifier : 0));
6425}
6426
6427#if 0
6428static unsigned short
6429x_emacs_to_x_modifiers (dpyinfo, state)
6430 struct x_display_info *dpyinfo;
6431 unsigned int state;
6432{
6433 return ( ((state & alt_modifier) ? dpyinfo->alt_mod_mask : 0)
6434 | ((state & super_modifier) ? dpyinfo->super_mod_mask : 0)
6435 | ((state & hyper_modifier) ? dpyinfo->hyper_mod_mask : 0)
6436 | ((state & shift_modifier) ? ShiftMask : 0)
6437 | ((state & ctrl_modifier) ? ControlMask : 0)
6438 | ((state & meta_modifier) ? dpyinfo->meta_mod_mask : 0));
6439}
6440#endif
6441
6442/* Convert a keysym to its name. */
6443
6444char *
6445x_get_keysym_name (keysym)
6446 int keysym;
6447{
6448 char *value;
6449
6450 BLOCK_INPUT;
6451#if 0
6452 value = XKeysymToString (keysym);
6453#else
6454 value = 0;
6455#endif
6456 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
6457
6458 return value;
6459}
6460
6461
6462\f
6463/* Mouse clicks and mouse movement. Rah. */
6464
6465/* Given a pixel position (PIX_X, PIX_Y) on frame F, return glyph
6466 co-ordinates in (*X, *Y). Set *BOUNDS to the rectangle that the
6467 glyph at X, Y occupies, if BOUNDS != 0. If NOCLIP is non-zero, do
6468 not force the value into range. */
6469
6470void
6471pixel_to_glyph_coords (f, pix_x, pix_y, x, y, bounds, noclip)
6472 FRAME_PTR f;
6473 register int pix_x, pix_y;
6474 register int *x, *y;
6475 Rect *bounds;
6476 int noclip;
6477{
6478 /* Arrange for the division in PIXEL_TO_CHAR_COL etc. to round down
6479 even for negative values. */
6480 if (pix_x < 0)
6481 pix_x -= FONT_WIDTH ((f)->output_data.mac->font) - 1;
6482 if (pix_y < 0)
6483 pix_y -= (f)->output_data.mac->line_height - 1;
6484
6485 pix_x = PIXEL_TO_CHAR_COL (f, pix_x);
6486 pix_y = PIXEL_TO_CHAR_ROW (f, pix_y);
6487
6488 if (bounds)
6489 {
6490 bounds->left = CHAR_TO_PIXEL_COL (f, pix_x);
6491 bounds->top = CHAR_TO_PIXEL_ROW (f, pix_y);
6492 bounds->right = bounds->left + FONT_WIDTH (f->output_data.mac->font);
6493 bounds->bottom = bounds->top + f->output_data.mac->line_height;
6494 }
6495
6496 if (!noclip)
6497 {
6498 if (pix_x < 0)
6499 pix_x = 0;
6500 else if (pix_x > FRAME_WINDOW_WIDTH (f))
6501 pix_x = FRAME_WINDOW_WIDTH (f);
6502
6503 if (pix_y < 0)
6504 pix_y = 0;
6505 else if (pix_y > f->height)
6506 pix_y = f->height;
6507 }
6508
6509 *x = pix_x;
6510 *y = pix_y;
6511}
6512
6513
6514/* Given HPOS/VPOS in the current matrix of W, return corresponding
6515 frame-relative pixel positions in *FRAME_X and *FRAME_Y. If we
6516 can't tell the positions because W's display is not up to date,
6517 return 0. */
6518
6519static int
6520glyph_to_pixel_coords (w, hpos, vpos, frame_x, frame_y)
6521 struct window *w;
6522 int hpos, vpos;
6523 int *frame_x, *frame_y;
6524{
6525 int success_p;
6526
6527 xassert (hpos >= 0 && hpos < w->current_matrix->matrix_w);
6528 xassert (vpos >= 0 && vpos < w->current_matrix->matrix_h);
6529
6530 if (display_completed)
6531 {
6532 struct glyph_row *row = MATRIX_ROW (w->current_matrix, vpos);
6533 struct glyph *glyph = row->glyphs[TEXT_AREA];
6534 struct glyph *end = glyph + min (hpos, row->used[TEXT_AREA]);
6535
6536 *frame_y = row->y;
6537 *frame_x = row->x;
6538 while (glyph < end)
6539 {
6540 *frame_x += glyph->pixel_width;
6541 ++glyph;
6542 }
6543
6544 success_p = 1;
6545 }
6546 else
6547 {
6548 *frame_y = *frame_x = 0;
6549 success_p = 0;
6550 }
6551
6552 *frame_y = WINDOW_TO_FRAME_PIXEL_Y (w, *frame_y);
6553 *frame_x = WINDOW_TO_FRAME_PIXEL_X (w, *frame_x);
6554 return success_p;
6555}
6556
6557
6558/* Prepare a mouse-event in *RESULT for placement in the input queue.
6559
6560 If the event is a button press, then note that we have grabbed
6561 the mouse. */
6562
6563static Lisp_Object
6564construct_mouse_click (result, event, f)
6565 struct input_event *result;
6566 EventRecord *event;
6567 struct frame *f;
6568{
6569 Point mouseLoc;
6570
6571 result->kind = mouse_click;
6572 result->code = 0; /* only one mouse button */
6573 result->timestamp = event->when;
6574 result->modifiers = event->what == mouseDown ? down_modifier : up_modifier;
6575
6576 mouseLoc = event->where;
6577 SetPort (FRAME_MAC_WINDOW (f));
6578 GlobalToLocal (&mouseLoc);
6579 XSETINT (result->x, mouseLoc.h);
6580 XSETINT (result->y, mouseLoc.v);
6581
6582 XSETFRAME (result->frame_or_window, f);
6583
6584 result->arg = Qnil;
6585 return Qnil;
6586}
6587
6588\f
6589/* Function to report a mouse movement to the mainstream Emacs code.
6590 The input handler calls this.
6591
6592 We have received a mouse movement event, which is given in *event.
6593 If the mouse is over a different glyph than it was last time, tell
6594 the mainstream emacs code by setting mouse_moved. If not, ask for
6595 another motion event, so we can check again the next time it moves. */
6596
6597static Point last_mouse_motion_position;
6598static Lisp_Object last_mouse_motion_frame;
6599
6600static void
6601note_mouse_movement (frame, pos)
6602 FRAME_PTR frame;
6603 Point *pos;
6604{
6605 last_mouse_movement_time = TickCount () * (1000 / 60); /* to milliseconds */
6606 last_mouse_motion_position = *pos;
6607 XSETFRAME (last_mouse_motion_frame, frame);
6608
6609 if (!PtInRect (*pos, &FRAME_MAC_WINDOW (frame)->portRect))
6610 {
6611 frame->mouse_moved = 1;
6612 last_mouse_scroll_bar = Qnil;
6613 note_mouse_highlight (frame, -1, -1);
6614 }
6615 /* Has the mouse moved off the glyph it was on at the last sighting? */
6616 else if (pos->h < last_mouse_glyph.left
6617 || pos->h >= last_mouse_glyph.right
6618 || pos->v < last_mouse_glyph.top
6619 || pos->v >= last_mouse_glyph.bottom)
6620 {
6621 frame->mouse_moved = 1;
6622 last_mouse_scroll_bar = Qnil;
6623 note_mouse_highlight (frame, pos->h, pos->v);
6624 }
6625}
6626
6627/* This is used for debugging, to turn off note_mouse_highlight. */
6628
6629int disable_mouse_highlight;
6630
6631
6632\f
6633/************************************************************************
6634 Mouse Face
6635 ************************************************************************/
6636
6637/* Find the glyph under window-relative coordinates X/Y in window W.
6638 Consider only glyphs from buffer text, i.e. no glyphs from overlay
6639 strings. Return in *HPOS and *VPOS the row and column number of
6640 the glyph found. Return in *AREA the glyph area containing X.
6641 Value is a pointer to the glyph found or null if X/Y is not on
6642 text, or we can't tell because W's current matrix is not up to
6643 date. */
6644
6645static struct glyph *
6646x_y_to_hpos_vpos (w, x, y, hpos, vpos, area)
6647 struct window *w;
6648 int x, y;
6649 int *hpos, *vpos, *area;
6650{
6651 struct glyph *glyph, *end;
6652 struct glyph_row *row = NULL;
6653 int x0, i, left_area_width;
6654
6655 /* Find row containing Y. Give up if some row is not enabled. */
6656 for (i = 0; i < w->current_matrix->nrows; ++i)
6657 {
6658 row = MATRIX_ROW (w->current_matrix, i);
6659 if (!row->enabled_p)
6660 return NULL;
6661 if (y >= row->y && y < MATRIX_ROW_BOTTOM_Y (row))
6662 break;
6663 }
6664
6665 *vpos = i;
6666 *hpos = 0;
6667
6668 /* Give up if Y is not in the window. */
6669 if (i == w->current_matrix->nrows)
6670 return NULL;
6671
6672 /* Get the glyph area containing X. */
6673 if (w->pseudo_window_p)
6674 {
6675 *area = TEXT_AREA;
6676 x0 = 0;
6677 }
6678 else
6679 {
6680 left_area_width = window_box_width (w, LEFT_MARGIN_AREA);
6681 if (x < left_area_width)
6682 {
6683 *area = LEFT_MARGIN_AREA;
6684 x0 = 0;
6685 }
6686 else if (x < left_area_width + window_box_width (w, TEXT_AREA))
6687 {
6688 *area = TEXT_AREA;
6689 x0 = row->x + left_area_width;
6690 }
6691 else
6692 {
6693 *area = RIGHT_MARGIN_AREA;
6694 x0 = left_area_width + window_box_width (w, TEXT_AREA);
6695 }
6696 }
6697
6698 /* Find glyph containing X. */
6699 glyph = row->glyphs[*area];
6700 end = glyph + row->used[*area];
6701 while (glyph < end)
6702 {
6703 if (x < x0 + glyph->pixel_width)
6704 {
6705 if (w->pseudo_window_p)
6706 break;
6707 else if (BUFFERP (glyph->object))
6708 break;
6709 }
6710
6711 x0 += glyph->pixel_width;
6712 ++glyph;
6713 }
6714
6715 if (glyph == end)
6716 return NULL;
6717
6718 *hpos = glyph - row->glyphs[*area];
6719 return glyph;
6720}
6721
6722
6723/* Convert frame-relative x/y to coordinates relative to window W.
6724 Takes pseudo-windows into account. */
6725
6726static void
6727frame_to_window_pixel_xy (w, x, y)
6728 struct window *w;
6729 int *x, *y;
6730{
6731 if (w->pseudo_window_p)
6732 {
6733 /* A pseudo-window is always full-width, and starts at the
6734 left edge of the frame, plus a frame border. */
6735 struct frame *f = XFRAME (w->frame);
6736 *x -= FRAME_INTERNAL_BORDER_WIDTH_SAFE (f);
6737 *y = FRAME_TO_WINDOW_PIXEL_Y (w, *y);
6738 }
6739 else
6740 {
6741 *x = FRAME_TO_WINDOW_PIXEL_X (w, *x);
6742 *y = FRAME_TO_WINDOW_PIXEL_Y (w, *y);
6743 }
6744}
6745
6746
6747/* Take proper action when mouse has moved to the mode or top line of
6748 window W, x-position X. MODE_LINE_P non-zero means mouse is on the
6749 mode line. X is relative to the start of the text display area of
6750 W, so the width of bitmap areas and scroll bars must be subtracted
6751 to get a position relative to the start of the mode line. */
6752
6753static void
6754note_mode_line_highlight (w, x, mode_line_p)
6755 struct window *w;
6756 int x, mode_line_p;
6757{
6758 struct frame *f = XFRAME (w->frame);
6759 struct mac_display_info *dpyinfo = FRAME_MAC_DISPLAY_INFO (f);
6760 Cursor cursor = dpyinfo->vertical_scroll_bar_cursor;
6761 struct glyph_row *row;
6762
6763 if (mode_line_p)
6764 row = MATRIX_MODE_LINE_ROW (w->current_matrix);
6765 else
6766 row = MATRIX_HEADER_LINE_ROW (w->current_matrix);
6767
6768 if (row->enabled_p)
6769 {
6770 struct glyph *glyph, *end;
6771 Lisp_Object help, map;
6772 int x0;
6773
6774 /* Find the glyph under X. */
6775 glyph = row->glyphs[TEXT_AREA];
6776 end = glyph + row->used[TEXT_AREA];
6777 x0 = - (FRAME_LEFT_SCROLL_BAR_WIDTH (f) * CANON_X_UNIT (f)
6778 + FRAME_X_LEFT_FLAGS_AREA_WIDTH (f));
6779 while (glyph < end
6780 && x >= x0 + glyph->pixel_width)
6781 {
6782 x0 += glyph->pixel_width;
6783 ++glyph;
6784 }
6785
6786 if (glyph < end
6787 && STRINGP (glyph->object)
6788 && XSTRING (glyph->object)->intervals
6789 && glyph->charpos >= 0
6790 && glyph->charpos < XSTRING (glyph->object)->size)
6791 {
6792 /* If we're on a string with `help-echo' text property,
6793 arrange for the help to be displayed. This is done by
6794 setting the global variable help_echo to the help string. */
6795 help = Fget_text_property (make_number (glyph->charpos),
6796 Qhelp_echo, glyph->object);
6797 if (!NILP (help))
6798 {
6799 help_echo = help;
6800 XSETWINDOW (help_echo_window, w);
6801 help_echo_object = glyph->object;
6802 help_echo_pos = glyph->charpos;
6803 }
6804
6805 /* Change the mouse pointer according to what is under X/Y. */
6806 map = Fget_text_property (make_number (glyph->charpos),
6807 Qlocal_map, glyph->object);
6808 if (!NILP (Fkeymapp (map)))
6809 cursor = f->output_data.mac->nontext_cursor;
6810 else
6811 {
6812 map = Fget_text_property (make_number (glyph->charpos),
6813 Qkeymap, glyph->object);
6814 if (!NILP (Fkeymapp (map)))
6815 cursor = f->output_data.mac->nontext_cursor;
6816 }
6817 }
6818 }
6819
6820#if 0 /* MAC_TODO: mouse cursor */
6821 XDefineCursor (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_X_WINDOW (f), cursor);
6822#endif
6823}
6824
6825
6826/* Take proper action when the mouse has moved to position X, Y on
6827 frame F as regards highlighting characters that have mouse-face
6828 properties. Also de-highlighting chars where the mouse was before.
6829 X and Y can be negative or out of range. */
6830
6831static void
6832note_mouse_highlight (f, x, y)
6833 struct frame *f;
6834 int x, y;
6835{
6836 struct mac_display_info *dpyinfo = FRAME_MAC_DISPLAY_INFO (f);
6837 int portion;
6838 Lisp_Object window;
6839 struct window *w;
6840
6841 /* When a menu is active, don't highlight because this looks odd. */
6842#ifdef USE_X_TOOLKIT
6843 if (popup_activated ())
6844 return;
6845#endif
6846
6847 if (disable_mouse_highlight
6848 || !f->glyphs_initialized_p)
6849 return;
6850
6851 dpyinfo->mouse_face_mouse_x = x;
6852 dpyinfo->mouse_face_mouse_y = y;
6853 dpyinfo->mouse_face_mouse_frame = f;
6854
6855 if (dpyinfo->mouse_face_defer)
6856 return;
6857
6858 if (gc_in_progress)
6859 {
6860 dpyinfo->mouse_face_deferred_gc = 1;
6861 return;
6862 }
6863
6864 /* Which window is that in? */
6865 window = window_from_coordinates (f, x, y, &portion, 1);
6866
6867 /* If we were displaying active text in another window, clear that. */
6868 if (! EQ (window, dpyinfo->mouse_face_window))
6869 clear_mouse_face (dpyinfo);
6870
6871 /* Not on a window -> return. */
6872 if (!WINDOWP (window))
6873 return;
6874
6875 /* Convert to window-relative pixel coordinates. */
6876 w = XWINDOW (window);
6877 frame_to_window_pixel_xy (w, &x, &y);
6878
6879 /* Handle tool-bar window differently since it doesn't display a
6880 buffer. */
6881 if (EQ (window, f->tool_bar_window))
6882 {
6883 note_tool_bar_highlight (f, x, y);
6884 return;
6885 }
6886
6887 if (portion == 1 || portion == 3)
6888 {
6889 /* Mouse is on the mode or top line. */
6890 note_mode_line_highlight (w, x, portion == 1);
6891 return;
6892 }
6893#if 0 /* MAC_TODO: mouse cursor */
6894 else
6895 XDefineCursor (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_X_WINDOW (f),
6896 f->output_data.x->text_cursor);
6897#endif
6898
6899 /* Are we in a window whose display is up to date?
6900 And verify the buffer's text has not changed. */
6901 if (/* Within text portion of the window. */
6902 portion == 0
6903 && EQ (w->window_end_valid, w->buffer)
6904 && XFASTINT (w->last_modified) == BUF_MODIFF (XBUFFER (w->buffer))
6905 && (XFASTINT (w->last_overlay_modified)
6906 == BUF_OVERLAY_MODIFF (XBUFFER (w->buffer))))
6907 {
6908 int hpos, vpos, pos, i, area;
6909 struct glyph *glyph;
6910
6911 /* Find the glyph under X/Y. */
6912 glyph = x_y_to_hpos_vpos (w, x, y, &hpos, &vpos, &area);
6913
6914 /* Clear mouse face if X/Y not over text. */
6915 if (glyph == NULL
6916 || area != TEXT_AREA
6917 || !MATRIX_ROW (w->current_matrix, vpos)->displays_text_p)
6918 {
6919 clear_mouse_face (dpyinfo);
6920 return;
6921 }
6922
6923 pos = glyph->charpos;
6924 xassert (w->pseudo_window_p || BUFFERP (glyph->object));
6925
6926 /* Check for mouse-face and help-echo. */
6927 {
6928 Lisp_Object mouse_face, overlay, position;
6929 Lisp_Object *overlay_vec;
6930 int len, noverlays;
6931 struct buffer *obuf;
6932 int obegv, ozv;
6933
6934 /* If we get an out-of-range value, return now; avoid an error. */
6935 if (pos > BUF_Z (XBUFFER (w->buffer)))
6936 return;
6937
6938 /* Make the window's buffer temporarily current for
6939 overlays_at and compute_char_face. */
6940 obuf = current_buffer;
6941 current_buffer = XBUFFER (w->buffer);
6942 obegv = BEGV;
6943 ozv = ZV;
6944 BEGV = BEG;
6945 ZV = Z;
6946
6947 /* Is this char mouse-active or does it have help-echo? */
6948 XSETINT (position, pos);
6949
6950 /* Put all the overlays we want in a vector in overlay_vec.
6951 Store the length in len. If there are more than 10, make
6952 enough space for all, and try again. */
6953 len = 10;
6954 overlay_vec = (Lisp_Object *) alloca (len * sizeof (Lisp_Object));
6955 noverlays = overlays_at (pos, 0, &overlay_vec, &len, NULL, NULL);
6956 if (noverlays > len)
6957 {
6958 len = noverlays;
6959 overlay_vec = (Lisp_Object *) alloca (len * sizeof (Lisp_Object));
6960 noverlays = overlays_at (pos, 0, &overlay_vec, &len, NULL, NULL);
6961 }
6962
6963 /* Sort overlays into increasing priority order. */
6964 noverlays = sort_overlays (overlay_vec, noverlays, w);
6965
6966 /* Check mouse-face highlighting. */
6967 if (! (EQ (window, dpyinfo->mouse_face_window)
6968 && vpos >= dpyinfo->mouse_face_beg_row
6969 && vpos <= dpyinfo->mouse_face_end_row
6970 && (vpos > dpyinfo->mouse_face_beg_row
6971 || hpos >= dpyinfo->mouse_face_beg_col)
6972 && (vpos < dpyinfo->mouse_face_end_row
6973 || hpos < dpyinfo->mouse_face_end_col
6974 || dpyinfo->mouse_face_past_end)))
6975 {
6976 /* Clear the display of the old active region, if any. */
6977 clear_mouse_face (dpyinfo);
6978
6979 /* Find the highest priority overlay that has a mouse-face prop. */
6980 overlay = Qnil;
6981 for (i = noverlays - 1; i >= 0; --i)
6982 {
6983 mouse_face = Foverlay_get (overlay_vec[i], Qmouse_face);
6984 if (!NILP (mouse_face))
6985 {
6986 overlay = overlay_vec[i];
6987 break;
6988 }
6989 }
6990
6991 /* If no overlay applies, get a text property. */
6992 if (NILP (overlay))
6993 mouse_face = Fget_text_property (position, Qmouse_face, w->buffer);
6994
6995 /* Handle the overlay case. */
6996 if (! NILP (overlay))
6997 {
6998 /* Find the range of text around this char that
6999 should be active. */
7000 Lisp_Object before, after;
7001 int ignore;
7002
7003 before = Foverlay_start (overlay);
7004 after = Foverlay_end (overlay);
7005 /* Record this as the current active region. */
7006 fast_find_position (w, XFASTINT (before),
7007 &dpyinfo->mouse_face_beg_col,
7008 &dpyinfo->mouse_face_beg_row,
7009 &dpyinfo->mouse_face_beg_x,
7010 &dpyinfo->mouse_face_beg_y);
7011 dpyinfo->mouse_face_past_end
7012 = !fast_find_position (w, XFASTINT (after),
7013 &dpyinfo->mouse_face_end_col,
7014 &dpyinfo->mouse_face_end_row,
7015 &dpyinfo->mouse_face_end_x,
7016 &dpyinfo->mouse_face_end_y);
7017 dpyinfo->mouse_face_window = window;
7018 dpyinfo->mouse_face_face_id
7019 = face_at_buffer_position (w, pos, 0, 0,
7020 &ignore, pos + 1, 1);
7021
7022 /* Display it as active. */
7023 show_mouse_face (dpyinfo, DRAW_MOUSE_FACE);
7024 }
7025 /* Handle the text property case. */
7026 else if (! NILP (mouse_face))
7027 {
7028 /* Find the range of text around this char that
7029 should be active. */
7030 Lisp_Object before, after, beginning, end;
7031 int ignore;
7032
7033 beginning = Fmarker_position (w->start);
7034 XSETINT (end, (BUF_Z (XBUFFER (w->buffer))
7035 - XFASTINT (w->window_end_pos)));
7036 before
7037 = Fprevious_single_property_change (make_number (pos + 1),
7038 Qmouse_face,
7039 w->buffer, beginning);
7040 after
7041 = Fnext_single_property_change (position, Qmouse_face,
7042 w->buffer, end);
7043 /* Record this as the current active region. */
7044 fast_find_position (w, XFASTINT (before),
7045 &dpyinfo->mouse_face_beg_col,
7046 &dpyinfo->mouse_face_beg_row,
7047 &dpyinfo->mouse_face_beg_x,
7048 &dpyinfo->mouse_face_beg_y);
7049 dpyinfo->mouse_face_past_end
7050 = !fast_find_position (w, XFASTINT (after),
7051 &dpyinfo->mouse_face_end_col,
7052 &dpyinfo->mouse_face_end_row,
7053 &dpyinfo->mouse_face_end_x,
7054 &dpyinfo->mouse_face_end_y);
7055 dpyinfo->mouse_face_window = window;
7056 dpyinfo->mouse_face_face_id
7057 = face_at_buffer_position (w, pos, 0, 0,
7058 &ignore, pos + 1, 1);
7059
7060 /* Display it as active. */
7061 show_mouse_face (dpyinfo, DRAW_MOUSE_FACE);
7062 }
7063 }
7064
7065 /* Look for a `help-echo' property. */
7066 {
7067 Lisp_Object help, overlay;
7068
7069 /* Check overlays first. */
7070 help = Qnil;
7071 for (i = noverlays - 1; i >= 0 && NILP (help); --i)
7072 {
7073 overlay = overlay_vec[i];
7074 help = Foverlay_get (overlay, Qhelp_echo);
7075 }
7076
7077 if (!NILP (help))
7078 {
7079 help_echo = help;
7080 help_echo_window = window;
7081 help_echo_object = overlay;
7082 help_echo_pos = pos;
7083 }
7084 else
7085 {
7086 /* Try text properties. */
7087 if ((STRINGP (glyph->object)
7088 && glyph->charpos >= 0
7089 && glyph->charpos < XSTRING (glyph->object)->size)
7090 || (BUFFERP (glyph->object)
7091 && glyph->charpos >= BEGV
7092 && glyph->charpos < ZV))
7093 help = Fget_text_property (make_number (glyph->charpos),
7094 Qhelp_echo, glyph->object);
7095
7096 if (!NILP (help))
7097 {
7098 help_echo = help;
7099 help_echo_window = window;
7100 help_echo_object = glyph->object;
7101 help_echo_pos = glyph->charpos;
7102 }
7103 }
7104 }
7105
7106 BEGV = obegv;
7107 ZV = ozv;
7108 current_buffer = obuf;
7109 }
7110 }
7111}
7112
7113static void
7114redo_mouse_highlight ()
7115{
7116 if (!NILP (last_mouse_motion_frame)
7117 && FRAME_LIVE_P (XFRAME (last_mouse_motion_frame)))
7118 note_mouse_highlight (XFRAME (last_mouse_motion_frame),
7119 last_mouse_motion_position.h,
7120 last_mouse_motion_position.v);
7121}
7122
7123
7124\f
7125/***********************************************************************
7126 Tool-bars
7127 ***********************************************************************/
7128
7129static int x_tool_bar_item P_ ((struct frame *, int, int,
7130 struct glyph **, int *, int *, int *));
7131
7132/* Tool-bar item index of the item on which a mouse button was pressed
7133 or -1. */
7134
7135static int last_tool_bar_item;
7136
7137
7138/* Get information about the tool-bar item at position X/Y on frame F.
7139 Return in *GLYPH a pointer to the glyph of the tool-bar item in
7140 the current matrix of the tool-bar window of F, or NULL if not
7141 on a tool-bar item. Return in *PROP_IDX the index of the tool-bar
7142 item in F->current_tool_bar_items. Value is
7143
7144 -1 if X/Y is not on a tool-bar item
7145 0 if X/Y is on the same item that was highlighted before.
7146 1 otherwise. */
7147
7148static int
7149x_tool_bar_item (f, x, y, glyph, hpos, vpos, prop_idx)
7150 struct frame *f;
7151 int x, y;
7152 struct glyph **glyph;
7153 int *hpos, *vpos, *prop_idx;
7154{
7155 struct mac_display_info *dpyinfo = FRAME_MAC_DISPLAY_INFO (f);
7156 struct window *w = XWINDOW (f->tool_bar_window);
7157 int area;
7158
7159 /* Find the glyph under X/Y. */
7160 *glyph = x_y_to_hpos_vpos (w, x, y, hpos, vpos, &area);
7161 if (*glyph == NULL)
7162 return -1;
7163
7164 /* Get the start of this tool-bar item's properties in
7165 f->current_tool_bar_items. */
7166 if (!tool_bar_item_info (f, *glyph, prop_idx))
7167 return -1;
7168
7169 /* Is mouse on the highlighted item? */
7170 if (EQ (f->tool_bar_window, dpyinfo->mouse_face_window)
7171 && *vpos >= dpyinfo->mouse_face_beg_row
7172 && *vpos <= dpyinfo->mouse_face_end_row
7173 && (*vpos > dpyinfo->mouse_face_beg_row
7174 || *hpos >= dpyinfo->mouse_face_beg_col)
7175 && (*vpos < dpyinfo->mouse_face_end_row
7176 || *hpos < dpyinfo->mouse_face_end_col
7177 || dpyinfo->mouse_face_past_end))
7178 return 0;
7179
7180 return 1;
7181}
7182
7183
7184/* Handle mouse button event on the tool-bar of frame F, at
7185 frame-relative coordinates X/Y. EVENT_TYPE is either ButtionPress
7186 or ButtonRelase. */
7187
7188static void
7189x_handle_tool_bar_click (f, button_event)
7190 struct frame *f;
7191 EventRecord *button_event;
7192{
7193 struct mac_display_info *dpyinfo = FRAME_MAC_DISPLAY_INFO (f);
7194 struct window *w = XWINDOW (f->tool_bar_window);
7195 int hpos, vpos, prop_idx;
7196 struct glyph *glyph;
7197 Lisp_Object enabled_p;
7198 int x = button_event->where.h;
7199 int y = button_event->where.v;
7200
7201 /* If not on the highlighted tool-bar item, return. */
7202 frame_to_window_pixel_xy (w, &x, &y);
7203 if (x_tool_bar_item (f, x, y, &glyph, &hpos, &vpos, &prop_idx) != 0)
7204 return;
7205
7206 /* If item is disabled, do nothing. */
7207 enabled_p = (XVECTOR (f->current_tool_bar_items)
7208 ->contents[prop_idx + TOOL_BAR_ITEM_ENABLED_P]);
7209 if (NILP (enabled_p))
7210 return;
7211
7212 if (button_event->what == mouseDown)
7213 {
7214 /* Show item in pressed state. */
7215 show_mouse_face (dpyinfo, DRAW_IMAGE_SUNKEN);
7216 dpyinfo->mouse_face_image_state = DRAW_IMAGE_SUNKEN;
7217 last_tool_bar_item = prop_idx;
7218 }
7219 else
7220 {
7221 Lisp_Object key, frame;
7222 struct input_event event;
7223
7224 /* Show item in released state. */
7225 show_mouse_face (dpyinfo, DRAW_IMAGE_RAISED);
7226 dpyinfo->mouse_face_image_state = DRAW_IMAGE_RAISED;
7227
7228 key = (XVECTOR (f->current_tool_bar_items)
7229 ->contents[prop_idx + TOOL_BAR_ITEM_KEY]);
7230
7231 XSETFRAME (frame, f);
7232 event.kind = TOOL_BAR_EVENT;
7233 event.frame_or_window = frame;
7234 event.arg = frame;
7235 kbd_buffer_store_event (&event);
7236
7237 event.kind = TOOL_BAR_EVENT;
7238 event.frame_or_window = frame;
7239 event.arg = key;
7240 event.modifiers = x_mac_to_emacs_modifiers (FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f),
7241 button_event->modifiers);
7242 kbd_buffer_store_event (&event);
7243 last_tool_bar_item = -1;
7244 }
7245}
7246
7247
7248/* Possibly highlight a tool-bar item on frame F when mouse moves to
7249 tool-bar window-relative coordinates X/Y. Called from
7250 note_mouse_highlight. */
7251
7252static void
7253note_tool_bar_highlight (f, x, y)
7254 struct frame *f;
7255 int x, y;
7256{
7257 Lisp_Object window = f->tool_bar_window;
7258 struct window *w = XWINDOW (window);
7259 struct mac_display_info *dpyinfo = FRAME_MAC_DISPLAY_INFO (f);
7260 int hpos, vpos;
7261 struct glyph *glyph;
7262 struct glyph_row *row;
7263 int i;
7264 Lisp_Object enabled_p;
7265 int prop_idx;
7266 enum draw_glyphs_face draw = DRAW_IMAGE_RAISED;
7267 int mouse_down_p, rc;
7268
7269 /* Function note_mouse_highlight is called with negative x(y
7270 values when mouse moves outside of the frame. */
7271 if (x <= 0 || y <= 0)
7272 {
7273 clear_mouse_face (dpyinfo);
7274 return;
7275 }
7276
7277 rc = x_tool_bar_item (f, x, y, &glyph, &hpos, &vpos, &prop_idx);
7278 if (rc < 0)
7279 {
7280 /* Not on tool-bar item. */
7281 clear_mouse_face (dpyinfo);
7282 return;
7283 }
7284 else if (rc == 0)
7285 /* On same tool-bar item as before. */
7286 goto set_help_echo;
7287
7288 clear_mouse_face (dpyinfo);
7289
7290 /* Mouse is down, but on different tool-bar item? */
7291 mouse_down_p = (dpyinfo->grabbed
7292 && f == last_mouse_frame
7293 && FRAME_LIVE_P (f));
7294 if (mouse_down_p
7295 && last_tool_bar_item != prop_idx)
7296 return;
7297
7298 dpyinfo->mouse_face_image_state = DRAW_NORMAL_TEXT;
7299 draw = mouse_down_p ? DRAW_IMAGE_SUNKEN : DRAW_IMAGE_RAISED;
7300
7301 /* If tool-bar item is not enabled, don't highlight it. */
7302 enabled_p = (XVECTOR (f->current_tool_bar_items)
7303 ->contents[prop_idx + TOOL_BAR_ITEM_ENABLED_P]);
7304 if (!NILP (enabled_p))
7305 {
7306 /* Compute the x-position of the glyph. In front and past the
7307 image is a space. We include this is the highlighted area. */
7308 row = MATRIX_ROW (w->current_matrix, vpos);
7309 for (i = x = 0; i < hpos; ++i)
7310 x += row->glyphs[TEXT_AREA][i].pixel_width;
7311
7312 /* Record this as the current active region. */
7313 dpyinfo->mouse_face_beg_col = hpos;
7314 dpyinfo->mouse_face_beg_row = vpos;
7315 dpyinfo->mouse_face_beg_x = x;
7316 dpyinfo->mouse_face_beg_y = row->y;
7317 dpyinfo->mouse_face_past_end = 0;
7318
7319 dpyinfo->mouse_face_end_col = hpos + 1;
7320 dpyinfo->mouse_face_end_row = vpos;
7321 dpyinfo->mouse_face_end_x = x + glyph->pixel_width;
7322 dpyinfo->mouse_face_end_y = row->y;
7323 dpyinfo->mouse_face_window = window;
7324 dpyinfo->mouse_face_face_id = TOOL_BAR_FACE_ID;
7325
7326 /* Display it as active. */
7327 show_mouse_face (dpyinfo, draw);
7328 dpyinfo->mouse_face_image_state = draw;
7329 }
7330
7331 set_help_echo:
7332
7333 /* Set help_echo to a help string.to display for this tool-bar item.
7334 XTread_socket does the rest. */
7335 help_echo_object = help_echo_window = Qnil;
7336 help_echo_pos = -1;
7337 help_echo = (XVECTOR (f->current_tool_bar_items)
7338 ->contents[prop_idx + TOOL_BAR_ITEM_HELP]);
7339 if (NILP (help_echo))
7340 help_echo = (XVECTOR (f->current_tool_bar_items)
7341 ->contents[prop_idx + TOOL_BAR_ITEM_CAPTION]);
7342}
7343
7344
7345\f
7346/* Find the glyph matrix position of buffer position POS in window W.
7347 *HPOS, *VPOS, *X, and *Y are set to the positions found. W's
7348 current glyphs must be up to date. If POS is above window start
7349 return (0, 0, 0, 0). If POS is after end of W, return end of
7350 last line in W. */
7351
7352static int
7353fast_find_position (w, pos, hpos, vpos, x, y)
7354 struct window *w;
7355 int pos;
7356 int *hpos, *vpos, *x, *y;
7357{
7358 int i;
7359 int lastcol;
7360 int maybe_next_line_p = 0;
7361 int line_start_position;
7362 int yb = window_text_bottom_y (w);
7363 struct glyph_row *row = MATRIX_ROW (w->current_matrix, 0);
7364 struct glyph_row *best_row = row;
7365 int row_vpos = 0, best_row_vpos = 0;
7366 int current_x;
7367
7368 while (row->y < yb)
7369 {
7370 if (row->used[TEXT_AREA])
7371 line_start_position = row->glyphs[TEXT_AREA]->charpos;
7372 else
7373 line_start_position = 0;
7374
7375 if (line_start_position > pos)
7376 break;
7377 /* If the position sought is the end of the buffer,
7378 don't include the blank lines at the bottom of the window. */
7379 else if (line_start_position == pos
7380 && pos == BUF_ZV (XBUFFER (w->buffer)))
7381 {
7382 maybe_next_line_p = 1;
7383 break;
7384 }
7385 else if (line_start_position > 0)
7386 {
7387 best_row = row;
7388 best_row_vpos = row_vpos;
7389 }
7390
7391 if (row->y + row->height >= yb)
7392 break;
7393
7394 ++row;
7395 ++row_vpos;
7396 }
7397
7398 /* Find the right column within BEST_ROW. */
7399 lastcol = 0;
7400 current_x = best_row->x;
7401 for (i = 0; i < best_row->used[TEXT_AREA]; i++)
7402 {
7403 struct glyph *glyph = best_row->glyphs[TEXT_AREA] + i;
7404 int charpos;
7405
7406 charpos = glyph->charpos;
7407 if (charpos == pos)
7408 {
7409 *hpos = i;
7410 *vpos = best_row_vpos;
7411 *x = current_x;
7412 *y = best_row->y;
7413 return 1;
7414 }
7415 else if (charpos > pos)
7416 break;
7417 else if (charpos > 0)
7418 lastcol = i;
7419
7420 current_x += glyph->pixel_width;
7421 }
7422
7423 /* If we're looking for the end of the buffer,
7424 and we didn't find it in the line we scanned,
7425 use the start of the following line. */
7426 if (maybe_next_line_p)
7427 {
7428 ++best_row;
7429 ++best_row_vpos;
7430 lastcol = 0;
7431 current_x = best_row->x;
7432 }
7433
7434 *vpos = best_row_vpos;
7435 *hpos = lastcol + 1;
7436 *x = current_x;
7437 *y = best_row->y;
7438 return 0;
7439}
7440
7441
7442/* Display the active region described by mouse_face_*
7443 in its mouse-face if HL > 0, in its normal face if HL = 0. */
7444
7445static void
7446show_mouse_face (dpyinfo, draw)
7447 struct mac_display_info *dpyinfo;
7448 enum draw_glyphs_face draw;
7449{
7450 struct window *w = XWINDOW (dpyinfo->mouse_face_window);
7451 struct frame *f = XFRAME (WINDOW_FRAME (w));
7452 int i;
7453 int cursor_off_p = 0;
7454 struct cursor_pos saved_cursor;
7455
7456 saved_cursor = output_cursor;
7457
7458 /* If window is in the process of being destroyed, don't bother
7459 to do anything. */
7460 if (w->current_matrix == NULL)
7461 goto set_x_cursor;
7462
7463 /* Recognize when we are called to operate on rows that don't exist
7464 anymore. This can happen when a window is split. */
7465 if (dpyinfo->mouse_face_end_row >= w->current_matrix->nrows)
7466 goto set_x_cursor;
7467
7468 set_output_cursor (&w->phys_cursor);
7469
7470 /* Note that mouse_face_beg_row etc. are window relative. */
7471 for (i = dpyinfo->mouse_face_beg_row;
7472 i <= dpyinfo->mouse_face_end_row;
7473 i++)
7474 {
7475 int start_hpos, end_hpos, start_x;
7476 struct glyph_row *row = MATRIX_ROW (w->current_matrix, i);
7477
7478 /* Don't do anything if row doesn't have valid contents. */
7479 if (!row->enabled_p)
7480 continue;
7481
7482 /* For all but the first row, the highlight starts at column 0. */
7483 if (i == dpyinfo->mouse_face_beg_row)
7484 {
7485 start_hpos = dpyinfo->mouse_face_beg_col;
7486 start_x = dpyinfo->mouse_face_beg_x;
7487 }
7488 else
7489 {
7490 start_hpos = 0;
7491 start_x = 0;
7492 }
7493
7494 if (i == dpyinfo->mouse_face_end_row)
7495 end_hpos = dpyinfo->mouse_face_end_col;
7496 else
7497 end_hpos = row->used[TEXT_AREA];
7498
7499 /* If the cursor's in the text we are about to rewrite, turn the
7500 cursor off. */
7501 if (!w->pseudo_window_p
7502 && i == output_cursor.vpos
7503 && output_cursor.hpos >= start_hpos - 1
7504 && output_cursor.hpos <= end_hpos)
7505 {
7506 x_update_window_cursor (w, 0);
7507 cursor_off_p = 1;
7508 }
7509
7510 if (end_hpos > start_hpos)
7511 {
7512 row->mouse_face_p = draw == DRAW_MOUSE_FACE;
7513 x_draw_glyphs (w, start_x, row, TEXT_AREA,
7514 start_hpos, end_hpos, draw, NULL, NULL, 0);
7515 }
7516 }
7517
7518 /* If we turned the cursor off, turn it back on. */
7519 if (cursor_off_p)
7520 x_display_cursor (w, 1,
7521 output_cursor.hpos, output_cursor.vpos,
7522 output_cursor.x, output_cursor.y);
7523
7524 output_cursor = saved_cursor;
7525
7526 set_x_cursor:
7527#if 0 /* MAC_TODO: mouse cursor */
7528 /* Change the mouse cursor. */
7529 if (draw == DRAW_NORMAL_TEXT)
7530 XDefineCursor (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_X_WINDOW (f),
7531 f->output_data.x->text_cursor);
7532 else if (draw == DRAW_MOUSE_FACE)
7533 XDefineCursor (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_X_WINDOW (f),
7534 f->output_data.x->cross_cursor);
7535 else
7536 XDefineCursor (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_X_WINDOW (f),
7537 f->output_data.x->nontext_cursor);
7538#endif
7539 ;
7540}
7541
7542/* Clear out the mouse-highlighted active region.
7543 Redraw it un-highlighted first. */
7544
7545void
7546clear_mouse_face (dpyinfo)
7547 struct mac_display_info *dpyinfo;
7548{
7549 if (tip_frame)
7550 return;
7551
7552 if (! NILP (dpyinfo->mouse_face_window))
7553 show_mouse_face (dpyinfo, DRAW_NORMAL_TEXT);
7554
7555 dpyinfo->mouse_face_beg_row = dpyinfo->mouse_face_beg_col = -1;
7556 dpyinfo->mouse_face_end_row = dpyinfo->mouse_face_end_col = -1;
7557 dpyinfo->mouse_face_window = Qnil;
7558}
7559
7560
7561/* Clear any mouse-face on window W. This function is part of the
7562 redisplay interface, and is called from try_window_id and similar
7563 functions to ensure the mouse-highlight is off. */
7564
7565void
7566x_clear_mouse_face (w)
7567 struct window *w;
7568{
7569 struct mac_display_info *dpyinfo = FRAME_MAC_DISPLAY_INFO (XFRAME (w->frame));
7570 Lisp_Object window;
7571
7572 XSETWINDOW (window, w);
7573 if (EQ (window, dpyinfo->mouse_face_window))
7574 clear_mouse_face (dpyinfo);
7575}
7576
7577
7578/* Just discard the mouse face information for frame F, if any.
7579 This is used when the size of F is changed. */
7580
7581static void
7582cancel_mouse_face (f)
7583 FRAME_PTR f;
7584{
7585 Lisp_Object window;
7586 struct mac_display_info *dpyinfo = FRAME_MAC_DISPLAY_INFO (f);
7587
7588 window = dpyinfo->mouse_face_window;
7589 if (! NILP (window) && XFRAME (XWINDOW (window)->frame) == f)
7590 {
7591 dpyinfo->mouse_face_beg_row = dpyinfo->mouse_face_beg_col = -1;
7592 dpyinfo->mouse_face_end_row = dpyinfo->mouse_face_end_col = -1;
7593 dpyinfo->mouse_face_window = Qnil;
7594 }
7595}
7596\f
7597static struct scroll_bar *x_window_to_scroll_bar ();
7598static void x_scroll_bar_report_motion ();
7599
7600/* Return the current position of the mouse.
7601 *fp should be a frame which indicates which display to ask about.
7602
7603 If the mouse movement started in a scroll bar, set *fp, *bar_window,
7604 and *part to the frame, window, and scroll bar part that the mouse
7605 is over. Set *x and *y to the portion and whole of the mouse's
7606 position on the scroll bar.
7607
7608 If the mouse movement started elsewhere, set *fp to the frame the
7609 mouse is on, *bar_window to nil, and *x and *y to the character cell
7610 the mouse is over.
7611
7612 Set *time to the server time-stamp for the time at which the mouse
7613 was at this position.
7614
7615 Don't store anything if we don't have a valid set of values to report.
7616
7617 This clears the mouse_moved flag, so we can wait for the next mouse
7618 movement. */
7619
7620void
7621XTmouse_position (fp, insist, bar_window, part, x, y, time)
7622 FRAME_PTR *fp;
7623 int insist;
7624 Lisp_Object *bar_window;
7625 enum scroll_bar_part *part;
7626 Lisp_Object *x, *y;
7627 unsigned long *time;
7628{
7629 Point mouse_pos;
7630 int ignore1, ignore2;
7631 WindowPtr wp = FrontWindow ();
7632 struct frame *f = ((mac_output *) GetWRefCon (wp))->mFP;
7633 Lisp_Object frame, tail;
7634
7635 BLOCK_INPUT;
7636
7637 if (! NILP (last_mouse_scroll_bar) && insist == 0)
7638 x_scroll_bar_report_motion (fp, bar_window, part, x, y, time);
7639 else
7640 {
7641 /* Clear the mouse-moved flag for every frame on this display. */
7642 FOR_EACH_FRAME (tail, frame)
7643 XFRAME (frame)->mouse_moved = 0;
7644
7645 last_mouse_scroll_bar = Qnil;
7646
7647 SetPort (wp);
7648 GetMouse (&mouse_pos);
7649
7650 pixel_to_glyph_coords (f, mouse_pos.h, mouse_pos.v, &ignore1, &ignore2,
7651 &last_mouse_glyph, insist);
7652
7653 *bar_window = Qnil;
7654 *part = scroll_bar_handle;
7655 *fp = f;
7656 XSETINT (*x, mouse_pos.h);
7657 XSETINT (*y, mouse_pos.v);
7658 *time = last_mouse_movement_time;
7659 }
7660
7661 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
7662}
7663
7664\f
7665/************************************************************************
7666 Scroll bars, general
7667 ************************************************************************/
7668
7669/* Create a scroll bar and return the scroll bar vector for it. W is
7670 the Emacs window on which to create the scroll bar. TOP, LEFT,
7671 WIDTH and HEIGHT are.the pixel coordinates and dimensions of the
7672 scroll bar. */
7673
7674static struct scroll_bar *
7675x_scroll_bar_create (w, top, left, width, height, disp_top, disp_height)
7676 struct window *w;
7677 int top, left, width, height, disp_top, disp_height;
7678{
7679 struct frame *f = XFRAME (w->frame);
7680 struct scroll_bar *bar
7681 = XSCROLL_BAR (Fmake_vector (make_number (SCROLL_BAR_VEC_SIZE), Qnil));
7682 Rect r;
7683 ControlHandle ch;
7684
7685 BLOCK_INPUT;
7686
7687 r.left = left;
7688 r.top = disp_top;
7689 r.right = left + width;
7690 r.bottom = disp_top + disp_height;
7691
7692 ch = NewControl (FRAME_MAC_WINDOW (f), &r, "\p", 1, 0, 0, 0, scrollBarProc,
7693 0L);
7694 SET_SCROLL_BAR_CONTROL_HANDLE (bar, ch);
7695 SetControlReference (ch, (long) bar);
7696
7697 XSETWINDOW (bar->window, w);
7698 XSETINT (bar->top, top);
7699 XSETINT (bar->left, left);
7700 XSETINT (bar->width, width);
7701 XSETINT (bar->height, height);
7702 XSETINT (bar->start, 0);
7703 XSETINT (bar->end, 0);
7704 bar->dragging = Qnil;
7705
7706 /* Add bar to its frame's list of scroll bars. */
7707 bar->next = FRAME_SCROLL_BARS (f);
7708 bar->prev = Qnil;
7709 XSETVECTOR (FRAME_SCROLL_BARS (f), bar);
7710 if (!NILP (bar->next))
7711 XSETVECTOR (XSCROLL_BAR (bar->next)->prev, bar);
7712
7713 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
7714 return bar;
7715}
7716
7717
7718/* Draw BAR's handle in the proper position.
7719
7720 If the handle is already drawn from START to END, don't bother
7721 redrawing it, unless REBUILD is non-zero; in that case, always
7722 redraw it. (REBUILD is handy for drawing the handle after expose
7723 events.)
7724
7725 Normally, we want to constrain the start and end of the handle to
7726 fit inside its rectangle, but if the user is dragging the scroll
7727 bar handle, we want to let them drag it down all the way, so that
7728 the bar's top is as far down as it goes; otherwise, there's no way
7729 to move to the very end of the buffer. */
7730
7731static void
7732x_scroll_bar_set_handle (bar, start, end, rebuild)
7733 struct scroll_bar *bar;
7734 int start, end;
7735 int rebuild;
7736{
7737 int dragging = ! NILP (bar->dragging);
7738 ControlHandle ch = SCROLL_BAR_CONTROL_HANDLE (bar);
7739 FRAME_PTR f = XFRAME (WINDOW_FRAME (XWINDOW (bar->window)));
7740
7741 /* If the display is already accurate, do nothing. */
7742 if (! rebuild
7743 && start == XINT (bar->start)
7744 && end == XINT (bar->end))
7745 return;
7746
7747 BLOCK_INPUT;
7748
7749 {
7750 int inside_width = VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_INSIDE_WIDTH (f, XINT (bar->width));
7751 int inside_height = VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_INSIDE_HEIGHT (f, XINT (bar->height));
7752 int top_range = VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_TOP_RANGE (f, XINT (bar->height));
7753
7754 /* Make sure the values are reasonable, and try to preserve
7755 the distance between start and end. */
7756 {
7757 int length = end - start;
7758
7759 if (start < 0)
7760 start = 0;
7761 else if (start > top_range)
7762 start = top_range;
7763 end = start + length;
7764
7765 if (end < start)
7766 end = start;
7767 else if (end > top_range && ! dragging)
7768 end = top_range;
7769 }
7770
7771 /* Store the adjusted setting in the scroll bar. */
7772 XSETINT (bar->start, start);
7773 XSETINT (bar->end, end);
7774
7775 /* Clip the end position, just for display. */
7776 if (end > top_range)
7777 end = top_range;
7778
7779 /* Draw bottom positions VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_MIN_HANDLE pixels
7780 below top positions, to make sure the handle is always at least
7781 that many pixels tall. */
7782 end += VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_MIN_HANDLE;
7783
7784 SetControlMinimum (ch, 0);
7785 /* Don't inadvertently activate deactivated scroll bars */
7786 if (GetControlMaximum (ch) != -1)
7787 SetControlMaximum (ch,
7788 VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_TOP_RANGE (f,
7789 XINT (bar->height))
7790 - 1);
7791 SetControlValue (ch, start);
7792#if 0 /* MAC_TODO: detect Appearance Manager 1.1 before use. */
7793 SetControlViewSize (ch, end);
7794#endif
7795 }
7796
7797 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
7798}
7799
7800
7801/* Destroy scroll bar BAR, and set its Emacs window's scroll bar to
7802 nil. */
7803
7804static void
7805x_scroll_bar_remove (bar)
7806 struct scroll_bar *bar;
7807{
7808 FRAME_PTR f = XFRAME (WINDOW_FRAME (XWINDOW (bar->window)));
7809
7810 BLOCK_INPUT;
7811
7812 /* Destroy the Mac scroll bar control */
7813 DisposeControl (SCROLL_BAR_CONTROL_HANDLE (bar));
7814
7815 /* Disassociate this scroll bar from its window. */
7816 XWINDOW (bar->window)->vertical_scroll_bar = Qnil;
7817
7818 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
7819}
7820
7821
7822/* Set the handle of the vertical scroll bar for WINDOW to indicate
7823 that we are displaying PORTION characters out of a total of WHOLE
7824 characters, starting at POSITION. If WINDOW has no scroll bar,
7825 create one. */
7826
7827static void
7828XTset_vertical_scroll_bar (w, portion, whole, position)
7829 struct window *w;
7830 int portion, whole, position;
7831{
7832 struct frame *f = XFRAME (w->frame);
7833 struct scroll_bar *bar;
7834 int top, height, left, sb_left, width, sb_width, disp_top, disp_height;
7835 int window_x, window_y, window_width, window_height;
7836
7837 /* Get window dimensions. */
7838 window_box (w, -1, &window_x, &window_y, &window_width, &window_height);
7839 top = window_y;
7840 width = FRAME_SCROLL_BAR_COLS (f) * CANON_X_UNIT (f);
7841 height = window_height;
7842
7843 /* Compute the left edge of the scroll bar area. */
7844 if (FRAME_HAS_VERTICAL_SCROLL_BARS_ON_RIGHT (f))
7845 left = XINT (w->left) + XINT (w->width) - FRAME_SCROLL_BAR_COLS (f);
7846 else
7847 left = XFASTINT (w->left);
7848 left *= CANON_X_UNIT (f);
7849 left += FRAME_INTERNAL_BORDER_WIDTH (f);
7850
7851 /* Compute the width of the scroll bar which might be less than
7852 the width of the area reserved for the scroll bar. */
7853 if (FRAME_SCROLL_BAR_PIXEL_WIDTH (f) > 0)
7854 sb_width = FRAME_SCROLL_BAR_PIXEL_WIDTH (f);
7855 else
7856 sb_width = width;
7857
7858 /* Compute the left edge of the scroll bar. */
7859 if (FRAME_HAS_VERTICAL_SCROLL_BARS_ON_RIGHT (f))
7860 sb_left = left + width - sb_width - (width - sb_width) / 2;
7861 else
7862 sb_left = left + (width - sb_width) / 2;
7863
7864 /* Adjustments according to Inside Macintosh to make it look nice */
7865 disp_top = top;
7866 disp_height = height;
7867 if (disp_top == 0)
7868 {
7869 disp_top = -1;
7870 disp_height++;
7871 }
7872 else if (disp_top == PIXEL_HEIGHT (f) - 16)
7873 {
7874 disp_top++;
7875 disp_height--;
7876 }
7877
7878 if (sb_left + sb_width == PIXEL_WIDTH (f))
7879 sb_left++;
7880
7881 /* Does the scroll bar exist yet? */
7882 if (NILP (w->vertical_scroll_bar))
7883 {
7884 BLOCK_INPUT;
7885 XClearArea (FRAME_MAC_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_MAC_WINDOW (f),
7886 left, top, width, height, 0);
7887 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
7888 bar = x_scroll_bar_create (w, top, sb_left, sb_width, height, disp_top,
7889 disp_height);
7890 XSETVECTOR (w->vertical_scroll_bar, bar);
7891 }
7892 else
7893 {
7894 /* It may just need to be moved and resized. */
7895 ControlHandle ch;
7896
7897 bar = XSCROLL_BAR (w->vertical_scroll_bar);
7898 ch = SCROLL_BAR_CONTROL_HANDLE (bar);
7899
7900 BLOCK_INPUT;
7901
7902 /* If already correctly positioned, do nothing. */
7903 if (XINT (bar->left) == sb_left
7904 && XINT (bar->top) == top
7905 && XINT (bar->width) == sb_width
7906 && XINT (bar->height) == height)
7907 Draw1Control (ch);
7908 else
7909 {
7910 if (sb_left + sb_width >= PIXEL_WIDTH (f))
7911 XClearArea (FRAME_MAC_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_MAC_WINDOW (f),
7912 sb_left - 1, top, 1, height, 0);
7913
7914 HideControl (ch);
7915 MoveControl (ch, sb_left + VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_WIDTH_TRIM, disp_top);
7916 SizeControl (ch, sb_width - VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_WIDTH_TRIM * 2,
7917 disp_height);
7918 ShowControl (ch);
7919
7920 /* Remember new settings. */
7921 XSETINT (bar->left, sb_left);
7922 XSETINT (bar->top, top);
7923 XSETINT (bar->width, sb_width);
7924 XSETINT (bar->height, height);
7925 }
7926
7927 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
7928 }
7929
7930 /* Set the scroll bar's current state, unless we're currently being
7931 dragged. */
7932 if (NILP (bar->dragging))
7933 {
7934 int top_range = VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_TOP_RANGE (f, height);
7935
7936 if (whole == 0)
7937 x_scroll_bar_set_handle (bar, 0, top_range, 0);
7938 else
7939 {
7940 int start = ((double) position * top_range) / whole;
7941 int end = ((double) (position + portion) * top_range) / whole;
7942 x_scroll_bar_set_handle (bar, start, end, 0);
7943 }
7944 }
7945}
7946
7947
7948/* The following three hooks are used when we're doing a thorough
7949 redisplay of the frame. We don't explicitly know which scroll bars
7950 are going to be deleted, because keeping track of when windows go
7951 away is a real pain - "Can you say set-window-configuration, boys
7952 and girls?" Instead, we just assert at the beginning of redisplay
7953 that *all* scroll bars are to be removed, and then save a scroll bar
7954 from the fiery pit when we actually redisplay its window. */
7955
7956/* Arrange for all scroll bars on FRAME to be removed at the next call
7957 to `*judge_scroll_bars_hook'. A scroll bar may be spared if
7958 `*redeem_scroll_bar_hook' is applied to its window before the judgment. */
7959
7960static void
7961XTcondemn_scroll_bars (frame)
7962 FRAME_PTR frame;
7963{
7964 /* Transfer all the scroll bars to FRAME_CONDEMNED_SCROLL_BARS. */
7965 while (! NILP (FRAME_SCROLL_BARS (frame)))
7966 {
7967 Lisp_Object bar;
7968 bar = FRAME_SCROLL_BARS (frame);
7969 FRAME_SCROLL_BARS (frame) = XSCROLL_BAR (bar)->next;
7970 XSCROLL_BAR (bar)->next = FRAME_CONDEMNED_SCROLL_BARS (frame);
7971 XSCROLL_BAR (bar)->prev = Qnil;
7972 if (! NILP (FRAME_CONDEMNED_SCROLL_BARS (frame)))
7973 XSCROLL_BAR (FRAME_CONDEMNED_SCROLL_BARS (frame))->prev = bar;
7974 FRAME_CONDEMNED_SCROLL_BARS (frame) = bar;
7975 }
7976}
7977
7978/* Un-mark WINDOW's scroll bar for deletion in this judgment cycle.
7979 Note that WINDOW isn't necessarily condemned at all. */
7980static void
7981XTredeem_scroll_bar (window)
7982 struct window *window;
7983{
7984 struct scroll_bar *bar;
7985
7986 /* We can't redeem this window's scroll bar if it doesn't have one. */
7987 if (NILP (window->vertical_scroll_bar))
7988 abort ();
7989
7990 bar = XSCROLL_BAR (window->vertical_scroll_bar);
7991
7992 /* Unlink it from the condemned list. */
7993 {
7994 FRAME_PTR f = XFRAME (WINDOW_FRAME (window));
7995
7996 if (NILP (bar->prev))
7997 {
7998 /* If the prev pointer is nil, it must be the first in one of
7999 the lists. */
8000 if (EQ (FRAME_SCROLL_BARS (f), window->vertical_scroll_bar))
8001 /* It's not condemned. Everything's fine. */
8002 return;
8003 else if (EQ (FRAME_CONDEMNED_SCROLL_BARS (f),
8004 window->vertical_scroll_bar))
8005 FRAME_CONDEMNED_SCROLL_BARS (f) = bar->next;
8006 else
8007 /* If its prev pointer is nil, it must be at the front of
8008 one or the other! */
8009 abort ();
8010 }
8011 else
8012 XSCROLL_BAR (bar->prev)->next = bar->next;
8013
8014 if (! NILP (bar->next))
8015 XSCROLL_BAR (bar->next)->prev = bar->prev;
8016
8017 bar->next = FRAME_SCROLL_BARS (f);
8018 bar->prev = Qnil;
8019 XSETVECTOR (FRAME_SCROLL_BARS (f), bar);
8020 if (! NILP (bar->next))
8021 XSETVECTOR (XSCROLL_BAR (bar->next)->prev, bar);
8022 }
8023}
8024
8025/* Remove all scroll bars on FRAME that haven't been saved since the
8026 last call to `*condemn_scroll_bars_hook'. */
8027
8028static void
8029XTjudge_scroll_bars (f)
8030 FRAME_PTR f;
8031{
8032 Lisp_Object bar, next;
8033
8034 bar = FRAME_CONDEMNED_SCROLL_BARS (f);
8035
8036 /* Clear out the condemned list now so we won't try to process any
8037 more events on the hapless scroll bars. */
8038 FRAME_CONDEMNED_SCROLL_BARS (f) = Qnil;
8039
8040 for (; ! NILP (bar); bar = next)
8041 {
8042 struct scroll_bar *b = XSCROLL_BAR (bar);
8043
8044 x_scroll_bar_remove (b);
8045
8046 next = b->next;
8047 b->next = b->prev = Qnil;
8048 }
8049
8050 /* Now there should be no references to the condemned scroll bars,
8051 and they should get garbage-collected. */
8052}
8053
8054
8055static void
8056activate_scroll_bars (frame)
8057 FRAME_PTR frame;
8058{
8059 Lisp_Object bar;
8060 ControlHandle ch;
8061
8062 bar = FRAME_SCROLL_BARS (frame);
8063 while (! NILP (bar))
8064 {
8065 ch = SCROLL_BAR_CONTROL_HANDLE (XSCROLL_BAR (bar));
8066 SetControlMaximum (ch,
8067 VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_TOP_RANGE (frame,
8068 XINT (XSCROLL_BAR (bar)
8069 ->height)) - 1);
8070
8071 bar = XSCROLL_BAR (bar)->next;
8072 }
8073}
8074
8075
8076static void
8077deactivate_scroll_bars (frame)
8078 FRAME_PTR frame;
8079{
8080 Lisp_Object bar;
8081 ControlHandle ch;
8082
8083 bar = FRAME_SCROLL_BARS (frame);
8084 while (! NILP (bar))
8085 {
8086 ch = SCROLL_BAR_CONTROL_HANDLE (XSCROLL_BAR (bar));
8087 SetControlMaximum (ch, XINT (-1));
8088
8089 bar = XSCROLL_BAR (bar)->next;
8090 }
8091}
8092
8093/* Handle a mouse click on the scroll bar BAR. If *EMACS_EVENT's kind
8094 is set to something other than no_event, it is enqueued.
8095
8096 This may be called from a signal handler, so we have to ignore GC
8097 mark bits. */
8098
8099static void
8100x_scroll_bar_handle_click (bar, part_code, er, bufp)
8101 struct scroll_bar *bar;
8102 int part_code;
8103 EventRecord *er;
8104 struct input_event *bufp;
8105{
8106 if (! GC_WINDOWP (bar->window))
8107 abort ();
8108
8109 bufp->kind = scroll_bar_click;
8110 bufp->frame_or_window = bar->window;
8111 bufp->arg = Qnil;
8112
8113 bar->dragging = Qnil;
8114
8115 switch (part_code)
8116 {
8117 case kControlUpButtonPart:
8118 bufp->part = scroll_bar_up_arrow;
8119 break;
8120 case kControlDownButtonPart:
8121 bufp->part = scroll_bar_down_arrow;
8122 break;
8123 case kControlPageUpPart:
8124 bufp->part = scroll_bar_above_handle;
8125 break;
8126 case kControlPageDownPart:
8127 bufp->part = scroll_bar_below_handle;
8128 break;
8129 case kControlIndicatorPart:
8130 if (er->what == mouseDown)
8131 bar->dragging = make_number (0);
8132 XSETVECTOR (last_mouse_scroll_bar, bar);
8133 bufp->part = scroll_bar_handle;
8134 break;
8135 }
8136}
8137
8138
8139/* Handle some mouse motion while someone is dragging the scroll bar.
8140
8141 This may be called from a signal handler, so we have to ignore GC
8142 mark bits. */
8143
8144static void
8145x_scroll_bar_note_movement (bar, y_pos, t)
8146 struct scroll_bar *bar;
8147 int y_pos;
8148 Time t;
8149{
8150 FRAME_PTR f = XFRAME (XWINDOW (bar->window)->frame);
8151
8152 last_mouse_movement_time = t;
8153
8154 f->mouse_moved = 1;
8155 XSETVECTOR (last_mouse_scroll_bar, bar);
8156
8157 /* If we're dragging the bar, display it. */
8158 if (! GC_NILP (bar->dragging))
8159 {
8160 /* Where should the handle be now? */
8161 int new_start = y_pos - 24;
8162
8163 if (new_start != XINT (bar->start))
8164 {
8165 int new_end = new_start + (XINT (bar->end) - XINT (bar->start));
8166
8167 x_scroll_bar_set_handle (bar, new_start, new_end, 0);
8168 }
8169 }
8170}
8171
8172
8173/* Return information to the user about the current position of the
8174 mouse on the scroll bar. */
8175
8176static void
8177x_scroll_bar_report_motion (fp, bar_window, part, x, y, time)
8178 FRAME_PTR *fp;
8179 Lisp_Object *bar_window;
8180 enum scroll_bar_part *part;
8181 Lisp_Object *x, *y;
8182 unsigned long *time;
8183{
8184 struct scroll_bar *bar = XSCROLL_BAR (last_mouse_scroll_bar);
8185 WindowPtr wp = FrontWindow ();
8186 Point mouse_pos;
8187 struct frame *f = ((mac_output *) GetWRefCon (wp))->mFP;
8188 int win_y, top_range;
8189
8190 SetPort (wp);
8191 GetMouse (&mouse_pos);
8192
8193 win_y = mouse_pos.v - XINT (bar->top);
8194 top_range = VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_TOP_RANGE (f, XINT (bar->height));
8195
8196 win_y -= VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_TOP_BORDER;
8197
8198 win_y -= 24;
8199
8200 if (! NILP (bar->dragging))
8201 win_y -= XINT (bar->dragging);
8202
8203 if (win_y < 0)
8204 win_y = 0;
8205 if (win_y > top_range)
8206 win_y = top_range;
8207
8208 *fp = f;
8209 *bar_window = bar->window;
8210
8211 if (! NILP (bar->dragging))
8212 *part = scroll_bar_handle;
8213 else if (win_y < XINT (bar->start))
8214 *part = scroll_bar_above_handle;
8215 else if (win_y < XINT (bar->end) + VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_MIN_HANDLE)
8216 *part = scroll_bar_handle;
8217 else
8218 *part = scroll_bar_below_handle;
8219
8220 XSETINT (*x, win_y);
8221 XSETINT (*y, top_range);
8222
8223 f->mouse_moved = 0;
8224 last_mouse_scroll_bar = Qnil;
8225
8226 *time = last_mouse_movement_time;
8227}
8228\f
8229/***********************************************************************
8230 Text Cursor
8231 ***********************************************************************/
8232
8233/* Note if the text cursor of window W has been overwritten by a
8234 drawing operation that outputs N glyphs starting at HPOS in the
8235 line given by output_cursor.vpos. N < 0 means all the rest of the
8236 line after HPOS has been written. */
8237
8238static void
8239note_overwritten_text_cursor (w, hpos, n)
8240 struct window *w;
8241 int hpos, n;
8242{
8243 if (updated_area == TEXT_AREA
8244 && output_cursor.vpos == w->phys_cursor.vpos
8245 && hpos <= w->phys_cursor.hpos
8246 && (n < 0
8247 || hpos + n > w->phys_cursor.hpos))
8248 w->phys_cursor_on_p = 0;
8249}
8250
8251
8252/* Set clipping for output in glyph row ROW. W is the window in which
8253 we operate. GC is the graphics context to set clipping in.
8254 WHOLE_LINE_P non-zero means include the areas used for truncation
8255 mark display and alike in the clipping rectangle.
8256
8257 ROW may be a text row or, e.g., a mode line. Text rows must be
8258 clipped to the interior of the window dedicated to text display,
8259 mode lines must be clipped to the whole window. */
8260
8261static void
8262x_clip_to_row (w, row, gc, whole_line_p)
8263 struct window *w;
8264 struct glyph_row *row;
8265 GC gc;
8266 int whole_line_p;
8267{
8268 struct frame *f = XFRAME (WINDOW_FRAME (w));
8269 Rect clip_rect;
8270 int window_x, window_y, window_width, window_height;
8271
8272 window_box (w, -1, &window_x, &window_y, &window_width, &window_height);
8273
8274 clip_rect.left = WINDOW_TO_FRAME_PIXEL_X (w, 0);
8275 clip_rect.top = WINDOW_TO_FRAME_PIXEL_Y (w, row->y);
8276 clip_rect.top = max (clip_rect.top, window_y);
8277 clip_rect.right = clip_rect.left + window_width;
8278 clip_rect.bottom = clip_rect.top + row->visible_height;
8279
8280 /* If clipping to the whole line, including trunc marks, extend
8281 the rectangle to the left and increase its width. */
8282 if (whole_line_p)
8283 {
8284 clip_rect.left -= FRAME_X_LEFT_FLAGS_AREA_WIDTH (f);
8285 clip_rect.right += FRAME_X_FLAGS_AREA_WIDTH (f);
8286 }
8287
8288 mac_set_clip_rectangle (FRAME_MAC_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_MAC_WINDOW (f), &clip_rect);
8289}
8290
8291
8292/* Draw a hollow box cursor on window W in glyph row ROW. */
8293
8294static void
8295x_draw_hollow_cursor (w, row)
8296 struct window *w;
8297 struct glyph_row *row;
8298{
8299 struct frame *f = XFRAME (WINDOW_FRAME (w));
8300 struct mac_display_info *dpyinfo = FRAME_MAC_DISPLAY_INFO (f);
8301 Display *dpy = FRAME_MAC_DISPLAY (f);
8302 int x, y, wd, h;
8303 XGCValues xgcv;
8304 struct glyph *cursor_glyph;
8305 GC gc;
8306
8307 /* Compute frame-relative coordinates from window-relative
8308 coordinates. */
8309 x = WINDOW_TEXT_TO_FRAME_PIXEL_X (w, w->phys_cursor.x);
8310 y = (WINDOW_TO_FRAME_PIXEL_Y (w, w->phys_cursor.y)
8311 + row->ascent - w->phys_cursor_ascent);
8312 h = row->height - 1;
8313
8314 /* Get the glyph the cursor is on. If we can't tell because
8315 the current matrix is invalid or such, give up. */
8316 cursor_glyph = get_phys_cursor_glyph (w);
8317 if (cursor_glyph == NULL)
8318 return;
8319
8320 /* Compute the width of the rectangle to draw. If on a stretch
8321 glyph, and `x-stretch-block-cursor' is nil, don't draw a
8322 rectangle as wide as the glyph, but use a canonical character
8323 width instead. */
8324 wd = cursor_glyph->pixel_width - 1;
8325 if (cursor_glyph->type == STRETCH_GLYPH
8326 && !x_stretch_cursor_p)
8327 wd = min (CANON_X_UNIT (f), wd);
8328
8329 /* The foreground of cursor_gc is typically the same as the normal
8330 background color, which can cause the cursor box to be invisible. */
8331 xgcv.foreground = f->output_data.mac->cursor_pixel;
8332 if (dpyinfo->scratch_cursor_gc)
8333 XChangeGC (dpy, dpyinfo->scratch_cursor_gc, GCForeground, &xgcv);
8334 else
8335 dpyinfo->scratch_cursor_gc = XCreateGC (dpy, FRAME_MAC_WINDOW (f),
8336 GCForeground, &xgcv);
8337 gc = dpyinfo->scratch_cursor_gc;
8338
8339 /* Set clipping, draw the rectangle, and reset clipping again. */
8340 x_clip_to_row (w, row, gc, 0);
8341 mac_draw_rectangle (dpy, FRAME_MAC_WINDOW (f), gc, x, y, wd, h);
8342 mac_reset_clipping (dpy, FRAME_MAC_WINDOW (f));
8343}
8344
8345
8346/* Draw a bar cursor on window W in glyph row ROW.
8347
8348 Implementation note: One would like to draw a bar cursor with an
8349 angle equal to the one given by the font property XA_ITALIC_ANGLE.
8350 Unfortunately, I didn't find a font yet that has this property set.
8351 --gerd. */
8352
8353static void
8354x_draw_bar_cursor (w, row, width)
8355 struct window *w;
8356 struct glyph_row *row;
8357 int width;
8358{
8359 /* If cursor hpos is out of bounds, don't draw garbage. This can
8360 happen in mini-buffer windows when switching between echo area
8361 glyphs and mini-buffer. */
8362 if (w->phys_cursor.hpos < row->used[TEXT_AREA])
8363 {
8364 struct frame *f = XFRAME (w->frame);
8365 struct glyph *cursor_glyph;
8366 GC gc;
8367 int x;
8368 unsigned long mask;
8369 XGCValues xgcv;
8370 Display *dpy;
8371 Window window;
8372
8373 cursor_glyph = get_phys_cursor_glyph (w);
8374 if (cursor_glyph == NULL)
8375 return;
8376
8377 xgcv.background = f->output_data.mac->cursor_pixel;
8378 xgcv.foreground = f->output_data.mac->cursor_pixel;
8379 mask = GCForeground | GCBackground;
8380 dpy = FRAME_MAC_DISPLAY (f);
8381 window = FRAME_MAC_WINDOW (f);
8382 gc = FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f)->scratch_cursor_gc;
8383
8384 if (gc)
8385 XChangeGC (dpy, gc, mask, &xgcv);
8386 else
8387 {
8388 gc = XCreateGC (dpy, window, mask, &xgcv);
8389 FRAME_MAC_DISPLAY_INFO (f)->scratch_cursor_gc = gc;
8390 }
8391
8392 if (width < 0)
8393 width = f->output_data.mac->cursor_width;
8394
8395 x = WINDOW_TEXT_TO_FRAME_PIXEL_X (w, w->phys_cursor.x);
8396 x_clip_to_row (w, row, gc, 0);
8397 XFillRectangle (dpy, window, gc,
8398 x,
8399 WINDOW_TO_FRAME_PIXEL_Y (w, w->phys_cursor.y),
8400 min (cursor_glyph->pixel_width, width),
8401 row->height);
8402 mac_reset_clipping (dpy, FRAME_MAC_WINDOW (f));
8403 }
8404}
8405
8406
8407/* Clear the cursor of window W to background color, and mark the
8408 cursor as not shown. This is used when the text where the cursor
8409 is is about to be rewritten. */
8410
8411static void
8412x_clear_cursor (w)
8413 struct window *w;
8414{
8415 if (FRAME_VISIBLE_P (XFRAME (w->frame)) && w->phys_cursor_on_p)
8416 x_update_window_cursor (w, 0);
8417}
8418
8419
8420/* Draw the cursor glyph of window W in glyph row ROW. See the
8421 comment of x_draw_glyphs for the meaning of HL. */
8422
8423static void
8424x_draw_phys_cursor_glyph (w, row, hl)
8425 struct window *w;
8426 struct glyph_row *row;
8427 enum draw_glyphs_face hl;
8428{
8429 /* If cursor hpos is out of bounds, don't draw garbage. This can
8430 happen in mini-buffer windows when switching between echo area
8431 glyphs and mini-buffer. */
8432 if (w->phys_cursor.hpos < row->used[TEXT_AREA])
8433 {
8434 x_draw_glyphs (w, w->phys_cursor.x, row, TEXT_AREA,
8435 w->phys_cursor.hpos, w->phys_cursor.hpos + 1,
8436 hl, 0, 0, 0);
8437
8438 /* When we erase the cursor, and ROW is overlapped by other
8439 rows, make sure that these overlapping parts of other rows
8440 are redrawn. */
8441 if (hl == DRAW_NORMAL_TEXT && row->overlapped_p)
8442 {
8443 if (row > w->current_matrix->rows
8444 && MATRIX_ROW_OVERLAPS_SUCC_P (row - 1))
8445 x_fix_overlapping_area (w, row - 1, TEXT_AREA);
8446
8447 if (MATRIX_ROW_BOTTOM_Y (row) < window_text_bottom_y (w)
8448 && MATRIX_ROW_OVERLAPS_PRED_P (row + 1))
8449 x_fix_overlapping_area (w, row + 1, TEXT_AREA);
8450 }
8451 }
8452}
8453
8454
8455/* Erase the image of a cursor of window W from the screen. */
8456
8457static void
8458x_erase_phys_cursor (w)
8459 struct window *w;
8460{
8461 struct frame *f = XFRAME (w->frame);
8462 struct x_display_info *dpyinfo = FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f);
8463 int hpos = w->phys_cursor.hpos;
8464 int vpos = w->phys_cursor.vpos;
8465 int mouse_face_here_p = 0;
8466 struct glyph_matrix *active_glyphs = w->current_matrix;
8467 struct glyph_row *cursor_row;
8468 struct glyph *cursor_glyph;
8469 enum draw_glyphs_face hl;
8470
8471 /* No cursor displayed or row invalidated => nothing to do on the
8472 screen. */
8473 if (w->phys_cursor_type == NO_CURSOR)
8474 goto mark_cursor_off;
8475
8476 /* VPOS >= active_glyphs->nrows means that window has been resized.
8477 Don't bother to erase the cursor. */
8478 if (vpos >= active_glyphs->nrows)
8479 goto mark_cursor_off;
8480
8481 /* If row containing cursor is marked invalid, there is nothing we
8482 can do. */
8483 cursor_row = MATRIX_ROW (active_glyphs, vpos);
8484 if (!cursor_row->enabled_p)
8485 goto mark_cursor_off;
8486
8487 /* This can happen when the new row is shorter than the old one.
8488 In this case, either x_draw_glyphs or clear_end_of_line
8489 should have cleared the cursor. Note that we wouldn't be
8490 able to erase the cursor in this case because we don't have a
8491 cursor glyph at hand. */
8492 if (w->phys_cursor.hpos >= cursor_row->used[TEXT_AREA])
8493 goto mark_cursor_off;
8494
8495 /* If the cursor is in the mouse face area, redisplay that when
8496 we clear the cursor. */
8497 if (! NILP (dpyinfo->mouse_face_window)
8498 && w == XWINDOW (dpyinfo->mouse_face_window)
8499 && (vpos > dpyinfo->mouse_face_beg_row
8500 || (vpos == dpyinfo->mouse_face_beg_row
8501 && hpos >= dpyinfo->mouse_face_beg_col))
8502 && (vpos < dpyinfo->mouse_face_end_row
8503 || (vpos == dpyinfo->mouse_face_end_row
8504 && hpos < dpyinfo->mouse_face_end_col))
8505 /* Don't redraw the cursor's spot in mouse face if it is at the
8506 end of a line (on a newline). The cursor appears there, but
8507 mouse highlighting does not. */
8508 && cursor_row->used[TEXT_AREA] > hpos)
8509 mouse_face_here_p = 1;
8510
8511 /* Maybe clear the display under the cursor. */
8512 if (w->phys_cursor_type == HOLLOW_BOX_CURSOR)
8513 {
8514 int x;
8515 int header_line_height = WINDOW_DISPLAY_HEADER_LINE_HEIGHT (w);
8516
8517 cursor_glyph = get_phys_cursor_glyph (w);
8518 if (cursor_glyph == NULL)
8519 goto mark_cursor_off;
8520
8521 x = WINDOW_TEXT_TO_FRAME_PIXEL_X (w, w->phys_cursor.x),
8522
8523 XClearArea (FRAME_MAC_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_MAC_WINDOW (f),
8524 x,
8525 WINDOW_TO_FRAME_PIXEL_Y (w, max (header_line_height,
8526 cursor_row->y)),
8527 cursor_glyph->pixel_width,
8528 cursor_row->visible_height,
8529 0);
8530 }
8531
8532 /* Erase the cursor by redrawing the character underneath it. */
8533 if (mouse_face_here_p)
8534 hl = DRAW_MOUSE_FACE;
8535 else if (cursor_row->inverse_p)
8536 hl = DRAW_INVERSE_VIDEO;
8537 else
8538 hl = DRAW_NORMAL_TEXT;
8539 x_draw_phys_cursor_glyph (w, cursor_row, hl);
8540
8541 mark_cursor_off:
8542 w->phys_cursor_on_p = 0;
8543 w->phys_cursor_type = NO_CURSOR;
8544}
8545
8546
8547/* Display or clear cursor of window W. If ON is zero, clear the
8548 cursor. If it is non-zero, display the cursor. If ON is nonzero,
8549 where to put the cursor is specified by HPOS, VPOS, X and Y. */
8550
8551void
8552x_display_and_set_cursor (w, on, hpos, vpos, x, y)
8553 struct window *w;
8554 int on, hpos, vpos, x, y;
8555{
8556 struct frame *f = XFRAME (w->frame);
8557 int new_cursor_type;
8558 int new_cursor_width;
8559 struct glyph_matrix *current_glyphs;
8560 struct glyph_row *glyph_row;
8561 struct glyph *glyph;
8562
8563 /* This is pointless on invisible frames, and dangerous on garbaged
8564 windows and frames; in the latter case, the frame or window may
8565 be in the midst of changing its size, and x and y may be off the
8566 window. */
8567 if (! FRAME_VISIBLE_P (f)
8568 || FRAME_GARBAGED_P (f)
8569 || vpos >= w->current_matrix->nrows
8570 || hpos >= w->current_matrix->matrix_w)
8571 return;
8572
8573 /* If cursor is off and we want it off, return quickly. */
8574 if (!on && !w->phys_cursor_on_p)
8575 return;
8576
8577 current_glyphs = w->current_matrix;
8578 glyph_row = MATRIX_ROW (current_glyphs, vpos);
8579 glyph = glyph_row->glyphs[TEXT_AREA] + hpos;
8580
8581 /* If cursor row is not enabled, we don't really know where to
8582 display the cursor. */
8583 if (!glyph_row->enabled_p)
8584 {
8585 w->phys_cursor_on_p = 0;
8586 return;
8587 }
8588
8589 xassert (interrupt_input_blocked);
8590
8591 /* Set new_cursor_type to the cursor we want to be displayed. In a
8592 mini-buffer window, we want the cursor only to appear if we are
8593 reading input from this window. For the selected window, we want
8594 the cursor type given by the frame parameter. If explicitly
8595 marked off, draw no cursor. In all other cases, we want a hollow
8596 box cursor. */
8597 new_cursor_width = -1;
8598 if (cursor_in_echo_area
8599 && FRAME_HAS_MINIBUF_P (f)
8600 && EQ (FRAME_MINIBUF_WINDOW (f), echo_area_window))
8601 {
8602 if (w == XWINDOW (echo_area_window))
8603 new_cursor_type = FRAME_DESIRED_CURSOR (f);
8604 else
8605 new_cursor_type = HOLLOW_BOX_CURSOR;
8606 }
8607 else
8608 {
8609 if (w != XWINDOW (selected_window)
8610 || f != FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f)->x_highlight_frame)
8611 {
8612 extern int cursor_in_non_selected_windows;
8613
8614 if (MINI_WINDOW_P (w) || !cursor_in_non_selected_windows)
8615 new_cursor_type = NO_CURSOR;
8616 else
8617 new_cursor_type = HOLLOW_BOX_CURSOR;
8618 }
8619 else if (w->cursor_off_p)
8620 new_cursor_type = NO_CURSOR;
8621 else
8622 {
8623 struct buffer *b = XBUFFER (w->buffer);
8624
8625 if (EQ (b->cursor_type, Qt))
8626 new_cursor_type = FRAME_DESIRED_CURSOR (f);
8627 else
8628 new_cursor_type = x_specified_cursor_type (b->cursor_type,
8629 &new_cursor_width);
8630 }
8631 }
8632
8633 /* If cursor is currently being shown and we don't want it to be or
8634 it is in the wrong place, or the cursor type is not what we want,
8635 erase it. */
8636 if (w->phys_cursor_on_p
8637 && (!on
8638 || w->phys_cursor.x != x
8639 || w->phys_cursor.y != y
8640 || new_cursor_type != w->phys_cursor_type))
8641 x_erase_phys_cursor (w);
8642
8643 /* If the cursor is now invisible and we want it to be visible,
8644 display it. */
8645 if (on && !w->phys_cursor_on_p)
8646 {
8647 w->phys_cursor_ascent = glyph_row->ascent;
8648 w->phys_cursor_height = glyph_row->height;
8649
8650 /* Set phys_cursor_.* before x_draw_.* is called because some
8651 of them may need the information. */
8652 w->phys_cursor.x = x;
8653 w->phys_cursor.y = glyph_row->y;
8654 w->phys_cursor.hpos = hpos;
8655 w->phys_cursor.vpos = vpos;
8656 w->phys_cursor_type = new_cursor_type;
8657 w->phys_cursor_on_p = 1;
8658
8659 switch (new_cursor_type)
8660 {
8661 case HOLLOW_BOX_CURSOR:
8662 x_draw_hollow_cursor (w, glyph_row);
8663 break;
8664
8665 case FILLED_BOX_CURSOR:
8666 x_draw_phys_cursor_glyph (w, glyph_row, DRAW_CURSOR);
8667 break;
8668
8669 case BAR_CURSOR:
8670 x_draw_bar_cursor (w, glyph_row, new_cursor_width);
8671 break;
8672
8673 case NO_CURSOR:
8674 break;
8675
8676 default:
8677 abort ();
8678 }
8679
8680#ifdef HAVE_X_I18N
8681 if (w == XWINDOW (f->selected_window))
8682 if (FRAME_XIC (f) && (FRAME_XIC_STYLE (f) & XIMPreeditPosition))
8683 xic_set_preeditarea (w, x, y);
8684#endif
8685 }
8686
8687#ifndef XFlush
8688 if (updating_frame != f)
8689 XFlush (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f));
8690#endif
8691}
8692
8693
8694/* Display the cursor on window W, or clear it. X and Y are window
8695 relative pixel coordinates. HPOS and VPOS are glyph matrix
8696 positions. If W is not the selected window, display a hollow
8697 cursor. ON non-zero means display the cursor at X, Y which
8698 correspond to HPOS, VPOS, otherwise it is cleared. */
8699
8700void
8701x_display_cursor (w, on, hpos, vpos, x, y)
8702 struct window *w;
8703 int on, hpos, vpos, x, y;
8704{
8705 BLOCK_INPUT;
8706 x_display_and_set_cursor (w, on, hpos, vpos, x, y);
8707 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
8708}
8709
8710
8711/* Display the cursor on window W, or clear it, according to ON_P.
8712 Don't change the cursor's position. */
8713
8714void
8715x_update_cursor (f, on_p)
8716 struct frame *f;
8717{
8718 x_update_cursor_in_window_tree (XWINDOW (f->root_window), on_p);
8719}
8720
8721
8722/* Call x_update_window_cursor with parameter ON_P on all leaf windows
8723 in the window tree rooted at W. */
8724
8725static void
8726x_update_cursor_in_window_tree (w, on_p)
8727 struct window *w;
8728 int on_p;
8729{
8730 while (w)
8731 {
8732 if (!NILP (w->hchild))
8733 x_update_cursor_in_window_tree (XWINDOW (w->hchild), on_p);
8734 else if (!NILP (w->vchild))
8735 x_update_cursor_in_window_tree (XWINDOW (w->vchild), on_p);
8736 else
8737 x_update_window_cursor (w, on_p);
8738
8739 w = NILP (w->next) ? 0 : XWINDOW (w->next);
8740 }
8741}
8742
8743
8744/* Switch the display of W's cursor on or off, according to the value
8745 of ON. */
8746
8747static void
8748x_update_window_cursor (w, on)
8749 struct window *w;
8750 int on;
8751{
8752 /* Don't update cursor in windows whose frame is in the process
8753 of being deleted. */
8754 if (w->current_matrix)
8755 {
8756 BLOCK_INPUT;
8757 x_display_and_set_cursor (w, on, w->phys_cursor.hpos, w->phys_cursor.vpos,
8758 w->phys_cursor.x, w->phys_cursor.y);
8759 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
8760 }
8761}
8762
8763\f
8764#if 0 /* MAC_TODO: no icon and X error handling (?) */
8765/* Icons. */
8766
8767/* Refresh bitmap kitchen sink icon for frame F
8768 when we get an expose event for it. */
8769
8770void
8771refreshicon (f)
8772 struct frame *f;
8773{
8774 /* Normally, the window manager handles this function. */
8775}
8776
8777/* Make the x-window of frame F use the gnu icon bitmap. */
8778
8779int
8780x_bitmap_icon (f, file)
8781 struct frame *f;
8782 Lisp_Object file;
8783{
8784 int bitmap_id;
8785
8786 if (FRAME_X_WINDOW (f) == 0)
8787 return 1;
8788
8789 /* Free up our existing icon bitmap if any. */
8790 if (f->output_data.x->icon_bitmap > 0)
8791 x_destroy_bitmap (f, f->output_data.x->icon_bitmap);
8792 f->output_data.x->icon_bitmap = 0;
8793
8794 if (STRINGP (file))
8795 bitmap_id = x_create_bitmap_from_file (f, file);
8796 else
8797 {
8798 /* Create the GNU bitmap if necessary. */
8799 if (FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f)->icon_bitmap_id < 0)
8800 FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f)->icon_bitmap_id
8801 = x_create_bitmap_from_data (f, gnu_bits,
8802 gnu_width, gnu_height);
8803
8804 /* The first time we create the GNU bitmap,
8805 this increments the ref-count one extra time.
8806 As a result, the GNU bitmap is never freed.
8807 That way, we don't have to worry about allocating it again. */
8808 x_reference_bitmap (f, FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f)->icon_bitmap_id);
8809
8810 bitmap_id = FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f)->icon_bitmap_id;
8811 }
8812
8813 x_wm_set_icon_pixmap (f, bitmap_id);
8814 f->output_data.x->icon_bitmap = bitmap_id;
8815
8816 return 0;
8817}
8818
8819
8820/* Make the x-window of frame F use a rectangle with text.
8821 Use ICON_NAME as the text. */
8822
8823int
8824x_text_icon (f, icon_name)
8825 struct frame *f;
8826 char *icon_name;
8827{
8828 if (FRAME_X_WINDOW (f) == 0)
8829 return 1;
8830
8831#ifdef HAVE_X11R4
8832 {
8833 XTextProperty text;
8834 text.value = (unsigned char *) icon_name;
8835 text.encoding = XA_STRING;
8836 text.format = 8;
8837 text.nitems = strlen (icon_name);
8838#ifdef USE_X_TOOLKIT
8839 XSetWMIconName (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), XtWindow (f->output_data.x->widget),
8840 &text);
8841#else /* not USE_X_TOOLKIT */
8842 XSetWMIconName (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_X_WINDOW (f), &text);
8843#endif /* not USE_X_TOOLKIT */
8844 }
8845#else /* not HAVE_X11R4 */
8846 XSetIconName (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_X_WINDOW (f), icon_name);
8847#endif /* not HAVE_X11R4 */
8848
8849 if (f->output_data.x->icon_bitmap > 0)
8850 x_destroy_bitmap (f, f->output_data.x->icon_bitmap);
8851 f->output_data.x->icon_bitmap = 0;
8852 x_wm_set_icon_pixmap (f, 0);
8853
8854 return 0;
8855}
8856\f
8857#define X_ERROR_MESSAGE_SIZE 200
8858
8859/* If non-nil, this should be a string.
8860 It means catch X errors and store the error message in this string. */
8861
8862static Lisp_Object x_error_message_string;
8863
8864/* An X error handler which stores the error message in
8865 x_error_message_string. This is called from x_error_handler if
8866 x_catch_errors is in effect. */
8867
8868static void
8869x_error_catcher (display, error)
8870 Display *display;
8871 XErrorEvent *error;
8872{
8873 XGetErrorText (display, error->error_code,
8874 XSTRING (x_error_message_string)->data,
8875 X_ERROR_MESSAGE_SIZE);
8876}
8877
8878/* Begin trapping X errors for display DPY. Actually we trap X errors
8879 for all displays, but DPY should be the display you are actually
8880 operating on.
8881
8882 After calling this function, X protocol errors no longer cause
8883 Emacs to exit; instead, they are recorded in the string
8884 stored in x_error_message_string.
8885
8886 Calling x_check_errors signals an Emacs error if an X error has
8887 occurred since the last call to x_catch_errors or x_check_errors.
8888
8889 Calling x_uncatch_errors resumes the normal error handling. */
8890
8891void x_check_errors ();
8892static Lisp_Object x_catch_errors_unwind ();
8893
8894int
8895x_catch_errors (dpy)
8896 Display *dpy;
8897{
8898 int count = specpdl_ptr - specpdl;
8899
8900 /* Make sure any errors from previous requests have been dealt with. */
8901 XSync (dpy, False);
8902
8903 record_unwind_protect (x_catch_errors_unwind, x_error_message_string);
8904
8905 x_error_message_string = make_uninit_string (X_ERROR_MESSAGE_SIZE);
8906 XSTRING (x_error_message_string)->data[0] = 0;
8907
8908 return count;
8909}
8910
8911/* Unbind the binding that we made to check for X errors. */
8912
8913static Lisp_Object
8914x_catch_errors_unwind (old_val)
8915 Lisp_Object old_val;
8916{
8917 x_error_message_string = old_val;
8918 return Qnil;
8919}
8920
8921/* If any X protocol errors have arrived since the last call to
8922 x_catch_errors or x_check_errors, signal an Emacs error using
8923 sprintf (a buffer, FORMAT, the x error message text) as the text. */
8924
8925void
8926x_check_errors (dpy, format)
8927 Display *dpy;
8928 char *format;
8929{
8930 /* Make sure to catch any errors incurred so far. */
8931 XSync (dpy, False);
8932
8933 if (XSTRING (x_error_message_string)->data[0])
8934 error (format, XSTRING (x_error_message_string)->data);
8935}
8936
8937/* Nonzero if we had any X protocol errors
8938 since we did x_catch_errors on DPY. */
8939
8940int
8941x_had_errors_p (dpy)
8942 Display *dpy;
8943{
8944 /* Make sure to catch any errors incurred so far. */
8945 XSync (dpy, False);
8946
8947 return XSTRING (x_error_message_string)->data[0] != 0;
8948}
8949
8950/* Forget about any errors we have had, since we did x_catch_errors on DPY. */
8951
8952void
8953x_clear_errors (dpy)
8954 Display *dpy;
8955{
8956 XSTRING (x_error_message_string)->data[0] = 0;
8957}
8958
8959/* Stop catching X protocol errors and let them make Emacs die.
8960 DPY should be the display that was passed to x_catch_errors.
8961 COUNT should be the value that was returned by
8962 the corresponding call to x_catch_errors. */
8963
8964void
8965x_uncatch_errors (dpy, count)
8966 Display *dpy;
8967 int count;
8968{
8969 unbind_to (count, Qnil);
8970}
8971
8972#if 0
8973static unsigned int x_wire_count;
8974x_trace_wire ()
8975{
8976 fprintf (stderr, "Lib call: %d\n", ++x_wire_count);
8977}
8978#endif /* ! 0 */
8979
8980\f
8981/* Handle SIGPIPE, which can happen when the connection to a server
8982 simply goes away. SIGPIPE is handled by x_connection_signal.
8983 Don't need to do anything, because the write which caused the
8984 SIGPIPE will fail, causing Xlib to invoke the X IO error handler,
8985 which will do the appropriate cleanup for us. */
8986
8987static SIGTYPE
8988x_connection_signal (signalnum) /* If we don't have an argument, */
8989 int signalnum; /* some compilers complain in signal calls. */
8990{
8991#ifdef USG
8992 /* USG systems forget handlers when they are used;
8993 must reestablish each time */
8994 signal (signalnum, x_connection_signal);
8995#endif /* USG */
8996}
8997\f
8998/* Handling X errors. */
8999
9000/* Handle the loss of connection to display DISPLAY. */
9001
9002static SIGTYPE
9003x_connection_closed (display, error_message)
9004 Display *display;
9005 char *error_message;
9006{
9007 struct x_display_info *dpyinfo = x_display_info_for_display (display);
9008 Lisp_Object frame, tail;
9009
9010 /* Indicate that this display is dead. */
9011
9012#if 0 /* Closing the display caused a bus error on OpenWindows. */
9013#ifdef USE_X_TOOLKIT
9014 XtCloseDisplay (display);
9015#endif
9016#endif
9017
9018 if (dpyinfo)
9019 dpyinfo->display = 0;
9020
9021 /* First delete frames whose mini-buffers are on frames
9022 that are on the dead display. */
9023 FOR_EACH_FRAME (tail, frame)
9024 {
9025 Lisp_Object minibuf_frame;
9026 minibuf_frame
9027 = WINDOW_FRAME (XWINDOW (FRAME_MINIBUF_WINDOW (XFRAME (frame))));
9028 if (FRAME_X_P (XFRAME (frame))
9029 && FRAME_X_P (XFRAME (minibuf_frame))
9030 && ! EQ (frame, minibuf_frame)
9031 && FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (XFRAME (minibuf_frame)) == dpyinfo)
9032 Fdelete_frame (frame, Qt);
9033 }
9034
9035 /* Now delete all remaining frames on the dead display.
9036 We are now sure none of these is used as the mini-buffer
9037 for another frame that we need to delete. */
9038 FOR_EACH_FRAME (tail, frame)
9039 if (FRAME_X_P (XFRAME (frame))
9040 && FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (XFRAME (frame)) == dpyinfo)
9041 {
9042 /* Set this to t so that Fdelete_frame won't get confused
9043 trying to find a replacement. */
9044 FRAME_KBOARD (XFRAME (frame))->Vdefault_minibuffer_frame = Qt;
9045 Fdelete_frame (frame, Qt);
9046 }
9047
9048 if (dpyinfo)
9049 x_delete_display (dpyinfo);
9050
9051 if (x_display_list == 0)
9052 {
9053 fprintf (stderr, "%s\n", error_message);
9054 shut_down_emacs (0, 0, Qnil);
9055 exit (70);
9056 }
9057
9058 /* Ordinary stack unwind doesn't deal with these. */
9059#ifdef SIGIO
9060 sigunblock (sigmask (SIGIO));
9061#endif
9062 sigunblock (sigmask (SIGALRM));
9063 TOTALLY_UNBLOCK_INPUT;
9064
9065 clear_waiting_for_input ();
9066 error ("%s", error_message);
9067}
9068
9069/* This is the usual handler for X protocol errors.
9070 It kills all frames on the display that we got the error for.
9071 If that was the only one, it prints an error message and kills Emacs. */
9072
9073static void
9074x_error_quitter (display, error)
9075 Display *display;
9076 XErrorEvent *error;
9077{
9078 char buf[256], buf1[356];
9079
9080 /* Note that there is no real way portable across R3/R4 to get the
9081 original error handler. */
9082
9083 XGetErrorText (display, error->error_code, buf, sizeof (buf));
9084 sprintf (buf1, "X protocol error: %s on protocol request %d",
9085 buf, error->request_code);
9086 x_connection_closed (display, buf1);
9087}
9088
9089/* This is the first-level handler for X protocol errors.
9090 It calls x_error_quitter or x_error_catcher. */
9091
9092static int
9093x_error_handler (display, error)
9094 Display *display;
9095 XErrorEvent *error;
9096{
9097 if (! NILP (x_error_message_string))
9098 x_error_catcher (display, error);
9099 else
9100 x_error_quitter (display, error);
9101 return 0;
9102}
9103
9104/* This is the handler for X IO errors, always.
9105 It kills all frames on the display that we lost touch with.
9106 If that was the only one, it prints an error message and kills Emacs. */
9107
9108static int
9109x_io_error_quitter (display)
9110 Display *display;
9111{
9112 char buf[256];
9113
9114 sprintf (buf, "Connection lost to X server `%s'", DisplayString (display));
9115 x_connection_closed (display, buf);
9116 return 0;
9117}
9118#endif
9119\f
9120/* Changing the font of the frame. */
9121
9122/* Give frame F the font named FONTNAME as its default font, and
9123 return the full name of that font. FONTNAME may be a wildcard
9124 pattern; in that case, we choose some font that fits the pattern.
9125 The return value shows which font we chose. */
9126
9127Lisp_Object
9128x_new_font (f, fontname)
9129 struct frame *f;
9130 register char *fontname;
9131{
9132 struct font_info *fontp
9133 = FS_LOAD_FONT (f, 0, fontname, -1);
9134
9135 if (!fontp)
9136 return Qnil;
9137
9138 f->output_data.mac->font = (XFontStruct *) (fontp->font);
9139 f->output_data.mac->baseline_offset = fontp->baseline_offset;
9140 f->output_data.mac->fontset = -1;
9141
9142 /* Compute the scroll bar width in character columns. */
9143 if (f->scroll_bar_pixel_width > 0)
9144 {
9145 int wid = FONT_WIDTH (f->output_data.mac->font);
9146 f->scroll_bar_cols = (f->scroll_bar_pixel_width + wid-1) / wid;
9147 }
9148 else
9149 {
9150 int wid = FONT_WIDTH (f->output_data.mac->font);
9151 f->scroll_bar_cols = (14 + wid - 1) / wid;
9152 }
9153
9154 /* Now make the frame display the given font. */
9155 if (FRAME_MAC_WINDOW (f) != 0)
9156 {
9157 XSetFont (FRAME_MAC_DISPLAY (f), f->output_data.mac->normal_gc,
9158 f->output_data.mac->font);
9159 XSetFont (FRAME_MAC_DISPLAY (f), f->output_data.mac->reverse_gc,
9160 f->output_data.mac->font);
9161 XSetFont (FRAME_MAC_DISPLAY (f), f->output_data.mac->cursor_gc,
9162 f->output_data.mac->font);
9163
9164 frame_update_line_height (f);
9165 x_set_window_size (f, 0, f->width, f->height);
9166 }
9167 else
9168 /* If we are setting a new frame's font for the first time, there
9169 are no faces yet, so this font's height is the line height. */
9170 f->output_data.mac->line_height = FONT_HEIGHT (f->output_data.mac->font);
9171
9172 return build_string (fontp->full_name);
9173}
9174
9175/* Give frame F the fontset named FONTSETNAME as its default font, and
9176 return the full name of that fontset. FONTSETNAME may be a
9177 wildcard pattern; in that case, we choose some fontset that fits
9178 the pattern. The return value shows which fontset we chose. */
9179
9180Lisp_Object
9181x_new_fontset (f, fontsetname)
9182 struct frame *f;
9183 char *fontsetname;
9184{
9185 int fontset = fs_query_fontset (build_string (fontsetname), 0);
9186 Lisp_Object result;
9187
9188 if (fontset < 0)
9189 return Qnil;
9190
9191 if (f->output_data.mac->fontset == fontset)
9192 /* This fontset is already set in frame F. There's nothing more
9193 to do. */
9194 return fontset_name (fontset);
9195
9196 result = x_new_font (f, (XSTRING (fontset_ascii (fontset))->data));
9197
9198 if (!STRINGP (result))
9199 /* Can't load ASCII font. */
9200 return Qnil;
9201
9202 /* Since x_new_font doesn't update any fontset information, do it
9203 now. */
9204 f->output_data.mac->fontset = fontset;
9205
9206#ifdef HAVE_X_I18N
9207 if (FRAME_XIC (f)
9208 && (FRAME_XIC_STYLE (f) & (XIMPreeditPosition | XIMStatusArea)))
9209 xic_set_xfontset (f, XSTRING (fontset_ascii (fontset))->data);
9210#endif
9211
9212 return build_string (fontsetname);
9213}
9214
9215#if 0 /* MAC_TODO: inline input methods for Mac */
9216\f
9217/***********************************************************************
9218 X Input Methods
9219 ***********************************************************************/
9220
9221#ifdef HAVE_X_I18N
9222
9223#ifdef HAVE_X11R6
9224
9225/* XIM destroy callback function, which is called whenever the
9226 connection to input method XIM dies. CLIENT_DATA contains a
9227 pointer to the x_display_info structure corresponding to XIM. */
9228
9229static void
9230xim_destroy_callback (xim, client_data, call_data)
9231 XIM xim;
9232 XPointer client_data;
9233 XPointer call_data;
9234{
9235 struct x_display_info *dpyinfo = (struct x_display_info *) client_data;
9236 Lisp_Object frame, tail;
9237
9238 BLOCK_INPUT;
9239
9240 /* No need to call XDestroyIC.. */
9241 FOR_EACH_FRAME (tail, frame)
9242 {
9243 struct frame *f = XFRAME (frame);
9244 if (FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f) == dpyinfo)
9245 {
9246 FRAME_XIC (f) = NULL;
9247 if (FRAME_XIC_FONTSET (f))
9248 {
9249 XFreeFontSet (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_XIC_FONTSET (f));
9250 FRAME_XIC_FONTSET (f) = NULL;
9251 }
9252 }
9253 }
9254
9255 /* No need to call XCloseIM. */
9256 dpyinfo->xim = NULL;
9257 XFree (dpyinfo->xim_styles);
9258 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
9259}
9260
9261#endif /* HAVE_X11R6 */
9262
9263/* Open the connection to the XIM server on display DPYINFO.
9264 RESOURCE_NAME is the resource name Emacs uses. */
9265
9266static void
9267xim_open_dpy (dpyinfo, resource_name)
9268 struct x_display_info *dpyinfo;
9269 char *resource_name;
9270{
9271#ifdef USE_XIM
9272 XIM xim;
9273
9274 xim = XOpenIM (dpyinfo->display, dpyinfo->xrdb, resource_name, EMACS_CLASS);
9275 dpyinfo->xim = xim;
9276
9277 if (xim)
9278 {
9279#ifdef HAVE_X11R6
9280 XIMCallback destroy;
9281#endif
9282
9283 /* Get supported styles and XIM values. */
9284 XGetIMValues (xim, XNQueryInputStyle, &dpyinfo->xim_styles, NULL);
9285
9286#ifdef HAVE_X11R6
9287 destroy.callback = xim_destroy_callback;
9288 destroy.client_data = (XPointer)dpyinfo;
9289 /* This isn't prptotyped in OSF 5.0. */
9290 XSetIMValues (xim, XNDestroyCallback, &destroy, NULL);
9291#endif
9292 }
9293
9294#else /* not USE_XIM */
9295 dpyinfo->xim = NULL;
9296#endif /* not USE_XIM */
9297}
9298
9299
9300#ifdef HAVE_X11R6_XIM
9301
9302struct xim_inst_t
9303{
9304 struct x_display_info *dpyinfo;
9305 char *resource_name;
9306};
9307
9308/* XIM instantiate callback function, which is called whenever an XIM
9309 server is available. DISPLAY is teh display of the XIM.
9310 CLIENT_DATA contains a pointer to an xim_inst_t structure created
9311 when the callback was registered. */
9312
9313static void
9314xim_instantiate_callback (display, client_data, call_data)
9315 Display *display;
9316 XPointer client_data;
9317 XPointer call_data;
9318{
9319 struct xim_inst_t *xim_inst = (struct xim_inst_t *) client_data;
9320 struct x_display_info *dpyinfo = xim_inst->dpyinfo;
9321
9322 /* We don't support multiple XIM connections. */
9323 if (dpyinfo->xim)
9324 return;
9325
9326 xim_open_dpy (dpyinfo, xim_inst->resource_name);
9327
9328 /* Create XIC for the existing frames on the same display, as long
9329 as they have no XIC. */
9330 if (dpyinfo->xim && dpyinfo->reference_count > 0)
9331 {
9332 Lisp_Object tail, frame;
9333
9334 BLOCK_INPUT;
9335 FOR_EACH_FRAME (tail, frame)
9336 {
9337 struct frame *f = XFRAME (frame);
9338
9339 if (FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f) == xim_inst->dpyinfo)
9340 if (FRAME_XIC (f) == NULL)
9341 {
9342 create_frame_xic (f);
9343 if (FRAME_XIC_STYLE (f) & XIMStatusArea)
9344 xic_set_statusarea (f);
9345 if (FRAME_XIC_STYLE (f) & XIMPreeditPosition)
9346 {
9347 struct window *w = XWINDOW (f->selected_window);
9348 xic_set_preeditarea (w, w->cursor.x, w->cursor.y);
9349 }
9350 }
9351 }
9352
9353 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
9354 }
9355}
9356
9357#endif /* HAVE_X11R6_XIM */
9358
9359
9360/* Open a connection to the XIM server on display DPYINFO.
9361 RESOURCE_NAME is the resource name for Emacs. On X11R5, open the
9362 connection only at the first time. On X11R6, open the connection
9363 in the XIM instantiate callback function. */
9364
9365static void
9366xim_initialize (dpyinfo, resource_name)
9367 struct x_display_info *dpyinfo;
9368 char *resource_name;
9369{
9370#ifdef USE_XIM
9371#ifdef HAVE_X11R6_XIM
9372 struct xim_inst_t *xim_inst;
9373 int len;
9374
9375 dpyinfo->xim = NULL;
9376 xim_inst = (struct xim_inst_t *) xmalloc (sizeof (struct xim_inst_t));
9377 xim_inst->dpyinfo = dpyinfo;
9378 len = strlen (resource_name);
9379 xim_inst->resource_name = (char *) xmalloc (len + 1);
9380 bcopy (resource_name, xim_inst->resource_name, len + 1);
9381 XRegisterIMInstantiateCallback (dpyinfo->display, dpyinfo->xrdb,
9382 resource_name, EMACS_CLASS,
9383 xim_instantiate_callback,
9384 /* Fixme: This is XPointer in
9385 XFree86 but (XPointer *) on
9386 Tru64, at least. */
9387 (XPointer) xim_inst);
9388#else /* not HAVE_X11R6_XIM */
9389 dpyinfo->xim = NULL;
9390 xim_open_dpy (dpyinfo, resource_name);
9391#endif /* not HAVE_X11R6_XIM */
9392
9393#else /* not USE_XIM */
9394 dpyinfo->xim = NULL;
9395#endif /* not USE_XIM */
9396}
9397
9398
9399/* Close the connection to the XIM server on display DPYINFO. */
9400
9401static void
9402xim_close_dpy (dpyinfo)
9403 struct x_display_info *dpyinfo;
9404{
9405#ifdef USE_XIM
9406#ifdef HAVE_X11R6_XIM
9407 XUnregisterIMInstantiateCallback (dpyinfo->display, dpyinfo->xrdb,
9408 NULL, EMACS_CLASS,
9409 xim_instantiate_callback, NULL);
9410#endif /* not HAVE_X11R6_XIM */
9411 XCloseIM (dpyinfo->xim);
9412 dpyinfo->xim = NULL;
9413 XFree (dpyinfo->xim_styles);
9414#endif /* USE_XIM */
9415}
9416
9417#endif /* not HAVE_X11R6_XIM */
9418
9419#endif
9420\f
9421/* Calculate the absolute position in frame F
9422 from its current recorded position values and gravity. */
9423
9424static void
9425x_calc_absolute_position (f)
9426 struct frame *f;
9427{
9428 Point pt;
9429 int flags = f->output_data.mac->size_hint_flags;
9430
9431 pt.h = pt.v = 0;
9432
9433 /* Find the position of the outside upper-left corner of
9434 the inner window, with respect to the outer window. */
9435 if (f->output_data.mac->parent_desc != FRAME_MAC_DISPLAY_INFO (f)->root_window)
9436 {
9437 GrafPtr savePort;
9438 GetPort (&savePort);
9439 SetPort (FRAME_MAC_WINDOW (f));
9440 SetPt(&pt, FRAME_MAC_WINDOW (f)->portRect.left, FRAME_MAC_WINDOW (f)->portRect.top);
9441 LocalToGlobal (&pt);
9442 SetPort (savePort);
9443 }
9444
9445 /* Treat negative positions as relative to the leftmost bottommost
9446 position that fits on the screen. */
9447 if (flags & XNegative)
9448 f->output_data.mac->left_pos = (FRAME_MAC_DISPLAY_INFO (f)->width
9449 - 2 * f->output_data.mac->border_width - pt.h
9450 - PIXEL_WIDTH (f)
9451 + f->output_data.mac->left_pos);
9452 /* NTEMACS_TODO: Subtract menubar height? */
9453 if (flags & YNegative)
9454 f->output_data.mac->top_pos = (FRAME_MAC_DISPLAY_INFO (f)->height
9455 - 2 * f->output_data.mac->border_width - pt.v
9456 - PIXEL_HEIGHT (f)
9457 + f->output_data.mac->top_pos);
9458 /* The left_pos and top_pos
9459 are now relative to the top and left screen edges,
9460 so the flags should correspond. */
9461 f->output_data.mac->size_hint_flags &= ~ (XNegative | YNegative);
9462}
9463
9464/* CHANGE_GRAVITY is 1 when calling from Fset_frame_position,
9465 to really change the position, and 0 when calling from
9466 x_make_frame_visible (in that case, XOFF and YOFF are the current
9467 position values). It is -1 when calling from x_set_frame_parameters,
9468 which means, do adjust for borders but don't change the gravity. */
9469
9470void
9471x_set_offset (f, xoff, yoff, change_gravity)
9472 struct frame *f;
9473 register int xoff, yoff;
9474 int change_gravity;
9475{
9476 if (change_gravity > 0)
9477 {
9478 f->output_data.mac->top_pos = yoff;
9479 f->output_data.mac->left_pos = xoff;
9480 f->output_data.mac->size_hint_flags &= ~ (XNegative | YNegative);
9481 if (xoff < 0)
9482 f->output_data.mac->size_hint_flags |= XNegative;
9483 if (yoff < 0)
9484 f->output_data.mac->size_hint_flags |= YNegative;
9485 f->output_data.mac->win_gravity = NorthWestGravity;
9486 }
9487 x_calc_absolute_position (f);
9488
9489 BLOCK_INPUT;
9490 x_wm_set_size_hint (f, (long) 0, 0);
9491
9492 MoveWindow (f->output_data.mac->mWP, xoff + 6, yoff + 42, false);
9493
9494 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
9495}
9496
9497/* Call this to change the size of frame F's x-window.
9498 If CHANGE_GRAVITY is 1, we change to top-left-corner window gravity
9499 for this size change and subsequent size changes.
9500 Otherwise we leave the window gravity unchanged. */
9501
9502void
9503x_set_window_size (f, change_gravity, cols, rows)
9504 struct frame *f;
9505 int change_gravity;
9506 int cols, rows;
9507{
9508 int pixelwidth, pixelheight;
9509
9510 check_frame_size (f, &rows, &cols);
9511 f->output_data.mac->vertical_scroll_bar_extra
9512 = (!FRAME_HAS_VERTICAL_SCROLL_BARS (f)
9513 ? 0
9514 : FRAME_SCROLL_BAR_PIXEL_WIDTH (f) > 0
9515 ? FRAME_SCROLL_BAR_PIXEL_WIDTH (f)
9516 : (FRAME_SCROLL_BAR_COLS (f) * FONT_WIDTH (f->output_data.mac->font)));
9517 f->output_data.mac->flags_areas_extra
9518 = FRAME_FLAGS_AREA_WIDTH (f);
9519 pixelwidth = CHAR_TO_PIXEL_WIDTH (f, cols);
9520 pixelheight = CHAR_TO_PIXEL_HEIGHT (f, rows);
9521
9522 f->output_data.mac->win_gravity = NorthWestGravity;
9523 x_wm_set_size_hint (f, (long) 0, 0);
9524
9525 SizeWindow (FRAME_MAC_WINDOW (f), pixelwidth, pixelheight, 0);
9526
9527 /* Now, strictly speaking, we can't be sure that this is accurate,
9528 but the window manager will get around to dealing with the size
9529 change request eventually, and we'll hear how it went when the
9530 ConfigureNotify event gets here.
9531
9532 We could just not bother storing any of this information here,
9533 and let the ConfigureNotify event set everything up, but that
9534 might be kind of confusing to the Lisp code, since size changes
9535 wouldn't be reported in the frame parameters until some random
9536 point in the future when the ConfigureNotify event arrives.
9537
9538 We pass 1 for DELAY since we can't run Lisp code inside of
9539 a BLOCK_INPUT. */
9540 change_frame_size (f, rows, cols, 0, 1, 0);
9541 PIXEL_WIDTH (f) = pixelwidth;
9542 PIXEL_HEIGHT (f) = pixelheight;
9543
9544 /* We've set {FRAME,PIXEL}_{WIDTH,HEIGHT} to the values we hope to
9545 receive in the ConfigureNotify event; if we get what we asked
9546 for, then the event won't cause the screen to become garbaged, so
9547 we have to make sure to do it here. */
9548 SET_FRAME_GARBAGED (f);
9549
9550 XFlush (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f));
9551
9552 /* If cursor was outside the new size, mark it as off. */
9553 mark_window_cursors_off (XWINDOW (f->root_window));
9554
9555 /* Clear out any recollection of where the mouse highlighting was,
9556 since it might be in a place that's outside the new frame size.
9557 Actually checking whether it is outside is a pain in the neck,
9558 so don't try--just let the highlighting be done afresh with new size. */
9559 cancel_mouse_face (f);
9560}
9561\f
9562/* Mouse warping. */
9563
9564void x_set_mouse_pixel_position (struct frame *f, int pix_x, int pix_y);
9565
9566void
9567x_set_mouse_position (f, x, y)
9568 struct frame *f;
9569 int x, y;
9570{
9571 int pix_x, pix_y;
9572
9573 pix_x = CHAR_TO_PIXEL_COL (f, x) + FONT_WIDTH (f->output_data.mac->font) / 2;
9574 pix_y = CHAR_TO_PIXEL_ROW (f, y) + f->output_data.mac->line_height / 2;
9575
9576 if (pix_x < 0) pix_x = 0;
9577 if (pix_x > PIXEL_WIDTH (f)) pix_x = PIXEL_WIDTH (f);
9578
9579 if (pix_y < 0) pix_y = 0;
9580 if (pix_y > PIXEL_HEIGHT (f)) pix_y = PIXEL_HEIGHT (f);
9581
9582 x_set_mouse_pixel_position (f, pix_x, pix_y);
9583}
9584
9585/* Move the mouse to position pixel PIX_X, PIX_Y relative to frame F. */
9586
9587void
9588x_set_mouse_pixel_position (f, pix_x, pix_y)
9589 struct frame *f;
9590 int pix_x, pix_y;
9591{
9592#if 0 /* MAC_TODO: CursorDeviceMoveTo is non-Carbon */
9593 BLOCK_INPUT;
9594
9595 XWarpPointer (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), None, FRAME_X_WINDOW (f),
9596 0, 0, 0, 0, pix_x, pix_y);
9597 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
9598#endif
9599}
9600\f
9601/* focus shifting, raising and lowering. */
9602
9603static void
9604x_focus_on_frame (f)
9605 struct frame *f;
9606{
9607#if 0 /* This proves to be unpleasant. */
9608 x_raise_frame (f);
9609#endif
9610#if 0
9611 /* I don't think that the ICCCM allows programs to do things like this
9612 without the interaction of the window manager. Whatever you end up
9613 doing with this code, do it to x_unfocus_frame too. */
9614 XSetInputFocus (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_X_WINDOW (f),
9615 RevertToPointerRoot, CurrentTime);
9616#endif /* ! 0 */
9617}
9618
9619static void
9620x_unfocus_frame (f)
9621 struct frame *f;
9622{
9623#if 0
9624 /* Look at the remarks in x_focus_on_frame. */
9625 if (FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f)->x_focus_frame == f)
9626 XSetInputFocus (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), PointerRoot,
9627 RevertToPointerRoot, CurrentTime);
9628#endif /* ! 0 */
9629}
9630
9631/* Raise frame F. */
9632
9633void
9634x_raise_frame (f)
9635 struct frame *f;
9636{
9637 if (f->async_visible)
9638 SelectWindow (FRAME_MAC_WINDOW (f));
9639}
9640
9641/* Lower frame F. */
9642
9643void
9644x_lower_frame (f)
9645 struct frame *f;
9646{
9647 if (f->async_visible)
9648 SendBehind (FRAME_MAC_WINDOW (f), nil);
9649}
9650
9651void
9652XTframe_raise_lower (f, raise_flag)
9653 FRAME_PTR f;
9654 int raise_flag;
9655{
9656 if (raise_flag)
9657 x_raise_frame (f);
9658 else
9659 x_lower_frame (f);
9660}
9661\f
9662/* Change of visibility. */
9663
9664/* This tries to wait until the frame is really visible.
9665 However, if the window manager asks the user where to position
9666 the frame, this will return before the user finishes doing that.
9667 The frame will not actually be visible at that time,
9668 but it will become visible later when the window manager
9669 finishes with it. */
9670
9671void
9672x_make_frame_visible (f)
9673 struct frame *f;
9674{
9675 Lisp_Object type;
9676 int original_top, original_left;
9677
9678 BLOCK_INPUT;
9679
9680 if (! FRAME_VISIBLE_P (f))
9681 {
9682 /* We test FRAME_GARBAGED_P here to make sure we don't
9683 call x_set_offset a second time
9684 if we get to x_make_frame_visible a second time
9685 before the window gets really visible. */
9686 if (! FRAME_ICONIFIED_P (f)
9687 && ! f->output_data.mac->asked_for_visible)
9688 x_set_offset (f, f->output_data.mac->left_pos,
9689 f->output_data.mac->top_pos, 0);
9690
9691 f->output_data.mac->asked_for_visible = 1;
9692
9693 ShowWindow (FRAME_MAC_WINDOW (f));
9694 }
9695
9696 XFlush (FRAME_MAC_DISPLAY (f));
9697
9698 /* Synchronize to ensure Emacs knows the frame is visible
9699 before we do anything else. We do this loop with input not blocked
9700 so that incoming events are handled. */
9701 {
9702 Lisp_Object frame;
9703 int count;
9704
9705 /* This must come after we set COUNT. */
9706 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
9707
9708 XSETFRAME (frame, f);
9709
9710 /* Wait until the frame is visible. Process X events until a
9711 MapNotify event has been seen, or until we think we won't get a
9712 MapNotify at all.. */
9713 for (count = input_signal_count + 10;
9714 input_signal_count < count && !FRAME_VISIBLE_P (f);)
9715 {
9716 /* Force processing of queued events. */
9717 x_sync (f);
9718
9719 /* Machines that do polling rather than SIGIO have been
9720 observed to go into a busy-wait here. So we'll fake an
9721 alarm signal to let the handler know that there's something
9722 to be read. We used to raise a real alarm, but it seems
9723 that the handler isn't always enabled here. This is
9724 probably a bug. */
9725 if (input_polling_used ())
9726 {
9727 /* It could be confusing if a real alarm arrives while
9728 processing the fake one. Turn it off and let the
9729 handler reset it. */
9730 extern void poll_for_input_1 P_ ((void));
9731 int old_poll_suppress_count = poll_suppress_count;
9732 poll_suppress_count = 1;
9733 poll_for_input_1 ();
9734 poll_suppress_count = old_poll_suppress_count;
9735 }
9736
9737 /* See if a MapNotify event has been processed. */
9738 FRAME_SAMPLE_VISIBILITY (f);
9739 }
9740 }
9741}
9742
9743/* Change from mapped state to withdrawn state. */
9744
9745/* Make the frame visible (mapped and not iconified). */
9746
9747void
9748x_make_frame_invisible (f)
9749 struct frame *f;
9750{
9751 /* Don't keep the highlight on an invisible frame. */
9752 if (FRAME_MAC_DISPLAY_INFO (f)->x_highlight_frame == f)
9753 FRAME_MAC_DISPLAY_INFO (f)->x_highlight_frame = 0;
9754
9755 BLOCK_INPUT;
9756
9757 HideWindow (FRAME_MAC_WINDOW (f));
9758
9759 /* We can't distinguish this from iconification
9760 just by the event that we get from the server.
9761 So we can't win using the usual strategy of letting
9762 FRAME_SAMPLE_VISIBILITY set this. So do it by hand,
9763 and synchronize with the server to make sure we agree. */
9764 f->visible = 0;
9765 FRAME_ICONIFIED_P (f) = 0;
9766 f->async_visible = 0;
9767 f->async_iconified = 0;
9768
9769 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
9770}
9771
9772/* Change window state from mapped to iconified. */
9773
9774void
9775x_iconify_frame (f)
9776 struct frame *f;
9777{
9778#if 0 /* MAC_TODO: really no iconify on Mac */
9779 int result;
9780 Lisp_Object type;
9781
9782 /* Don't keep the highlight on an invisible frame. */
9783 if (FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f)->x_highlight_frame == f)
9784 FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f)->x_highlight_frame = 0;
9785
9786 if (f->async_iconified)
9787 return;
9788
9789 BLOCK_INPUT;
9790
9791 FRAME_SAMPLE_VISIBILITY (f);
9792
9793 type = x_icon_type (f);
9794 if (!NILP (type))
9795 x_bitmap_icon (f, type);
9796
9797#ifdef USE_X_TOOLKIT
9798
9799 if (! FRAME_VISIBLE_P (f))
9800 {
9801 if (! EQ (Vx_no_window_manager, Qt))
9802 x_wm_set_window_state (f, IconicState);
9803 /* This was XtPopup, but that did nothing for an iconified frame. */
9804 XtMapWidget (f->output_data.x->widget);
9805 /* The server won't give us any event to indicate
9806 that an invisible frame was changed to an icon,
9807 so we have to record it here. */
9808 f->iconified = 1;
9809 f->visible = 1;
9810 f->async_iconified = 1;
9811 f->async_visible = 0;
9812 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
9813 return;
9814 }
9815
9816 result = XIconifyWindow (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f),
9817 XtWindow (f->output_data.x->widget),
9818 DefaultScreen (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f)));
9819 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
9820
9821 if (!result)
9822 error ("Can't notify window manager of iconification");
9823
9824 f->async_iconified = 1;
9825 f->async_visible = 0;
9826
9827
9828 BLOCK_INPUT;
9829 XFlush (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f));
9830 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
9831#else /* not USE_X_TOOLKIT */
9832
9833 /* Make sure the X server knows where the window should be positioned,
9834 in case the user deiconifies with the window manager. */
9835 if (! FRAME_VISIBLE_P (f) && !FRAME_ICONIFIED_P (f))
9836 x_set_offset (f, f->output_data.x->left_pos, f->output_data.x->top_pos, 0);
9837
9838 /* Since we don't know which revision of X we're running, we'll use both
9839 the X11R3 and X11R4 techniques. I don't know if this is a good idea. */
9840
9841 /* X11R4: send a ClientMessage to the window manager using the
9842 WM_CHANGE_STATE type. */
9843 {
9844 XEvent message;
9845
9846 message.xclient.window = FRAME_X_WINDOW (f);
9847 message.xclient.type = ClientMessage;
9848 message.xclient.message_type = FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f)->Xatom_wm_change_state;
9849 message.xclient.format = 32;
9850 message.xclient.data.l[0] = IconicState;
9851
9852 if (! XSendEvent (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f),
9853 DefaultRootWindow (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f)),
9854 False,
9855 SubstructureRedirectMask | SubstructureNotifyMask,
9856 &message))
9857 {
9858 UNBLOCK_INPUT_RESIGNAL;
9859 error ("Can't notify window manager of iconification");
9860 }
9861 }
9862
9863 /* X11R3: set the initial_state field of the window manager hints to
9864 IconicState. */
9865 x_wm_set_window_state (f, IconicState);
9866
9867 if (!FRAME_VISIBLE_P (f))
9868 {
9869 /* If the frame was withdrawn, before, we must map it. */
9870 XMapRaised (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_X_WINDOW (f));
9871 }
9872
9873 f->async_iconified = 1;
9874 f->async_visible = 0;
9875
9876 XFlush (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f));
9877 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
9878#endif /* not USE_X_TOOLKIT */
9879#endif
9880}
9881\f
9882/* Destroy the X window of frame F. */
9883
9884void
9885x_destroy_window (f)
9886 struct frame *f;
9887{
9888 struct mac_display_info *dpyinfo = FRAME_MAC_DISPLAY_INFO (f);
9889
9890 BLOCK_INPUT;
9891
9892 DisposeWindow (FRAME_MAC_WINDOW (f));
9893
9894 free_frame_menubar (f);
9895 free_frame_faces (f);
9896
9897 xfree (f->output_data.mac);
9898 f->output_data.mac = 0;
9899 if (f == dpyinfo->x_focus_frame)
9900 dpyinfo->x_focus_frame = 0;
9901 if (f == dpyinfo->x_focus_event_frame)
9902 dpyinfo->x_focus_event_frame = 0;
9903 if (f == dpyinfo->x_highlight_frame)
9904 dpyinfo->x_highlight_frame = 0;
9905
9906 dpyinfo->reference_count--;
9907
9908 if (f == dpyinfo->mouse_face_mouse_frame)
9909 {
9910 dpyinfo->mouse_face_beg_row
9911 = dpyinfo->mouse_face_beg_col = -1;
9912 dpyinfo->mouse_face_end_row
9913 = dpyinfo->mouse_face_end_col = -1;
9914 dpyinfo->mouse_face_window = Qnil;
9915 dpyinfo->mouse_face_deferred_gc = 0;
9916 dpyinfo->mouse_face_mouse_frame = 0;
9917 }
9918
9919 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
9920}
9921\f
9922/* Setting window manager hints. */
9923
9924/* Set the normal size hints for the window manager, for frame F.
9925 FLAGS is the flags word to use--or 0 meaning preserve the flags
9926 that the window now has.
9927 If USER_POSITION is nonzero, we set the USPosition
9928 flag (this is useful when FLAGS is 0). */
9929
9930void
9931x_wm_set_size_hint (f, flags, user_position)
9932 struct frame *f;
9933 long flags;
9934 int user_position;
9935{
9936#if 0 /* MAC_TODO: connect this to the Appearance Manager */
9937 XSizeHints size_hints;
9938
9939#ifdef USE_X_TOOLKIT
9940 Arg al[2];
9941 int ac = 0;
9942 Dimension widget_width, widget_height;
9943 Window window = XtWindow (f->output_data.x->widget);
9944#else /* not USE_X_TOOLKIT */
9945 Window window = FRAME_X_WINDOW (f);
9946#endif /* not USE_X_TOOLKIT */
9947
9948 /* Setting PMaxSize caused various problems. */
9949 size_hints.flags = PResizeInc | PMinSize /* | PMaxSize */;
9950
9951 size_hints.x = f->output_data.x->left_pos;
9952 size_hints.y = f->output_data.x->top_pos;
9953
9954#ifdef USE_X_TOOLKIT
9955 XtSetArg (al[ac], XtNwidth, &widget_width); ac++;
9956 XtSetArg (al[ac], XtNheight, &widget_height); ac++;
9957 XtGetValues (f->output_data.x->widget, al, ac);
9958 size_hints.height = widget_height;
9959 size_hints.width = widget_width;
9960#else /* not USE_X_TOOLKIT */
9961 size_hints.height = PIXEL_HEIGHT (f);
9962 size_hints.width = PIXEL_WIDTH (f);
9963#endif /* not USE_X_TOOLKIT */
9964
9965 size_hints.width_inc = FONT_WIDTH (f->output_data.x->font);
9966 size_hints.height_inc = f->output_data.x->line_height;
9967 size_hints.max_width
9968 = FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f)->width - CHAR_TO_PIXEL_WIDTH (f, 0);
9969 size_hints.max_height
9970 = FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f)->height - CHAR_TO_PIXEL_HEIGHT (f, 0);
9971
9972 /* Calculate the base and minimum sizes.
9973
9974 (When we use the X toolkit, we don't do it here.
9975 Instead we copy the values that the widgets are using, below.) */
9976#ifndef USE_X_TOOLKIT
9977 {
9978 int base_width, base_height;
9979 int min_rows = 0, min_cols = 0;
9980
9981 base_width = CHAR_TO_PIXEL_WIDTH (f, 0);
9982 base_height = CHAR_TO_PIXEL_HEIGHT (f, 0);
9983
9984 check_frame_size (f, &min_rows, &min_cols);
9985
9986 /* The window manager uses the base width hints to calculate the
9987 current number of rows and columns in the frame while
9988 resizing; min_width and min_height aren't useful for this
9989 purpose, since they might not give the dimensions for a
9990 zero-row, zero-column frame.
9991
9992 We use the base_width and base_height members if we have
9993 them; otherwise, we set the min_width and min_height members
9994 to the size for a zero x zero frame. */
9995
9996#ifdef HAVE_X11R4
9997 size_hints.flags |= PBaseSize;
9998 size_hints.base_width = base_width;
9999 size_hints.base_height = base_height;
10000 size_hints.min_width = base_width + min_cols * size_hints.width_inc;
10001 size_hints.min_height = base_height + min_rows * size_hints.height_inc;
10002#else
10003 size_hints.min_width = base_width;
10004 size_hints.min_height = base_height;
10005#endif
10006 }
10007
10008 /* If we don't need the old flags, we don't need the old hint at all. */
10009 if (flags)
10010 {
10011 size_hints.flags |= flags;
10012 goto no_read;
10013 }
10014#endif /* not USE_X_TOOLKIT */
10015
10016 {
10017 XSizeHints hints; /* Sometimes I hate X Windows... */
10018 long supplied_return;
10019 int value;
10020
10021#ifdef HAVE_X11R4
10022 value = XGetWMNormalHints (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), window, &hints,
10023 &supplied_return);
10024#else
10025 value = XGetNormalHints (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), window, &hints);
10026#endif
10027
10028#ifdef USE_X_TOOLKIT
10029 size_hints.base_height = hints.base_height;
10030 size_hints.base_width = hints.base_width;
10031 size_hints.min_height = hints.min_height;
10032 size_hints.min_width = hints.min_width;
10033#endif
10034
10035 if (flags)
10036 size_hints.flags |= flags;
10037 else
10038 {
10039 if (value == 0)
10040 hints.flags = 0;
10041 if (hints.flags & PSize)
10042 size_hints.flags |= PSize;
10043 if (hints.flags & PPosition)
10044 size_hints.flags |= PPosition;
10045 if (hints.flags & USPosition)
10046 size_hints.flags |= USPosition;
10047 if (hints.flags & USSize)
10048 size_hints.flags |= USSize;
10049 }
10050 }
10051
10052#ifndef USE_X_TOOLKIT
10053 no_read:
10054#endif
10055
10056#ifdef PWinGravity
10057 size_hints.win_gravity = f->output_data.x->win_gravity;
10058 size_hints.flags |= PWinGravity;
10059
10060 if (user_position)
10061 {
10062 size_hints.flags &= ~ PPosition;
10063 size_hints.flags |= USPosition;
10064 }
10065#endif /* PWinGravity */
10066
10067#ifdef HAVE_X11R4
10068 XSetWMNormalHints (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), window, &size_hints);
10069#else
10070 XSetNormalHints (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), window, &size_hints);
10071#endif
10072#endif /* MACTODO */
10073}
10074
10075#if 0 /* MACTODO: hide application instead of iconify? */
10076/* Used for IconicState or NormalState */
10077
10078void
10079x_wm_set_window_state (f, state)
10080 struct frame *f;
10081 int state;
10082{
10083#ifdef USE_X_TOOLKIT
10084 Arg al[1];
10085
10086 XtSetArg (al[0], XtNinitialState, state);
10087 XtSetValues (f->output_data.x->widget, al, 1);
10088#else /* not USE_X_TOOLKIT */
10089 Window window = FRAME_X_WINDOW (f);
10090
10091 f->output_data.x->wm_hints.flags |= StateHint;
10092 f->output_data.x->wm_hints.initial_state = state;
10093
10094 XSetWMHints (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), window, &f->output_data.x->wm_hints);
10095#endif /* not USE_X_TOOLKIT */
10096}
10097
10098void
10099x_wm_set_icon_pixmap (f, pixmap_id)
10100 struct frame *f;
10101 int pixmap_id;
10102{
10103 Pixmap icon_pixmap;
10104
10105#ifndef USE_X_TOOLKIT
10106 Window window = FRAME_X_WINDOW (f);
10107#endif
10108
10109 if (pixmap_id > 0)
10110 {
10111 icon_pixmap = x_bitmap_pixmap (f, pixmap_id);
10112 f->output_data.x->wm_hints.icon_pixmap = icon_pixmap;
10113 }
10114 else
10115 {
10116 /* It seems there is no way to turn off use of an icon pixmap.
10117 The following line does it, only if no icon has yet been created,
10118 for some window managers. But with mwm it crashes.
10119 Some people say it should clear the IconPixmapHint bit in this case,
10120 but that doesn't work, and the X consortium said it isn't the
10121 right thing at all. Since there is no way to win,
10122 best to explicitly give up. */
10123#if 0
10124 f->output_data.x->wm_hints.icon_pixmap = None;
10125#else
10126 return;
10127#endif
10128 }
10129
10130#ifdef USE_X_TOOLKIT /* same as in x_wm_set_window_state. */
10131
10132 {
10133 Arg al[1];
10134 XtSetArg (al[0], XtNiconPixmap, icon_pixmap);
10135 XtSetValues (f->output_data.x->widget, al, 1);
10136 }
10137
10138#else /* not USE_X_TOOLKIT */
10139
10140 f->output_data.x->wm_hints.flags |= IconPixmapHint;
10141 XSetWMHints (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), window, &f->output_data.x->wm_hints);
10142
10143#endif /* not USE_X_TOOLKIT */
10144}
10145
10146#endif
10147
10148void
10149x_wm_set_icon_position (f, icon_x, icon_y)
10150 struct frame *f;
10151 int icon_x, icon_y;
10152{
10153#if 0 /* MAC_TODO: no icons on Mac */
10154#ifdef USE_X_TOOLKIT
10155 Window window = XtWindow (f->output_data.x->widget);
10156#else
10157 Window window = FRAME_X_WINDOW (f);
10158#endif
10159
10160 f->output_data.x->wm_hints.flags |= IconPositionHint;
10161 f->output_data.x->wm_hints.icon_x = icon_x;
10162 f->output_data.x->wm_hints.icon_y = icon_y;
10163
10164 XSetWMHints (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), window, &f->output_data.x->wm_hints);
10165#endif
10166}
10167
10168\f
10169/***********************************************************************
10170 Fonts
10171 ***********************************************************************/
10172
10173/* Return a pointer to struct font_info of font FONT_IDX of frame F. */
10174
10175struct font_info *
10176x_get_font_info (f, font_idx)
10177 FRAME_PTR f;
10178 int font_idx;
10179{
10180 return (FRAME_MAC_FONT_TABLE (f) + font_idx);
10181}
10182
10183/* the global font name table */
10184char **font_name_table = NULL;
10185int font_name_table_size = 0;
10186int font_name_count = 0;
10187
10188/* compare two strings ignoring case */
10189static int
10190stricmp (const char *s, const char *t)
10191{
10192 for ( ; tolower (*s) == tolower (*t); s++, t++)
10193 if (*s == '\0')
10194 return 0;
10195 return tolower (*s) - tolower (*t);
10196}
10197
10198/* compare two strings ignoring case and handling wildcard */
10199static int
10200wildstrieq (char *s1, char *s2)
10201{
10202 if (strcmp (s1, "*") == 0 || strcmp (s2, "*") == 0)
10203 return true;
10204
10205 return stricmp (s1, s2) == 0;
10206}
10207
10208/* Assume parameter 1 is fully qualified, no wildcards. */
10209static int
10210mac_font_pattern_match (fontname, pattern)
10211 char * fontname;
10212 char * pattern;
10213{
10214 char *regex = (char *) alloca (strlen (pattern) * 2);
10215 char *font_name_copy = (char *) alloca (strlen (fontname) + 1);
10216 char *ptr;
10217
10218 /* Copy fontname so we can modify it during comparison. */
10219 strcpy (font_name_copy, fontname);
10220
10221 ptr = regex;
10222 *ptr++ = '^';
10223
10224 /* Turn pattern into a regexp and do a regexp match. */
10225 for (; *pattern; pattern++)
10226 {
10227 if (*pattern == '?')
10228 *ptr++ = '.';
10229 else if (*pattern == '*')
10230 {
10231 *ptr++ = '.';
10232 *ptr++ = '*';
10233 }
10234 else
10235 *ptr++ = *pattern;
10236 }
10237 *ptr = '$';
10238 *(ptr + 1) = '\0';
10239
10240 return (fast_c_string_match_ignore_case (build_string (regex),
10241 font_name_copy) >= 0);
10242}
10243
10244/* Two font specs are considered to match if their foundry, family,
10245 weight, slant, and charset match. */
10246static int
10247mac_font_match (char *mf, char *xf)
10248{
10249 char m_foundry[50], m_family[50], m_weight[20], m_slant[2], m_charset[20];
10250 char x_foundry[50], x_family[50], x_weight[20], x_slant[2], x_charset[20];
10251
10252 if (sscanf (mf, "-%49[^-]-%49[^-]-%19[^-]-%1[^-]-%*[^-]--%*[^-]-%*[^-]-%*[^-]-%*[^-]-%*c-%*[^-]-%19s",
10253 m_foundry, m_family, m_weight, m_slant, m_charset) != 5)
10254 return mac_font_pattern_match (mf, xf);
10255
10256 if (sscanf (xf, "-%49[^-]-%49[^-]-%19[^-]-%1[^-]-%*[^-]-%*[^-]-%*[^-]-%*[^-]-%*[^-]-%*[^-]-%*c-%*[^-]-%19s",
10257 x_foundry, x_family, x_weight, x_slant, x_charset) != 5)
10258 return mac_font_pattern_match (mf, xf);
10259
10260 return (wildstrieq (m_foundry, x_foundry)
10261 && wildstrieq (m_family, x_family)
10262 && wildstrieq (m_weight, x_weight)
10263 && wildstrieq (m_slant, x_slant)
10264 && wildstrieq (m_charset, x_charset))
10265 || mac_font_pattern_match (mf, xf);
10266}
10267
10268
10269static char *
10270mac_to_x_fontname (char *name, int size, Style style, short scriptcode)
10271{
10272 char foundry[32], family[32], cs[32];
10273 char xf[255], *result, *p;
10274
10275 if (sscanf (name, "%31[^-]-%31[^-]-%31s", foundry, family, cs) != 3)
10276 {
10277 strcpy(foundry, "Apple");
10278 strcpy(family, name);
10279
10280 switch (scriptcode)
10281 {
10282 case smTradChinese:
10283 strcpy(cs, "big5-0");
10284 break;
10285 case smSimpChinese:
10286 strcpy(cs, "gb2312-0");
10287 break;
10288 case smJapanese:
10289 strcpy(cs, "jisx0208.1983-sjis");
10290 break;
10291 case smKorean:
10292 strcpy(cs, "ksc5601-0");
10293 break;
10294 default:
10295 strcpy(cs, "mac-roman");
10296 break;
10297 }
10298 }
10299
10300 sprintf(xf, "-%s-%s-%s-%c-normal--%d-%d-75-75-m-%d-%s",
10301 foundry, family, style & bold ? "bold" : "medium",
10302 style & italic ? 'i' : 'r', size, size * 10, size * 10, cs);
10303
10304 result = (char *) xmalloc (strlen (xf) + 1);
10305 strcpy (result, xf);
10306 for (p = result; *p; p++)
10307 *p = tolower(*p);
10308 return result;
10309}
10310
10311
10312/* Convert an X font spec to the corresponding mac font name, which
10313 can then be passed to GetFNum after conversion to a Pascal string.
10314 For ordinary Mac fonts, this should just be their names, like
10315 "monaco", "Taipei", etc. Fonts converted from the GNU intlfonts
10316 collection contain their charset designation in their names, like
10317 "ETL-Fixed-iso8859-1", "ETL-Fixed-koi8-r", etc. Both types of font
10318 names are handled accordingly. */
10319static void
10320x_font_name_to_mac_font_name (char *xf, char *mf)
10321{
10322 char foundry[32], family[32], weight[20], slant[2], cs[32];
10323
10324 strcpy (mf, "");
10325
10326 if (sscanf (xf, "-%31[^-]-%31[^-]-%19[^-]-%1[^-]-%*[^-]-%*[^-]-%*[^-]-%*[^-]-%*[^-]-%*[^-]-%*c-%*[^-]-%31s",
10327 foundry, family, weight, slant, cs) != 5 &&
10328 sscanf (xf, "-%31[^-]-%31[^-]-%19[^-]-%1[^-]-%*[^-]--%*[^-]-%*[^-]-%*[^-]-%*[^-]-%*c-%*[^-]-%31s",
10329 foundry, family, weight, slant, cs) != 5)
10330 return;
10331
10332 if (strcmp (cs, "big5-0") == 0 || strcmp (cs, "gb2312-0") == 0
10333 || strcmp (cs, "jisx0208.1983-sjis") == 0
10334 || strcmp (cs, "ksc5601-0") == 0 || strcmp (cs, "mac-roman") == 0)
10335 strcpy(mf, family);
10336 else
10337 sprintf(mf, "%s-%s-%s", foundry, family, cs);
10338}
10339
10340
10341/* Sets up the table font_name_table to contain the list of all
10342 monospace fonts in the system the first time the table is used so
10343 that the Resource Manager need not be accessed every time this
10344 information is needed. */
10345
10346static void
10347init_font_name_table ()
10348{
10349 GrafPtr port;
10350 SInt16 fontnum, old_fontnum;
10351 int num_mac_fonts = CountResources('FOND');
10352 int i, j;
10353 Handle font_handle, font_handle_2;
10354 short id, scriptcode;
10355 ResType type;
10356 Str32 name;
10357 struct FontAssoc *fat;
10358 struct AsscEntry *assc_entry;
10359
10360 GetPort (&port); /* save the current font number used */
10361 old_fontnum = port->txFont;
10362
10363 for (i = 1; i <= num_mac_fonts; i++) /* loop to get all available fonts */
10364 {
10365 font_handle = GetIndResource ('FOND', i);
10366 if (!font_handle)
10367 continue;
10368
10369 GetResInfo (font_handle, &id, &type, name);
10370 GetFNum (name, &fontnum);
10371 p2cstr (name);
10372 if (fontnum == 0)
10373 continue;
10374
10375 TextFont (fontnum);
10376 scriptcode = FontToScript (fontnum);
10377 do
10378 {
10379 HLock (font_handle);
10380
10381 if (GetResourceSizeOnDisk (font_handle) >= sizeof (struct FamRec))
10382 {
10383 fat = (struct FontAssoc *) (*font_handle
10384 + sizeof (struct FamRec));
10385 assc_entry = (struct AsscEntry *) (*font_handle
10386 + sizeof (struct FamRec)
10387 + sizeof (struct FontAssoc));
10388
10389 for (j = 0; j <= fat->numAssoc; j++, assc_entry++)
10390 {
10391 if (font_name_table_size == 0)
10392 {
10393 font_name_table_size = 16;
10394 font_name_table = (char **)
10395 xmalloc (font_name_table_size * sizeof (char *));
10396 }
10397 else if (font_name_count >= font_name_table_size)
10398 {
10399 font_name_table_size += 16;
10400 font_name_table = (char **)
10401 xrealloc (font_name_table,
10402 font_name_table_size * sizeof (char *));
10403 }
10404 font_name_table[font_name_count++]
10405 = mac_to_x_fontname (name,
10406 assc_entry->fontSize,
10407 assc_entry->fontStyle,
10408 scriptcode);
10409 }
10410 }
10411
10412 HUnlock (font_handle);
10413 font_handle_2 = GetNextFOND (font_handle);
10414 ReleaseResource (font_handle);
10415 font_handle = font_handle_2;
10416 }
10417 while (ResError () == noErr && font_handle);
10418 }
10419
10420 TextFont (old_fontnum);
10421}
10422
10423
10424/* Return a list of at most MAXNAMES font specs matching the one in
10425 PATTERN. Note that each '*' in the PATTERN matches exactly one
10426 field of the font spec, unlike X in which an '*' in a font spec can
10427 match a number of fields. The result is in the Mac implementation
10428 all fonts must be specified by a font spec with all 13 fields
10429 (although many of these can be "*'s"). */
10430
10431Lisp_Object
10432x_list_fonts (struct frame *f,
10433 Lisp_Object pattern,
10434 int size,
10435 int maxnames)
10436{
10437 char *ptnstr;
10438 Lisp_Object newlist = Qnil;
10439 int n_fonts = 0;
10440 int i;
10441
10442 if (font_name_table == NULL) /* Initialize when first used. */
10443 init_font_name_table ();
10444
10445 ptnstr = XSTRING (pattern)->data;
10446
10447 /* Scan and matching bitmap fonts. */
10448 for (i = 0; i < font_name_count; i++)
10449 {
10450 if (mac_font_pattern_match (font_name_table[i], ptnstr))
10451 {
10452 newlist = Fcons (build_string (font_name_table[i]), newlist);
10453
10454 n_fonts++;
10455 if (n_fonts >= maxnames)
10456 break;
10457 }
10458 }
10459
10460 /* MAC_TODO: add code for matching outline fonts here */
10461
10462 return newlist;
10463}
10464
10465
10466#if GLYPH_DEBUG
10467
10468/* Check that FONT is valid on frame F. It is if it can be found in
10469 F's font table. */
10470
10471static void
10472x_check_font (f, font)
10473 struct frame *f;
10474 XFontStruct *font;
10475{
10476 int i;
10477 struct x_display_info *dpyinfo = FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f);
10478
10479 xassert (font != NULL);
10480
10481 for (i = 0; i < dpyinfo->n_fonts; i++)
10482 if (dpyinfo->font_table[i].name
10483 && font == dpyinfo->font_table[i].font)
10484 break;
10485
10486 xassert (i < dpyinfo->n_fonts);
10487}
10488
10489#endif /* GLYPH_DEBUG != 0 */
10490
10491
10492/* Set *W to the minimum width, *H to the minimum font height of FONT.
10493 Note: There are (broken) X fonts out there with invalid XFontStruct
10494 min_bounds contents. For example, handa@etl.go.jp reports that
10495 "-adobe-courier-medium-r-normal--*-180-*-*-m-*-iso8859-1" fonts
10496 have font->min_bounds.width == 0. */
10497
10498static INLINE void
10499x_font_min_bounds (font, w, h)
10500 MacFontStruct *font;
10501 int *w, *h;
10502{
10503 *h = FONT_HEIGHT (font);
10504 *w = font->min_bounds.width;
10505
10506 /* Try to handle the case where FONT->min_bounds has invalid
10507 contents. Since the only font known to have invalid min_bounds
10508 is fixed-width, use max_bounds if min_bounds seems to be invalid. */
10509 if (*w <= 0)
10510 *w = font->max_bounds.width;
10511}
10512
10513
10514/* Compute the smallest character width and smallest font height over
10515 all fonts available on frame F. Set the members smallest_char_width
10516 and smallest_font_height in F's x_display_info structure to
10517 the values computed. Value is non-zero if smallest_font_height or
10518 smallest_char_width become smaller than they were before. */
10519
10520static int
10521x_compute_min_glyph_bounds (f)
10522 struct frame *f;
10523{
10524 int i;
10525 struct mac_display_info *dpyinfo = FRAME_MAC_DISPLAY_INFO (f);
10526 MacFontStruct *font;
10527 int old_width = dpyinfo->smallest_char_width;
10528 int old_height = dpyinfo->smallest_font_height;
10529
10530 dpyinfo->smallest_font_height = 100000;
10531 dpyinfo->smallest_char_width = 100000;
10532
10533 for (i = 0; i < dpyinfo->n_fonts; ++i)
10534 if (dpyinfo->font_table[i].name)
10535 {
10536 struct font_info *fontp = dpyinfo->font_table + i;
10537 int w, h;
10538
10539 font = (MacFontStruct *) fontp->font;
10540 xassert (font != (MacFontStruct *) ~0);
10541 x_font_min_bounds (font, &w, &h);
10542
10543 dpyinfo->smallest_font_height = min (dpyinfo->smallest_font_height, h);
10544 dpyinfo->smallest_char_width = min (dpyinfo->smallest_char_width, w);
10545 }
10546
10547 xassert (dpyinfo->smallest_char_width > 0
10548 && dpyinfo->smallest_font_height > 0);
10549
10550 return (dpyinfo->n_fonts == 1
10551 || dpyinfo->smallest_char_width < old_width
10552 || dpyinfo->smallest_font_height < old_height);
10553}
10554
10555
10556/* Determine whether given string is a fully-specified XLFD: all 14
10557 fields are present, none is '*'. */
10558
10559static int
10560is_fully_specified_xlfd (char *p)
10561{
10562 int i;
10563 char *q;
10564
10565 if (*p != '-')
10566 return 0;
10567
10568 for (i = 0; i < 13; i++)
10569 {
10570 q = strchr (p + 1, '-');
10571 if (q == NULL)
10572 return 0;
10573 if (q - p == 2 && *(p + 1) == '*')
10574 return 0;
10575 p = q;
10576 }
10577
10578 if (strchr (p + 1, '-') != NULL)
10579 return 0;
10580
10581 if (*(p + 1) == '*' && *(p + 2) == '\0')
10582 return 0;
10583
10584 return 1;
10585}
10586
10587
10588const int kDefaultFontSize = 9;
10589
10590
10591/* MacLoadQueryFont creates and returns an internal representation for
10592 a font in a MacFontStruct struct (similar in function to
10593 XLoadQueryFont in X). There is really no concept corresponding to
10594 "loading" a font on the Mac. But we check its existence and find
10595 the font number and all other information for it and store them in
10596 the returned MacFontStruct. */
10597
10598static MacFontStruct *
10599XLoadQueryFont (Display *dpy, char *fontname)
10600{
10601 int i, size, is_two_byte_font, char_width;
10602 char *name;
10603 GrafPtr port;
10604 SInt16 old_fontnum, old_fontsize;
10605 Style old_fontface;
10606 Str32 mfontname;
10607 SInt16 fontnum;
10608 Style fontface = normal;
10609 MacFontStruct *font;
10610 FontInfo the_fontinfo;
10611 char s_weight[7], c_slant;
10612
10613 if (is_fully_specified_xlfd (fontname))
10614 name = fontname;
10615 else
10616 {
10617 for (i = 0; i < font_name_count; i++)
10618 if (mac_font_pattern_match (font_name_table[i], fontname))
10619 break;
10620
10621 if (i >= font_name_count)
10622 return NULL;
10623
10624 name = font_name_table[i];
10625 }
10626
10627 GetPort (&port); /* save the current font number used */
10628 old_fontnum = port->txFont;
10629 old_fontsize = port->txSize;
10630 old_fontface = port->txFace;
10631
10632 if (sscanf (name, "-%*[^-]-%*[^-]-%*[^-]-%*c-%*[^-]--%d-%*[^-]-%*[^-]-%*[^-]-%*c-%*[^-]-%*s", &size) != 1)
10633 size = kDefaultFontSize;
10634
10635 if (sscanf (name, "-%*[^-]-%*[^-]-%6[^-]-%*c-%*[^-]--%*[^-]-%*[^-]-%*[^-]-%*[^-]-%*c-%*[^-]-%*s", s_weight) == 1)
10636 if (strcmp (s_weight, "bold") == 0)
10637 fontface |= bold;
10638
10639 if (sscanf (name, "-%*[^-]-%*[^-]-%*[^-]-%c-%*[^-]--%*[^-]-%*[^-]-%*[^-]-%*[^-]-%*c-%*[^-]-%*s", &c_slant) == 1)
10640 if (c_slant == 'i')
10641 fontface |= italic;
10642
10643 x_font_name_to_mac_font_name (name, mfontname);
10644 c2pstr (mfontname);
10645 GetFNum (mfontname, &fontnum);
10646 if (fontnum == 0)
10647 return NULL;
10648
10649 font = (MacFontStruct *) xmalloc (sizeof (struct MacFontStruct));
10650
10651 font->fontname = (char *) xmalloc (strlen (name) + 1);
10652 bcopy (name, font->fontname, strlen (name) + 1);
10653
10654 font->mac_fontnum = fontnum;
10655 font->mac_fontsize = size;
10656 font->mac_fontface = fontface;
10657 font->mac_scriptcode = FontToScript (fontnum);
10658
10659 is_two_byte_font = font->mac_scriptcode == smJapanese ||
10660 font->mac_scriptcode == smTradChinese ||
10661 font->mac_scriptcode == smSimpChinese ||
10662 font->mac_scriptcode == smKorean;
10663
10664 TextFont (fontnum);
10665 TextSize (size);
10666 TextFace (fontface);
10667
10668 GetFontInfo (&the_fontinfo);
10669
10670 font->ascent = the_fontinfo.ascent;
10671 font->descent = the_fontinfo.descent;
10672
10673 font->min_byte1 = 0;
10674 if (is_two_byte_font)
10675 font->max_byte1 = 1;
10676 else
10677 font->max_byte1 = 0;
10678 font->min_char_or_byte2 = 0x20;
10679 font->max_char_or_byte2 = 0xff;
10680
10681 if (is_two_byte_font)
10682 {
10683 /* Use the width of an "ideographic space" of that font because
10684 the_fontinfo.widMax returns the wrong width for some fonts. */
10685 switch (font->mac_scriptcode)
10686 {
10687 case smJapanese:
10688 char_width = StringWidth("\p\x81\x40");
10689 break;
10690 case smTradChinese:
10691 char_width = StringWidth("\p\xa1\x40");
10692 break;
10693 case smSimpChinese:
10694 char_width = StringWidth("\p\xa1\xa1");
10695 break;
10696 case smKorean:
10697 char_width = StringWidth("\p\xa1\xa1");
10698 break;
10699 }
10700 }
10701 else
10702 /* Do this instead of use the_fontinfo.widMax, which incorrectly
10703 returns 15 for 12-point Monaco! */
10704 char_width = CharWidth ('m');
10705
10706 font->max_bounds.rbearing = char_width;
10707 font->max_bounds.lbearing = 0;
10708 font->max_bounds.width = char_width;
10709 font->max_bounds.ascent = the_fontinfo.ascent;
10710 font->max_bounds.descent = the_fontinfo.descent;
10711
10712 font->min_bounds = font->max_bounds;
10713
10714 if (is_two_byte_font || CharWidth ('m') == CharWidth ('i'))
10715 font->per_char = NULL;
10716 else
10717 {
10718 font->per_char = (XCharStruct *)
10719 xmalloc (sizeof (XCharStruct) * (0xff - 0x20 + 1));
10720 {
10721 int c;
10722
10723 for (c = 0x20; c <= 0xff; c++)
10724 {
10725 font->per_char[c - 0x20] = font->max_bounds;
10726 font->per_char[c - 0x20].width = CharWidth (c);
10727 }
10728 }
10729 }
10730
10731 TextFont (old_fontnum); /* restore previous font number, size and face */
10732 TextSize (old_fontsize);
10733 TextFace (old_fontface);
10734
10735 return font;
10736}
10737
10738
10739/* Load font named FONTNAME of the size SIZE for frame F, and return a
10740 pointer to the structure font_info while allocating it dynamically.
10741 If SIZE is 0, load any size of font.
10742 If loading is failed, return NULL. */
10743
10744struct font_info *
10745x_load_font (f, fontname, size)
10746 struct frame *f;
10747 register char *fontname;
10748 int size;
10749{
10750 struct mac_display_info *dpyinfo = FRAME_MAC_DISPLAY_INFO (f);
10751 Lisp_Object font_names;
10752
10753 /* Get a list of all the fonts that match this name. Once we
10754 have a list of matching fonts, we compare them against the fonts
10755 we already have by comparing names. */
10756 font_names = x_list_fonts (f, build_string (fontname), size, 1);
10757
10758 if (!NILP (font_names))
10759 {
10760 Lisp_Object tail;
10761 int i;
10762
10763 for (i = 0; i < dpyinfo->n_fonts; i++)
10764 for (tail = font_names; CONSP (tail); tail = XCDR (tail))
10765 if (dpyinfo->font_table[i].name
10766 && (!strcmp (dpyinfo->font_table[i].name,
10767 XSTRING (XCAR (tail))->data)
10768 || !strcmp (dpyinfo->font_table[i].full_name,
10769 XSTRING (XCAR (tail))->data)))
10770 return (dpyinfo->font_table + i);
10771 }
10772
10773 /* Load the font and add it to the table. */
10774 {
10775 char *full_name;
10776 struct MacFontStruct *font;
10777 struct font_info *fontp;
10778 unsigned long value;
10779 int i;
10780
10781 /* If we have found fonts by x_list_font, load one of them. If
10782 not, we still try to load a font by the name given as FONTNAME
10783 because XListFonts (called in x_list_font) of some X server has
10784 a bug of not finding a font even if the font surely exists and
10785 is loadable by XLoadQueryFont. */
10786 if (size > 0 && !NILP (font_names))
10787 fontname = (char *) XSTRING (XCAR (font_names))->data;
10788
10789 font = (MacFontStruct *) XLoadQueryFont (FRAME_MAC_DISPLAY (f), fontname);
10790 if (!font)
10791 return NULL;
10792
10793 /* Find a free slot in the font table. */
10794 for (i = 0; i < dpyinfo->n_fonts; ++i)
10795 if (dpyinfo->font_table[i].name == NULL)
10796 break;
10797
10798 /* If no free slot found, maybe enlarge the font table. */
10799 if (i == dpyinfo->n_fonts
10800 && dpyinfo->n_fonts == dpyinfo->font_table_size)
10801 {
10802 int sz;
10803 dpyinfo->font_table_size = max (16, 2 * dpyinfo->font_table_size);
10804 sz = dpyinfo->font_table_size * sizeof *dpyinfo->font_table;
10805 dpyinfo->font_table
10806 = (struct font_info *) xrealloc (dpyinfo->font_table, sz);
10807 }
10808
10809 fontp = dpyinfo->font_table + i;
10810 if (i == dpyinfo->n_fonts)
10811 ++dpyinfo->n_fonts;
10812
10813 /* Now fill in the slots of *FONTP. */
10814 BLOCK_INPUT;
10815 fontp->font = font;
10816 fontp->font_idx = i;
10817 fontp->name = (char *) xmalloc (strlen (font->fontname) + 1);
10818 bcopy (font->fontname, fontp->name, strlen (font->fontname) + 1);
10819
10820 fontp->full_name = fontp->name;
10821
10822 fontp->size = font->max_bounds.width;
10823 fontp->height = FONT_HEIGHT (font);
10824 {
10825 /* For some font, ascent and descent in max_bounds field is
10826 larger than the above value. */
10827 int max_height = font->max_bounds.ascent + font->max_bounds.descent;
10828 if (max_height > fontp->height)
10829 fontp->height = max_height;
10830 }
10831
10832 /* The slot `encoding' specifies how to map a character
10833 code-points (0x20..0x7F or 0x2020..0x7F7F) of each charset to
10834 the font code-points (0:0x20..0x7F, 1:0xA0..0xFF), or
10835 (0:0x2020..0x7F7F, 1:0xA0A0..0xFFFF, 3:0x20A0..0x7FFF,
10836 2:0xA020..0xFF7F). For the moment, we don't know which charset
10837 uses this font. So, we set information in fontp->encoding[1]
10838 which is never used by any charset. If mapping can't be
10839 decided, set FONT_ENCODING_NOT_DECIDED. */
10840 if (font->mac_scriptcode == smJapanese)
10841 fontp->encoding[1] = 4;
10842 else
10843 {
10844 fontp->encoding[1]
10845 = (font->max_byte1 == 0
10846 /* 1-byte font */
10847 ? (font->min_char_or_byte2 < 0x80
10848 ? (font->max_char_or_byte2 < 0x80
10849 ? 0 /* 0x20..0x7F */
10850 : FONT_ENCODING_NOT_DECIDED) /* 0x20..0xFF */
10851 : 1) /* 0xA0..0xFF */
10852 /* 2-byte font */
10853 : (font->min_byte1 < 0x80
10854 ? (font->max_byte1 < 0x80
10855 ? (font->min_char_or_byte2 < 0x80
10856 ? (font->max_char_or_byte2 < 0x80
10857 ? 0 /* 0x2020..0x7F7F */
10858 : FONT_ENCODING_NOT_DECIDED) /* 0x2020..0x7FFF */
10859 : 3) /* 0x20A0..0x7FFF */
10860 : FONT_ENCODING_NOT_DECIDED) /* 0x20??..0xA0?? */
10861 : (font->min_char_or_byte2 < 0x80
10862 ? (font->max_char_or_byte2 < 0x80
10863 ? 2 /* 0xA020..0xFF7F */
10864 : FONT_ENCODING_NOT_DECIDED) /* 0xA020..0xFFFF */
10865 : 1))); /* 0xA0A0..0xFFFF */
10866 }
10867
10868#if 0 /* MAC_TODO: fill these out with more reasonably values */
10869 fontp->baseline_offset
10870 = (XGetFontProperty (font, dpyinfo->Xatom_MULE_BASELINE_OFFSET, &value)
10871 ? (long) value : 0);
10872 fontp->relative_compose
10873 = (XGetFontProperty (font, dpyinfo->Xatom_MULE_RELATIVE_COMPOSE, &value)
10874 ? (long) value : 0);
10875 fontp->default_ascent
10876 = (XGetFontProperty (font, dpyinfo->Xatom_MULE_DEFAULT_ASCENT, &value)
10877 ? (long) value : 0);
10878#else
10879 fontp->baseline_offset = 0;
10880 fontp->relative_compose = 0;
10881 fontp->default_ascent = 0;
10882#endif
10883
10884 /* Set global flag fonts_changed_p to non-zero if the font loaded
10885 has a character with a smaller width than any other character
10886 before, or if the font loaded has a smalle>r height than any
10887 other font loaded before. If this happens, it will make a
10888 glyph matrix reallocation necessary. */
10889 fonts_changed_p = x_compute_min_glyph_bounds (f);
10890 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
10891 return fontp;
10892 }
10893}
10894
10895
10896/* Return a pointer to struct font_info of a font named FONTNAME for
10897 frame F. If no such font is loaded, return NULL. */
10898
10899struct font_info *
10900x_query_font (f, fontname)
10901 struct frame *f;
10902 register char *fontname;
10903{
10904 struct mac_display_info *dpyinfo = FRAME_MAC_DISPLAY_INFO (f);
10905 int i;
10906
10907 for (i = 0; i < dpyinfo->n_fonts; i++)
10908 if (dpyinfo->font_table[i].name
10909 && (!strcmp (dpyinfo->font_table[i].name, fontname)
10910 || !strcmp (dpyinfo->font_table[i].full_name, fontname)))
10911 return (dpyinfo->font_table + i);
10912 return NULL;
10913}
10914
10915
10916/* Find a CCL program for a font specified by FONTP, and set the member
10917 `encoder' of the structure. */
10918
10919void
10920x_find_ccl_program (fontp)
10921 struct font_info *fontp;
10922{
10923 Lisp_Object list, elt;
10924
10925 for (list = Vfont_ccl_encoder_alist; CONSP (list); list = XCDR (list))
10926 {
10927 elt = XCAR (list);
10928 if (CONSP (elt)
10929 && STRINGP (XCAR (elt))
10930 && (fast_c_string_match_ignore_case (XCAR (elt), fontp->name)
10931 >= 0))
10932 break;
10933 }
10934 if (! NILP (list))
10935 {
10936 struct ccl_program *ccl
10937 = (struct ccl_program *) xmalloc (sizeof (struct ccl_program));
10938
10939 if (setup_ccl_program (ccl, XCDR (elt)) < 0)
10940 xfree (ccl);
10941 else
10942 fontp->font_encoder = ccl;
10943 }
10944}
10945
10946
10947\f
10948/***********************************************************************
10949 Initialization
10950 ***********************************************************************/
10951
10952#ifdef USE_X_TOOLKIT
10953static XrmOptionDescRec emacs_options[] = {
10954 {"-geometry", ".geometry", XrmoptionSepArg, NULL},
10955 {"-iconic", ".iconic", XrmoptionNoArg, (XtPointer) "yes"},
10956
10957 {"-internal-border-width", "*EmacsScreen.internalBorderWidth",
10958 XrmoptionSepArg, NULL},
10959 {"-ib", "*EmacsScreen.internalBorderWidth", XrmoptionSepArg, NULL},
10960
10961 {"-T", "*EmacsShell.title", XrmoptionSepArg, (XtPointer) NULL},
10962 {"-wn", "*EmacsShell.title", XrmoptionSepArg, (XtPointer) NULL},
10963 {"-title", "*EmacsShell.title", XrmoptionSepArg, (XtPointer) NULL},
10964 {"-iconname", "*EmacsShell.iconName", XrmoptionSepArg, (XtPointer) NULL},
10965 {"-in", "*EmacsShell.iconName", XrmoptionSepArg, (XtPointer) NULL},
10966 {"-mc", "*pointerColor", XrmoptionSepArg, (XtPointer) NULL},
10967 {"-cr", "*cursorColor", XrmoptionSepArg, (XtPointer) NULL}
10968};
10969#endif /* USE_X_TOOLKIT */
10970
10971static int x_initialized;
10972
10973#ifdef MULTI_KBOARD
10974/* Test whether two display-name strings agree up to the dot that separates
10975 the screen number from the server number. */
10976static int
10977same_x_server (name1, name2)
10978 char *name1, *name2;
10979{
10980 int seen_colon = 0;
10981 unsigned char *system_name = XSTRING (Vsystem_name)->data;
10982 int system_name_length = strlen (system_name);
10983 int length_until_period = 0;
10984
10985 while (system_name[length_until_period] != 0
10986 && system_name[length_until_period] != '.')
10987 length_until_period++;
10988
10989 /* Treat `unix' like an empty host name. */
10990 if (! strncmp (name1, "unix:", 5))
10991 name1 += 4;
10992 if (! strncmp (name2, "unix:", 5))
10993 name2 += 4;
10994 /* Treat this host's name like an empty host name. */
10995 if (! strncmp (name1, system_name, system_name_length)
10996 && name1[system_name_length] == ':')
10997 name1 += system_name_length;
10998 if (! strncmp (name2, system_name, system_name_length)
10999 && name2[system_name_length] == ':')
11000 name2 += system_name_length;
11001 /* Treat this host's domainless name like an empty host name. */
11002 if (! strncmp (name1, system_name, length_until_period)
11003 && name1[length_until_period] == ':')
11004 name1 += length_until_period;
11005 if (! strncmp (name2, system_name, length_until_period)
11006 && name2[length_until_period] == ':')
11007 name2 += length_until_period;
11008
11009 for (; *name1 != '\0' && *name1 == *name2; name1++, name2++)
11010 {
11011 if (*name1 == ':')
11012 seen_colon++;
11013 if (seen_colon && *name1 == '.')
11014 return 1;
11015 }
11016 return (seen_colon
11017 && (*name1 == '.' || *name1 == '\0')
11018 && (*name2 == '.' || *name2 == '\0'));
11019}
11020#endif
11021
11022struct mac_display_info *
11023x_term_init (display_name, xrm_option, resource_name)
11024 Lisp_Object display_name;
11025 char *xrm_option;
11026 char *resource_name;
11027{
11028 if (!x_initialized)
11029 {
11030 x_initialize ();
11031 x_initialized = 1;
11032 }
11033
11034 return &one_mac_display_info;
11035}
11036\f
11037/* Set up use of X before we make the first connection. */
11038
11039static struct redisplay_interface x_redisplay_interface =
11040{
11041 x_produce_glyphs,
11042 x_write_glyphs,
11043 x_insert_glyphs,
11044 x_clear_end_of_line,
11045 x_scroll_run,
11046 x_after_update_window_line,
11047 x_update_window_begin,
11048 x_update_window_end,
11049 XTcursor_to,
11050 x_flush,
11051 x_clear_mouse_face,
11052 x_get_glyph_overhangs,
11053 x_fix_overlapping_area
11054};
11055
11056
11057/* The Mac Event loop code */
11058
11059#include <Events.h>
11060#include <Quickdraw.h>
11061#include <Balloons.h>
11062#include <Devices.h>
11063#include <Fonts.h>
11064#include <Gestalt.h>
11065#include <Menus.h>
11066#include <Processes.h>
11067#include <Sound.h>
11068#include <ToolUtils.h>
11069#include <TextUtils.h>
11070#include <Dialogs.h>
11071#include <Script.h>
11072#include <Scrap.h>
11073#include <Types.h>
11074#include <TextEncodingConverter.h>
11075#include <Resources.h>
11076
11077#if __MWERKS__
11078#include <unix.h>
11079#endif
11080
11081#define M_APPLE 128
11082#define I_ABOUT 1
11083
11084#define WINDOW_RESOURCE 128
11085#define TERM_WINDOW_RESOURCE 129
11086
11087#define DEFAULT_NUM_COLS 80
11088
11089#define MIN_DOC_SIZE 64
11090#define MAX_DOC_SIZE 32767
11091
11092/* sleep time for WaitNextEvent */
11093#define WNE_SLEEP_AT_SUSPEND 10
11094#define WNE_SLEEP_AT_RESUME 1
11095
11096/* true when cannot handle any Mac OS events */
11097static int handling_window_update = 0;
11098
11099/* the flag appl_is_suspended is used both for determining the sleep
11100 time to be passed to WaitNextEvent and whether the cursor should be
11101 drawn when updating the display. The cursor is turned off when
11102 Emacs is suspended. Redrawing it is unnecessary and what needs to
11103 be done depends on whether the cursor lies inside or outside the
11104 redraw region. So we might as well skip drawing it when Emacs is
11105 suspended. */
11106static Boolean app_is_suspended = false;
11107static long app_sleep_time = WNE_SLEEP_AT_RESUME;
11108
11109#define EXTRA_STACK_ALLOC (256 * 1024)
11110
11111#define ARGV_STRING_LIST_ID 129
11112#define ABOUT_ALERT_ID 128
11113
11114Boolean terminate_flag = false;
11115
11116/* true if using command key as meta key */
11117Lisp_Object Vmac_command_key_is_meta;
11118
11119/* convert input from Mac keyboard (assumed to be in Mac Roman coding)
11120 to this text encoding */
11121int mac_keyboard_text_encoding;
11122int current_mac_keyboard_text_encoding = kTextEncodingMacRoman;
11123
11124/* Set in term/mac-win.el to indicate that event loop can now generate
11125 drag and drop events. */
11126Lisp_Object Vmac_ready_for_drag_n_drop;
11127
11128Lisp_Object drag_and_drop_file_list;
11129
11130Point saved_menu_event_location;
11131
11132/* Apple Events */
11133static void init_required_apple_events(void);
11134static pascal OSErr do_ae_open_application(const AppleEvent *, AppleEvent *, long);
11135static pascal OSErr do_ae_print_documents(const AppleEvent *, AppleEvent *, long);
11136static pascal OSErr do_ae_open_documents(AppleEvent *, AppleEvent *, long);
11137static pascal OSErr do_ae_quit_application(AppleEvent *, AppleEvent *, long);
11138
11139extern void init_emacs_passwd_dir ();
11140extern int emacs_main (int, char **, char **);
11141extern void check_alarm ();
11142
11143extern void initialize_applescript();
11144extern void terminate_applescript();
11145
11146
11147static void
11148do_get_menus (void)
11149{
11150 Handle menubar_handle;
11151 MenuHandle menu_handle;
11152
11153 menubar_handle = GetNewMBar (128);
11154 if(menubar_handle == NULL)
11155 abort ();
11156 SetMenuBar (menubar_handle);
11157 DrawMenuBar ();
11158
11159 menu_handle = GetMenuHandle (M_APPLE);
11160 if(menu_handle != NULL)
11161 AppendResMenu (menu_handle,'DRVR');
11162 else
11163 abort ();
11164}
11165
11166
11167static void
11168do_init_managers (void)
11169{
11170 InitGraf (&qd.thePort);
11171 InitFonts ();
11172 FlushEvents (everyEvent, 0);
11173 InitWindows ();
11174 InitMenus ();
11175 TEInit ();
11176 InitDialogs (NULL);
11177 InitCursor ();
11178
11179 /* set up some extra stack space for use by emacs */
11180 SetApplLimit ((Ptr) ((long) GetApplLimit () - EXTRA_STACK_ALLOC));
11181
11182 /* MaxApplZone must be called for AppleScript to execute more
11183 complicated scripts */
11184 MaxApplZone ();
11185 MoreMasters ();
11186}
11187
11188
11189static void
11190do_window_update (WindowPtr win)
11191{
11192 struct mac_output *mwp = (mac_output *) GetWRefCon (win);
11193 struct frame *f = mwp->mFP;
11194
11195 if (f)
11196 {
11197 if (f->async_visible == 0)
11198 {
11199 f->async_visible = 1;
11200 f->async_iconified = 0;
11201 SET_FRAME_GARBAGED (f);
11202
11203 /* An update event is equivalent to MapNotify on X, so report
11204 visibility changes properly. */
11205 if (! NILP(Vframe_list) && ! NILP (XCDR (Vframe_list)))
11206 /* Force a redisplay sooner or later to update the
11207 frame titles in case this is the second frame. */
11208 record_asynch_buffer_change ();
11209 }
11210 else
11211 {
11212 BeginUpdate (win);
11213 handling_window_update = 1;
11214
11215 expose_frame (f, 0, 0, 0, 0);
11216
11217 handling_window_update = 0;
11218 EndUpdate (win);
11219 }
11220 }
11221}
11222
11223static void
11224do_window_activate (WindowPtr win)
11225{
11226 mac_output *mwp = (mac_output *) GetWRefCon (win);
11227 struct frame *f = mwp->mFP;
11228
11229 if (f)
11230 {
11231 x_new_focus_frame (FRAME_MAC_DISPLAY_INFO (f), f);
11232 activate_scroll_bars (f);
11233 }
11234}
11235
11236static void
11237do_window_deactivate (WindowPtr win)
11238{
11239 mac_output *mwp = (mac_output *) GetWRefCon (win);
11240 struct frame *f = mwp->mFP;
11241
11242 if (f == FRAME_MAC_DISPLAY_INFO (f)->x_focus_frame)
11243 {
11244 x_new_focus_frame (FRAME_MAC_DISPLAY_INFO (f), 0);
11245 deactivate_scroll_bars (f);
11246 }
11247}
11248
11249static void
11250do_app_resume ()
11251{
11252 mac_output *mwp = (mac_output *) GetWRefCon (FrontWindow ());
11253 struct frame *f = mwp->mFP;
11254
11255 if (f)
11256 {
11257 x_new_focus_frame (FRAME_MAC_DISPLAY_INFO (f), f);
11258 activate_scroll_bars (f);
11259 }
11260
11261 app_is_suspended = false;
11262 app_sleep_time = WNE_SLEEP_AT_RESUME;
11263}
11264
11265static void
11266do_app_suspend ()
11267{
11268 mac_output *mwp = (mac_output *) GetWRefCon (FrontWindow ());
11269 struct frame *f = mwp->mFP;
11270
11271 if (f == FRAME_MAC_DISPLAY_INFO (f)->x_focus_frame)
11272 {
11273 x_new_focus_frame (FRAME_MAC_DISPLAY_INFO (f), 0);
11274 deactivate_scroll_bars (f);
11275 }
11276
11277 app_is_suspended = true;
11278 app_sleep_time = WNE_SLEEP_AT_SUSPEND;
11279}
11280
11281
11282static void
11283do_mouse_moved (Point mouse_pos)
11284{
11285 WindowPtr wp = FrontWindow ();
11286 struct frame *f = ((mac_output *) GetWRefCon (wp))->mFP;
11287
11288 SetPort (wp);
11289 GlobalToLocal (&mouse_pos);
11290
11291 note_mouse_movement (f, &mouse_pos);
11292}
11293
11294
11295static void
11296do_os_event (EventRecord *erp)
11297{
11298 switch((erp->message >> 24) & 0x000000FF)
11299 {
11300 case suspendResumeMessage:
11301 if((erp->message & resumeFlag) == 1)
11302 do_app_resume ();
11303 else
11304 do_app_suspend ();
11305 break;
11306
11307 case mouseMovedMessage:
11308 do_mouse_moved (erp->where);
11309 break;
11310 }
11311}
11312
11313static void
11314do_events (EventRecord *erp)
11315{
11316 switch (erp->what)
11317 {
11318 case updateEvt:
11319 do_window_update ((WindowPtr) erp->message);
11320 break;
11321
11322 case osEvt:
11323 do_os_event (erp);
11324 break;
11325
11326 case activateEvt:
11327 if ((erp->modifiers & activeFlag) != 0)
11328 do_window_activate ((WindowPtr) erp->message);
11329 else
11330 do_window_deactivate ((WindowPtr) erp->message);
11331 break;
11332 }
11333}
11334
11335static void
11336do_apple_menu (SInt16 menu_item)
11337{
11338 Str255 item_name;
11339 SInt16 da_driver_refnum;
11340
11341 if (menu_item == I_ABOUT)
11342 NoteAlert (ABOUT_ALERT_ID, NULL);
11343 else
11344 {
11345 GetMenuItemText (GetMenuHandle (M_APPLE), menu_item, item_name);
11346 da_driver_refnum = OpenDeskAcc (item_name);
11347 }
11348}
11349
11350void
11351do_menu_choice (SInt32 menu_choice)
11352{
11353 SInt16 menu_id, menu_item;
11354
11355 menu_id = HiWord (menu_choice);
11356 menu_item = LoWord (menu_choice);
11357
11358 if (menu_id == 0)
11359 return;
11360
11361 switch (menu_id)
11362 {
11363 case M_APPLE:
11364 do_apple_menu (menu_item);
11365 break;
11366
11367 default:
11368 {
11369 WindowPtr wp = FrontWindow ();
11370 struct frame *f = ((mac_output *) GetWRefCon (wp))->mFP;
11371 MenuHandle menu = GetMenuHandle (menu_id);
11372 if (menu)
11373 {
11374 UInt32 refcon;
11375
11376 GetMenuItemRefCon (menu, menu_item, &refcon);
11377 menubar_selection_callback (f, refcon);
11378 }
11379 }
11380 }
11381
11382 HiliteMenu (0);
11383}
11384
11385
11386/* Handle drags in size box. Based on code contributed by Ben
11387 Mesander and IM - Window Manager A. */
11388
11389static void
11390do_grow_window (WindowPtr w, EventRecord *e)
11391{
11392 long grow_size;
11393 Rect limit_rect;
11394 int rows, columns;
11395 mac_output *mwp = (mac_output *) GetWRefCon (w);
11396 struct frame *f = mwp->mFP;
11397
11398 SetRect(&limit_rect, MIN_DOC_SIZE, MIN_DOC_SIZE, MAX_DOC_SIZE, MAX_DOC_SIZE);
11399
11400 grow_size = GrowWindow (w, e->where, &limit_rect);
11401
11402 /* see if it really changed size */
11403 if (grow_size != 0)
11404 {
11405 rows = PIXEL_TO_CHAR_HEIGHT (f, HiWord (grow_size));
11406 columns = PIXEL_TO_CHAR_WIDTH (f, LoWord (grow_size));
11407
11408 x_set_window_size (f, 0, columns, rows);
11409 }
11410}
11411
11412
11413/* Handle clicks in zoom box. Calculation of "standard state" based
11414 on code in IM - Window Manager A and code contributed by Ben
11415 Mesander. The standard state of an Emacs window is 80-characters
11416 wide (DEFAULT_NUM_COLS) and as tall as will fit on the screen. */
11417
11418static void
11419do_zoom_window (WindowPtr w, int zoom_in_or_out)
11420{
11421 GrafPtr save_port;
11422 Rect zoom_rect, port_rect;
11423 Point top_left;
11424 int w_title_height, columns, rows, width, height, dummy, x, y;
11425 mac_output *mwp = (mac_output *) GetWRefCon (w);
11426 struct frame *f = mwp->mFP;
11427
11428 GetPort (&save_port);
11429 SetPort (w);
11430 EraseRect (&(w->portRect)); /* erase to avoid flicker */
11431 if (zoom_in_or_out == inZoomOut)
11432 {
11433 SetPt(&top_left, w->portRect.left, w->portRect.top);
11434 LocalToGlobal (&top_left);
11435
11436 /* calculate height of window's title bar */
11437 w_title_height = top_left.v - 1
11438 - (**((WindowPeek) w)->strucRgn).rgnBBox.top + GetMBarHeight();
11439
11440 /* get maximum height of window into zoom_rect.bottom - zoom_rect.top */
11441 zoom_rect = qd.screenBits.bounds;
11442 zoom_rect.top += w_title_height;
11443 InsetRect (&zoom_rect, 8, 4); /* not too tight */
11444
11445 zoom_rect.right = zoom_rect.left
11446 + CHAR_TO_PIXEL_WIDTH (f, DEFAULT_NUM_COLS);
11447
11448 (**((WStateDataHandle) ((WindowPeek) w)->dataHandle)).stdState = zoom_rect;
11449 }
11450
11451 ZoomWindow (w, zoom_in_or_out, w == FrontWindow());
11452
11453 /* retrieve window size and update application values */
11454 port_rect = w->portRect;
11455 rows = PIXEL_TO_CHAR_HEIGHT (f, port_rect.bottom - port_rect.top);
11456 columns = PIXEL_TO_CHAR_WIDTH (f, port_rect.right - port_rect.left);
11457 x_set_window_size (mwp->mFP, 0, columns, rows);
11458
11459 SetPort (save_port);
11460}
11461
11462
11463/* Intialize AppleEvent dispatcher table for the required events. */
11464void
11465init_required_apple_events ()
11466{
11467 OSErr err;
11468 long result;
11469
11470 /* Make sure we have apple events before starting. */
11471 err = Gestalt (gestaltAppleEventsAttr, &result);
11472 if (err != noErr)
11473 abort ();
11474
11475 if (!(result & (1 << gestaltAppleEventsPresent)))
11476 abort ();
11477
11478 err = AEInstallEventHandler(kCoreEventClass, kAEOpenApplication,
11479 NewAEEventHandlerProc ((AEEventHandlerProcPtr) do_ae_open_application),
11480 0L, false);
11481 if (err != noErr)
11482 abort ();
11483
11484 err = AEInstallEventHandler(kCoreEventClass, kAEOpenDocuments,
11485 NewAEEventHandlerProc ((AEEventHandlerProcPtr) do_ae_open_documents),
11486 0L, false);
11487 if (err != noErr)
11488 abort ();
11489
11490 err = AEInstallEventHandler(kCoreEventClass, kAEPrintDocuments,
11491 NewAEEventHandlerProc ((AEEventHandlerProcPtr) do_ae_print_documents),
11492 0L, false);
11493 if (err != noErr)
11494 abort ();
11495
11496 err = AEInstallEventHandler(kCoreEventClass, kAEQuitApplication,
11497 NewAEEventHandlerProc ((AEEventHandlerProcPtr) do_ae_quit_application),
11498 0L, false);
11499 if (err != noErr)
11500 abort ();
11501}
11502
11503
11504/* Open Application Apple Event */
11505static pascal OSErr
11506do_ae_open_application(const AppleEvent *pae, AppleEvent *preply, long prefcon)
11507{
11508 return noErr;
11509}
11510
11511
11512/* Defined in mac.c. */
11513extern int
11514path_from_vol_dir_name (char *, int, short, long, char *);
11515
11516
11517/* Called when we receive an AppleEvent with an ID of
11518 "kAEOpenDocuments". This routine gets the direct parameter,
11519 extracts the FSSpecs in it, and puts their names on a list. */
11520static pascal OSErr
11521do_ae_open_documents(AppleEvent *message, AppleEvent *reply, long refcon)
11522{
11523 OSErr err, err2;
11524 AEDesc the_desc;
11525 AEKeyword keyword;
11526 DescType actual_type;
11527 Size actual_size;
11528
11529 err = AEGetParamDesc (message, keyDirectObject, typeAEList, &the_desc);
11530 if (err != noErr)
11531 goto descriptor_error_exit;
11532
11533 /* Check to see that we got all of the required parameters from the
11534 event descriptor. For an 'odoc' event this should just be the
11535 file list. */
11536 err = AEGetAttributePtr(message, keyMissedKeywordAttr, typeWildCard,
11537 &actual_type, (Ptr) &keyword,
11538 sizeof (keyword), &actual_size);
11539 /* No error means that we found some unused parameters.
11540 errAEDescNotFound means that there are no more parameters. If we
11541 get an error code other than that, flag it. */
11542 if ((err == noErr) || (err != errAEDescNotFound))
11543 {
11544 err = errAEEventNotHandled;
11545 goto error_exit;
11546 }
11547 err = noErr;
11548
11549 /* Got all the parameters we need. Now, go through the direct
11550 object list and parse it up. */
11551 {
11552 long num_files_to_open;
11553
11554 err = AECountItems (&the_desc, &num_files_to_open);
11555 if (err == noErr)
11556 {
11557 int i;
11558
11559 /* AE file list is one based so just use that for indexing here. */
11560 for (i = 1; (err == noErr) && (i <= num_files_to_open); i++) {
11561 FSSpec fs;
11562 Str255 path_name, unix_path_name;
11563
11564 err = AEGetNthPtr(&the_desc, i, typeFSS, &keyword, &actual_type,
11565 (Ptr) &fs, sizeof (fs), &actual_size);
11566 if (err != noErr) break;
11567
11568 if (path_from_vol_dir_name (path_name, 255, fs.vRefNum, fs.parID,
11569 fs.name) &&
11570 mac_to_unix_pathname (path_name, unix_path_name, 255))
11571 drag_and_drop_file_list = Fcons (build_string (unix_path_name),
11572 drag_and_drop_file_list);
11573 }
11574 }
11575 }
11576
11577error_exit:
11578 /* Nuke the coerced file list in any case */
11579 err2 = AEDisposeDesc(&the_desc);
11580
11581descriptor_error_exit:
11582 /* InvalRect(&(gFrontMacWindowP->mWP->portRect)); */
11583 return err;
11584}
11585
11586
11587/* Print Document Apple Event */
11588static pascal OSErr
11589do_ae_print_documents (const AppleEvent *pAE, AppleEvent *reply, long refcon)
11590{
11591 return errAEEventNotHandled;
11592}
11593
11594
11595static pascal OSErr
11596do_ae_quit_application (AppleEvent* message, AppleEvent *reply, long refcon)
11597{
11598 /* FixMe: Do we need an unwind-protect or something here? And what
11599 do we do about unsaved files. Currently just forces quit rather
11600 than doing recursive callback to get user input. */
11601
11602 terminate_flag = true;
11603
11604 /* Fkill_emacs doesn't return. We have to return. (TI) */
11605 return noErr;
11606}
11607
11608
11609#if __profile__
11610void
11611profiler_exit_proc ()
11612{
11613 ProfilerDump ("\pEmacs.prof");
11614 ProfilerTerm ();
11615}
11616#endif
11617
11618/* These few functions implement Emacs as a normal Mac application
11619 (almost): set up the the heap and the Toolbox, handle necessary
11620 system events plus a few simple menu events. They also set up
11621 Emacs's access to functions defined in the rest of this file.
11622 Emacs uses function hooks to perform all its terminal I/O. A
11623 complete list of these functions appear in termhooks.h. For what
11624 they do, read the comments there and see also w32term.c and
11625 xterm.c. What's noticeably missing here is the event loop, which
11626 is normally present in most Mac application. After performing the
11627 necessary Mac initializations, main passes off control to
11628 emacs_main (corresponding to main in emacs.c). Emacs_main calls
11629 mac_read_socket (defined further below) to read input. This is
11630 where WaitNextEvent is called to process Mac events. This is also
11631 where check_alarm in sysdep.c is called to simulate alarm signals.
11632 This makes the cursor jump back to its correct position after
11633 briefly jumping to that of the matching parenthesis, print useful
11634 hints and prompts in the minibuffer after the user stops typing for
11635 a wait, etc. */
11636
11637#undef main
11638int
11639main (void)
11640{
11641#if __profile__ /* is the profiler on? */
11642 if (ProfilerInit(collectDetailed, bestTimeBase, 5000, 200))
11643 exit(1);
11644#endif
11645
11646#if __MWERKS__
11647 /* set creator and type for files created by MSL */
11648 _fcreator = 'EMAx';
11649 _ftype = 'TEXT';
11650#endif
11651
11652 do_init_managers ();
11653
11654 do_get_menus ();
11655
11656 init_emacs_passwd_dir ();
11657
11658 init_environ ();
11659
11660 initialize_applescript ();
11661
11662 init_required_apple_events ();
11663
11664 {
11665 char **argv;
11666 int argc = 0;
11667
11668 /* set up argv array from STR# resource */
11669 get_string_list (&argv, ARGV_STRING_LIST_ID);
11670 while (argv[argc])
11671 argc++;
11672
11673 /* free up AppleScript resources on exit */
11674 atexit (terminate_applescript);
11675
11676#if __profile__ /* is the profiler on? */
11677 atexit (profiler_exit_proc);
11678#endif
11679
11680 /* 3rd param "envp" never used in emacs_main */
11681 (void) emacs_main (argc, argv, 0);
11682 }
11683
11684 /* Never reached - real exit in Fkill_emacs */
11685 return 0;
11686}
11687
11688
11689/* Table for translating Mac keycode to X keysym values. Contributed
11690 by Sudhir Shenoy. */
11691static unsigned char keycode_to_xkeysym_table[] = {
11692/* 0x00 - 0x3f */
11693 0, 0, 0, 0, 0, 0, 0, 0, 0, 0, 0, 0, 0, 0, 0, 0,
11694 0, 0, 0, 0, 0, 0, 0, 0, 0, 0, 0, 0, 0, 0, 0, 0,
11695 0, 0, 0, 0, 0, 0, 0, 0, 0, 0, 0, 0, 0, 0, 0, 0,
11696 0, 0, 0, 0, 0, 0, 0, 0, 0, 0, 0, 0, 0, 0, 0, 0,
11697/* 0x40 */
11698 0, '\xae' /* kp. */, 0, '\xaa' /* kp* */,
11699 0, '\xab' /* kp+ */, 0, '\x7f' /* kp_clr */,
11700 0, 0, 0, '\xaf' /* kp/ */,
11701 '\x8d' /* kp_ent */, 0, '\xad' /* kp- */, 0,
11702/* 0x50 */
11703 0, '\xbd' /* kp= */, '\xb0' /* kp0 */, '\xb1' /* kp1 */,
11704 '\xb2' /* kp2 */, '\xb3' /* kp3 */, '\xb4' /* kp4 */, '\xb5' /* kp5 */,
11705 '\xb6' /* kp6 */, '\xb7' /* kp7 */, 0, '\xb8' /* kp8 */,
11706 '\xb9' /* kp9 */, 0, 0, 0,
11707/* 0x60 */
11708 '\xc2' /* F5 */, '\xc3' /* F6 */, '\xc4' /* F7 */, '\xc0' /* F3 */,
11709 '\xc5' /* F8 */, '\xc6' /* F9 */, 0, '\xc8' /* F11 */,
11710 0, '\xca' /* F13 */, 0, '\xcb' /* F14 */,
11711 0, '\xc7' /* F10 */, 0, '\xc9' /* F12 */,
11712/* 0x70 */
11713 0, '\xcc' /* F15 */, '\x9e' /* ins */, '\x95' /* home */,
11714 '\x9a' /* pgup */, '\x9f' /* del */, '\xc1' /* F4 */, '\x9c' /* end */,
11715 '\xbf' /* F2 */, '\x9b' /* pgdown */, '\xbe' /* F1 */, '\x51' /* left */,
11716 '\x53' /* right */, '\x54' /* down */, '\x52' /* up */, 0
11717};
11718
11719static int
11720keycode_to_xkeysym (int keyCode, int *xKeySym)
11721{
11722 *xKeySym = keycode_to_xkeysym_table [keyCode & 0x7f];
11723 return *xKeySym != 0;
11724}
11725
11726/* Emacs calls this whenever it wants to read an input event from the
11727 user. */
11728int
11729XTread_socket (int sd, struct input_event *bufp, int numchars, int expected)
11730{
11731 int count = 0;
11732 EventRecord er;
11733 int the_modifiers;
11734 EventMask event_mask;
11735
11736 if (interrupt_input_blocked)
11737 {
11738 interrupt_input_pending = 1;
11739 return -1;
11740 }
11741
11742 interrupt_input_pending = 0;
11743 BLOCK_INPUT;
11744
11745 /* So people can tell when we have read the available input. */
11746 input_signal_count++;
11747
11748 if (numchars <= 0)
11749 abort ();
11750
11751 /* Don't poll for events to process (specifically updateEvt) if
11752 window update currently already in progress. A call to redisplay
11753 (in do_window_update) can be preempted by another call to
11754 redisplay, causing blank regions to be left on the screen and the
11755 cursor to be left at strange places. */
11756 if (handling_window_update)
11757 {
11758 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
11759 return 0;
11760 }
11761
11762 if (terminate_flag)
11763 Fkill_emacs (make_number (1));
11764
11765 /* It is necessary to set this (additional) argument slot of an
11766 event to nil because keyboard.c protects incompletely processed
11767 event from being garbage collected by placing them in the
11768 kbd_buffer_gcpro vector. */
11769 bufp->arg = Qnil;
11770
11771 event_mask = everyEvent;
11772 if (NILP (Vmac_ready_for_drag_n_drop))
11773 event_mask -= highLevelEventMask;
11774
11775 if (WaitNextEvent (event_mask, &er, (expected ? app_sleep_time : 0L), NULL))
11776 switch (er.what)
11777 {
11778 case mouseDown:
11779 case mouseUp:
11780 {
11781 WindowPtr window_ptr = FrontWindow ();
11782 SInt16 part_code;
11783
11784 if (mouse_tracking_in_progress == mouse_tracking_scroll_bar
11785 && er.what == mouseUp)
11786 {
11787 struct mac_output *mwp = (mac_output *) GetWRefCon (window_ptr);
11788 Point mouse_loc = er.where;
11789
11790 /* Convert to local coordinates of new window. */
11791 SetPort (window_ptr);
11792 GlobalToLocal (&mouse_loc);
11793
11794 bufp->code = 0; /* only one mouse button */
11795 bufp->kind = scroll_bar_click;
11796 bufp->frame_or_window = tracked_scroll_bar->window;
11797 bufp->part = scroll_bar_handle;
11798 bufp->modifiers = up_modifier;
11799 bufp->timestamp = er.when * (1000 / 60);
11800 /* ticks to milliseconds */
11801
11802 XSETINT (bufp->x, tracked_scroll_bar->left + 2);
11803 XSETINT (bufp->y, mouse_loc.v - 24);
11804 tracked_scroll_bar->dragging = Qnil;
11805 mouse_tracking_in_progress = mouse_tracking_none;
11806 tracked_scroll_bar = NULL;
11807 count++;
11808 break;
11809 }
11810
11811 part_code = FindWindow (er.where, &window_ptr);
11812
11813 switch (part_code)
11814 {
11815 case inMenuBar:
11816 {
11817 struct frame *f = ((mac_output *)
11818 GetWRefCon (FrontWindow ()))->mFP;
11819 saved_menu_event_location = er.where;
11820 bufp->kind = menu_bar_activate_event;
11821 XSETFRAME (bufp->frame_or_window, f);
11822 count++;
11823 }
11824 break;
11825
11826 case inContent:
11827 if (window_ptr != FrontWindow ())
11828 SelectWindow (window_ptr);
11829 else
11830 {
11831 int control_part_code;
11832 ControlHandle ch;
11833 struct mac_output *mwp = (mac_output *)
11834 GetWRefCon (window_ptr);
11835 Point mouse_loc = er.where;
11836
11837 /* convert to local coordinates of new window */
11838 SetPort (window_ptr);
11839 GlobalToLocal (&mouse_loc);
11840 control_part_code = FindControl (mouse_loc, window_ptr, &ch);
11841
11842 bufp->code = 0; /* only one mouse button */
11843 XSETINT (bufp->x, mouse_loc.h);
11844 XSETINT (bufp->y, mouse_loc.v);
11845 bufp->timestamp = er.when * (1000 / 60);
11846 /* ticks to milliseconds */
11847
11848 if (control_part_code != 0)
11849 {
11850 struct scroll_bar *bar = (struct scroll_bar *)
11851 GetControlReference (ch);
11852 x_scroll_bar_handle_click (bar, control_part_code, &er,
11853 bufp);
11854 if (er.what == mouseDown
11855 && control_part_code == kControlIndicatorPart)
11856 {
11857 mouse_tracking_in_progress = mouse_tracking_scroll_bar;
11858 tracked_scroll_bar = bar;
11859 }
11860 else
11861 {
11862 mouse_tracking_in_progress = mouse_tracking_none;
11863 tracked_scroll_bar = NULL;
11864 }
11865 }
11866 else
11867 {
11868 bufp->kind = mouse_click;
11869 XSETFRAME (bufp->frame_or_window, mwp->mFP);
11870 if (er.what == mouseDown)
11871 mouse_tracking_in_progress = mouse_tracking_mouse_movement;
11872 else
11873 mouse_tracking_in_progress = mouse_tracking_none;
11874 }
11875
11876 switch (er.what)
11877 {
11878 case mouseDown:
11879 bufp->modifiers = down_modifier;
11880 break;
11881 case mouseUp:
11882 bufp->modifiers = up_modifier;
11883 break;
11884 }
11885
11886 count++;
11887 }
11888 break;
11889
11890 case inDrag:
11891 DragWindow (window_ptr, er.where, &qd.screenBits.bounds);
11892 break;
11893
11894 case inGoAway:
11895 if (TrackGoAway (window_ptr, er.where))
11896 {
11897 bufp->kind = delete_window_event;
11898 XSETFRAME (bufp->frame_or_window,
11899 ((mac_output *) GetWRefCon (window_ptr))->mFP);
11900 count++;
11901 }
11902 break;
11903
11904 /* window resize handling added --ben */
11905 case inGrow:
11906 do_grow_window(window_ptr, &er);
11907 break;
11908
11909 /* window zoom handling added --ben */
11910 case inZoomIn:
11911 case inZoomOut:
11912 if (TrackBox (window_ptr, er.where, part_code))
11913 do_zoom_window (window_ptr, part_code);
11914 break;
11915
11916 default:
11917 break;
11918 }
11919 }
11920 break;
11921
11922 case updateEvt:
11923 case osEvt:
11924 case activateEvt:
11925 do_events (&er);
11926 break;
11927
11928 case keyDown:
11929 case autoKey:
11930 {
11931 int keycode = (er.message & keyCodeMask) >> 8;
11932 int xkeysym;
11933
11934 ObscureCursor ();
11935
11936 if (keycode == 0x33) /* delete key (charCode translated to 0x8) */
11937 {
11938 bufp->code = 0x7f;
11939 bufp->kind = ascii_keystroke;
11940 }
11941 else if (keycode_to_xkeysym (keycode, &xkeysym))
11942 {
11943 bufp->code = 0xff00 | xkeysym;
11944 bufp->kind = non_ascii_keystroke;
11945 }
11946 else
11947 {
11948 if (er.modifiers
11949 & (NILP (Vmac_command_key_is_meta) ? optionKey : cmdKey))
11950 {
11951 /* This code comes from Keyboard Resource, Appendix
11952 C of IM - Text. This is necessary since shift is
11953 ignored in KCHR table translation when option or
11954 command is pressed. */
11955 int new_modifiers = er.modifiers & 0xf600;
11956 /* mask off option and command */
11957 int new_keycode = keycode | new_modifiers;
11958 Ptr kchr_ptr = (Ptr) GetScriptManagerVariable (smKCHRCache);
11959 unsigned long some_state = 0;
11960 bufp->code = KeyTranslate (kchr_ptr, new_keycode,
11961 &some_state) & 0xff;
11962 }
11963 else
11964 bufp->code = er.message & charCodeMask;
11965 bufp->kind = ascii_keystroke;
11966 }
11967 }
11968
11969 /* If variable mac-convert-keyboard-input-to-latin-1 is non-nil,
11970 convert non-ASCII characters typed at the Mac keyboard
11971 (presumed to be in the Mac Roman encoding) to iso-latin-1
11972 encoding before they are passed to Emacs. This enables the
11973 Mac keyboard to be used to enter non-ASCII iso-latin-1
11974 characters directly. */
11975 if (mac_keyboard_text_encoding != kTextEncodingMacRoman
11976 && bufp->kind == ascii_keystroke && bufp->code >= 128)
11977 {
11978 static TECObjectRef converter = NULL;
11979 OSStatus the_err = noErr;
11980 OSStatus convert_status = noErr;
11981
11982 if (converter == NULL)
11983 {
11984 the_err = TECCreateConverter (&converter,
11985 kTextEncodingMacRoman,
11986 mac_keyboard_text_encoding);
11987 current_mac_keyboard_text_encoding = mac_keyboard_text_encoding;
11988 }
11989 else if (mac_keyboard_text_encoding != current_mac_keyboard_text_encoding)
11990 {
11991 /* Free the converter for the current encoding before
11992 creating a new one. */
11993 TECDisposeConverter (converter);
11994 the_err = TECCreateConverter (&converter,
11995 kTextEncodingMacRoman,
11996 mac_keyboard_text_encoding);
11997 current_mac_keyboard_text_encoding = mac_keyboard_text_encoding;
11998 }
11999
12000 if (the_err == noErr)
12001 {
12002 unsigned char ch = bufp->code;
12003 ByteCount actual_input_length, actual_output_length;
12004 unsigned char outch;
12005
12006 convert_status = TECConvertText (converter, &ch, 1,
12007 &actual_input_length,
12008 &outch, 1,
12009 &actual_output_length);
12010 if (convert_status == noErr
12011 && actual_input_length == 1
12012 && actual_output_length == 1)
12013 bufp->code = outch;
12014 }
12015 }
12016
12017 the_modifiers = 0;
12018 if (er.modifiers & shiftKey)
12019 the_modifiers |= shift_modifier;
12020 if (er.modifiers & controlKey)
12021 the_modifiers |= ctrl_modifier;
12022 /* use option or command key as meta depending on value of
12023 mac-command-key-is-meta */
12024 if (er.modifiers
12025 & (NILP (Vmac_command_key_is_meta) ? optionKey : cmdKey))
12026 the_modifiers |= meta_modifier;
12027 bufp->modifiers = the_modifiers;
12028
12029 {
12030 mac_output *mwp = (mac_output *) GetWRefCon (FrontWindow ());
12031 XSETFRAME (bufp->frame_or_window, mwp->mFP);
12032 }
12033
12034 bufp->timestamp = er.when * (1000 / 60); /* ticks to milliseconds */
12035
12036 count++;
12037 break;
12038
12039 case kHighLevelEvent:
12040 drag_and_drop_file_list = Qnil;
12041
12042 AEProcessAppleEvent(&er);
12043
12044 /* Build a drag_n_drop type event as is done in
12045 constuct_drag_n_drop in w32term.c. */
12046 if (!NILP (drag_and_drop_file_list))
12047 {
12048 struct frame *f;
12049 WindowPtr wp;
12050 Lisp_Object frame;
12051
12052 wp = FrontWindow ();
12053 if (!wp)
12054 f = NULL;
12055 else
12056 f = ((mac_output *) GetWRefCon (wp))->mFP;
12057
12058 bufp->kind = drag_n_drop;
12059 bufp->code = 0;
12060 bufp->timestamp = er.when * (1000 / 60);
12061 /* ticks to milliseconds */
12062 bufp->modifiers = 0;
12063
12064 XSETINT (bufp->x, 0);
12065 XSETINT (bufp->y, 0);
12066
12067 XSETFRAME (frame, f);
12068 bufp->frame_or_window = Fcons (frame, drag_and_drop_file_list);
12069
12070 /* Regardless of whether Emacs was suspended or in the
12071 foreground, ask it to redraw its entire screen.
12072 Otherwise parts of the screen can be left in an
12073 inconsistent state. */
12074 if (wp)
12075 InvalRect (&(wp->portRect));
12076
12077 count++;
12078 }
12079
12080 default:
12081 break;
12082 }
12083
12084 /* If the focus was just given to an autoraising frame,
12085 raise it now. */
12086 /* ??? This ought to be able to handle more than one such frame. */
12087 if (pending_autoraise_frame)
12088 {
12089 x_raise_frame (pending_autoraise_frame);
12090 pending_autoraise_frame = 0;
12091 }
12092
12093 check_alarm (); /* simulate the handling of a SIGALRM */
12094
12095 {
12096 static Point old_mouse_pos = { -1, -1 };
12097
12098 if (app_is_suspended)
12099 {
12100 old_mouse_pos.h = -1;
12101 old_mouse_pos.v = -1;
12102 }
12103 else
12104 {
12105 Point mouse_pos;
12106 WindowPtr wp = FrontWindow ();
12107 struct frame *f = ((mac_output *) GetWRefCon (wp))->mFP;
12108 Lisp_Object bar;
12109 struct scroll_bar *sb;
12110
12111 SetPort (wp);
12112 GetMouse (&mouse_pos);
12113
12114 if (!EqualPt (mouse_pos, old_mouse_pos))
12115 {
12116 if (mouse_tracking_in_progress == mouse_tracking_scroll_bar
12117 && tracked_scroll_bar)
12118 x_scroll_bar_note_movement (tracked_scroll_bar,
12119 mouse_pos.v
12120 - XINT (tracked_scroll_bar->top),
12121 TickCount() * (1000 / 60));
12122 else
12123 note_mouse_movement (f, &mouse_pos);
12124
12125 old_mouse_pos = mouse_pos;
12126 }
12127 }
12128 }
12129
12130 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
12131
12132 return count;
12133}
12134
12135
12136/* Need to override CodeWarrior's input function so no conversion is
12137 done on newlines Otherwise compiled functions in .elc files will be
12138 read incorrectly. Defined in ...:MSL C:MSL
12139 Common:Source:buffer_io.c. */
12140#ifdef __MWERKS__
12141void
12142__convert_to_newlines (unsigned char * p, size_t * n)
12143{
12144#pragma unused(p,n)
12145}
12146
12147void
12148__convert_from_newlines (unsigned char * p, size_t * n)
12149{
12150#pragma unused(p,n)
12151}
12152#endif
12153
12154
12155/* Initialize the struct pointed to by MW to represent a new COLS x
12156 ROWS Macintosh window, using font with name FONTNAME and size
12157 FONTSIZE. */
12158void
12159NewMacWindow (FRAME_PTR fp)
12160{
12161 mac_output *mwp;
12162 static int making_terminal_window = 1;
12163
12164 mwp = fp->output_data.mac;
12165
12166 if (making_terminal_window)
12167 {
12168 if (!(mwp->mWP = GetNewCWindow (TERM_WINDOW_RESOURCE, NULL,
12169 (WindowPtr) -1)))
12170 abort ();
12171 making_terminal_window = 0;
12172 }
12173 else
12174 if (!(mwp->mWP = GetNewCWindow (WINDOW_RESOURCE, NULL, (WindowPtr) -1)))
12175 abort ();
12176
12177
12178 SetWRefCon (mwp->mWP, (long) mwp);
12179 /* so that update events can find this mac_output struct */
12180 mwp->mFP = fp; /* point back to emacs frame */
12181
12182 SetPort (mwp->mWP);
12183
12184 mwp->fontset = -1;
12185
12186 SizeWindow (mwp->mWP, mwp->pixel_width, mwp->pixel_height, false);
12187 ShowWindow (mwp->mWP);
12188
12189}
12190
12191
12192void make_mac_frame (struct frame *f)
12193{
12194 FRAME_CAN_HAVE_SCROLL_BARS (f) = 1;
12195 FRAME_VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_TYPE (f) = vertical_scroll_bar_right;
12196
12197 NewMacWindow(f);
12198 f->output_data.mac->background_pixel = 0xffffff;
12199 f->output_data.mac->foreground_pixel = 0;
12200
12201 f->output_data.mac->cursor_pixel = 0;
12202 f->output_data.mac->border_pixel = 0x00ff00;
12203 f->output_data.mac->mouse_pixel = 0xff00ff;
12204 f->output_data.mac->cursor_foreground_pixel = 0x0000ff;
12205
12206 f->output_data.mac->desired_cursor = FILLED_BOX_CURSOR;
12207
12208 f->output_data.mac->fontset = -1;
12209 f->output_data.mac->scroll_bar_foreground_pixel = -1;
12210 f->output_data.mac->scroll_bar_background_pixel = -1;
12211 f->output_data.mac->left_pos = 4;
12212 f->output_data.mac->top_pos = 4;
12213 f->output_data.mac->border_width = 0;
12214 f->output_data.mac->explicit_parent = 0;
12215
12216 f->output_data.mac->internal_border_width = 0;
12217
12218 f->output_method = output_mac;
12219
12220 f->auto_raise = 1;
12221 f->auto_lower = 1;
12222
12223 f->new_width = 0;
12224 f->new_height = 0;
12225}
12226
12227void make_mac_terminal_frame (struct frame *f)
12228{
12229 Lisp_Object frame;
12230
12231 XSETFRAME (frame, f);
12232
12233 f->output_method = output_mac;
12234 f->output_data.mac = (struct mac_output *)
12235 xmalloc (sizeof (struct mac_output));
12236 bzero (f->output_data.mac, sizeof (struct mac_output));
12237 f->output_data.mac->fontset = -1;
12238 f->output_data.mac->scroll_bar_foreground_pixel = -1;
12239 f->output_data.mac->scroll_bar_background_pixel = -1;
12240
12241 XSETFRAME (FRAME_KBOARD (f)->Vdefault_minibuffer_frame, f);
12242
12243 f->width = 96;
12244 f->height = 4;
12245
12246 make_mac_frame (f);
12247
12248 Fmodify_frame_parameters (frame,
12249 Fcons (Fcons (Qfont,
12250 build_string ("-*-monaco-medium-r-*--*-90-*-*-*-*-mac-roman")), Qnil));
12251 Fmodify_frame_parameters (frame,
12252 Fcons (Fcons (Qforeground_color,
12253 build_string ("black")), Qnil));
12254 Fmodify_frame_parameters (frame,
12255 Fcons (Fcons (Qbackground_color,
12256 build_string ("white")), Qnil));
12257}
12258
12259void
12260mac_initialize_display_info ()
12261{
12262 struct mac_display_info *dpyinfo = &one_mac_display_info;
12263 GDHandle main_device_handle;
12264
12265 bzero (dpyinfo, sizeof (*dpyinfo));
12266
12267 /* Put it on x_display_name_list. */
12268 x_display_name_list = Fcons (Fcons (build_string ("Mac"), Qnil),
12269 x_display_name_list);
12270 dpyinfo->name_list_element = XCAR (x_display_name_list);
12271
12272 main_device_handle = LMGetMainDevice();
12273
12274 dpyinfo->reference_count = 0;
12275 dpyinfo->resx = 75.0;
12276 dpyinfo->resy = 75.0;
12277 dpyinfo->n_planes = 1;
12278 dpyinfo->n_cbits = 16;
12279 dpyinfo->height = (**main_device_handle).gdRect.bottom;
12280 dpyinfo->width = (**main_device_handle).gdRect.right;
12281 dpyinfo->grabbed = 0;
12282 dpyinfo->root_window = NULL;
12283
12284 dpyinfo->mouse_face_beg_row = dpyinfo->mouse_face_beg_col = -1;
12285 dpyinfo->mouse_face_end_row = dpyinfo->mouse_face_end_col = -1;
12286 dpyinfo->mouse_face_face_id = DEFAULT_FACE_ID;
12287 dpyinfo->mouse_face_window = Qnil;
12288
12289}
12290
12291void
12292x_initialize ()
12293{
12294 rif = &x_redisplay_interface;
12295
12296 clear_frame_hook = x_clear_frame;
12297 ins_del_lines_hook = x_ins_del_lines;
12298 change_line_highlight_hook = x_change_line_highlight;
12299 delete_glyphs_hook = x_delete_glyphs;
12300 ring_bell_hook = XTring_bell;
12301 reset_terminal_modes_hook = XTreset_terminal_modes;
12302 set_terminal_modes_hook = XTset_terminal_modes;
12303 update_begin_hook = x_update_begin;
12304 update_end_hook = x_update_end;
12305 set_terminal_window_hook = XTset_terminal_window;
12306 read_socket_hook = XTread_socket;
12307 frame_up_to_date_hook = XTframe_up_to_date;
12308 reassert_line_highlight_hook = XTreassert_line_highlight;
12309 mouse_position_hook = XTmouse_position;
12310 frame_rehighlight_hook = XTframe_rehighlight;
12311 frame_raise_lower_hook = XTframe_raise_lower;
12312
12313 set_vertical_scroll_bar_hook = XTset_vertical_scroll_bar;
12314 condemn_scroll_bars_hook = XTcondemn_scroll_bars;
12315 redeem_scroll_bar_hook = XTredeem_scroll_bar;
12316 judge_scroll_bars_hook = XTjudge_scroll_bars;
12317
12318 estimate_mode_line_height_hook = x_estimate_mode_line_height;
12319
12320 scroll_region_ok = 1; /* we'll scroll partial frames */
12321 char_ins_del_ok = 0; /* just as fast to write the line */
12322 line_ins_del_ok = 1; /* we'll just blt 'em */
12323 fast_clear_end_of_line = 1; /* X does this well */
12324 memory_below_frame = 0; /* we don't remember what scrolls
12325 off the bottom */
12326 baud_rate = 19200;
12327
12328 x_noop_count = 0;
12329 last_tool_bar_item = -1;
12330 any_help_event_p = 0;
12331
12332 /* Try to use interrupt input; if we can't, then start polling. */
12333 Fset_input_mode (Qt, Qnil, Qt, Qnil);
12334
12335#ifdef USE_X_TOOLKIT
12336 XtToolkitInitialize ();
12337 Xt_app_con = XtCreateApplicationContext ();
12338 XtAppSetFallbackResources (Xt_app_con, Xt_default_resources);
12339
12340 /* Install an asynchronous timer that processes Xt timeout events
12341 every 0.1s. This is necessary because some widget sets use
12342 timeouts internally, for example the LessTif menu bar, or the
12343 Xaw3d scroll bar. When Xt timouts aren't processed, these
12344 widgets don't behave normally. */
12345 {
12346 EMACS_TIME interval;
12347 EMACS_SET_SECS_USECS (interval, 0, 100000);
12348 start_atimer (ATIMER_CONTINUOUS, interval, x_process_timeouts, 0);
12349 }
12350#endif
12351
12352#if USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS
12353 xaw3d_arrow_scroll = False;
12354 xaw3d_pick_top = True;
12355#endif
12356
12357#if 0
12358 /* Note that there is no real way portable across R3/R4 to get the
12359 original error handler. */
12360 XSetErrorHandler (x_error_handler);
12361 XSetIOErrorHandler (x_io_error_quitter);
12362
12363 /* Disable Window Change signals; they are handled by X events. */
12364#ifdef SIGWINCH
12365 signal (SIGWINCH, SIG_DFL);
12366#endif /* ! defined (SIGWINCH) */
12367
12368 signal (SIGPIPE, x_connection_signal);
12369#endif
12370
12371 mac_initialize_display_info ();
12372}
12373
12374
12375void
12376syms_of_macterm ()
12377{
12378#if 0
12379 staticpro (&x_error_message_string);
12380 x_error_message_string = Qnil;
12381#endif
12382
12383 staticpro (&x_display_name_list);
12384 x_display_name_list = Qnil;
12385
12386 staticpro (&last_mouse_scroll_bar);
12387 last_mouse_scroll_bar = Qnil;
12388
12389 staticpro (&Qvendor_specific_keysyms);
12390 Qvendor_specific_keysyms = intern ("vendor-specific-keysyms");
12391
12392 staticpro (&last_mouse_press_frame);
12393 last_mouse_press_frame = Qnil;
12394
12395 help_echo = Qnil;
12396 staticpro (&help_echo);
12397 help_echo_object = Qnil;
12398 staticpro (&help_echo_object);
12399 help_echo_window = Qnil;
12400 staticpro (&help_echo_window);
12401 previous_help_echo = Qnil;
12402 staticpro (&previous_help_echo);
12403 help_echo_pos = -1;
12404
12405 DEFVAR_BOOL ("x-stretch-cursor", &x_stretch_cursor_p,
12406 "*Non-nil means draw block cursor as wide as the glyph under it.\n\
12407For example, if a block cursor is over a tab, it will be drawn as\n\
12408wide as that tab on the display.");
12409 x_stretch_cursor_p = 0;
12410
12411 DEFVAR_BOOL ("x-toolkit-scroll-bars-p", &x_toolkit_scroll_bars_p,
12412 "If not nil, Emacs uses toolkit scroll bars.");
12413#if USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS
12414 x_toolkit_scroll_bars_p = 1;
12415#else
12416 x_toolkit_scroll_bars_p = 0;
12417#endif
12418
12419 staticpro (&last_mouse_motion_frame);
12420 last_mouse_motion_frame = Qnil;
12421
12422 DEFVAR_LISP ("mac-command-key-is-meta", &Vmac_command_key_is_meta,
12423 "Non-nil means that the command key is used as the Emacs meta key.\n\
12424Otherwise the option key is used.");
12425 Vmac_command_key_is_meta = Qt;
12426
12427 DEFVAR_LISP ("mac-ready-for-drag-n-drop", &Vmac_ready_for_drag_n_drop,
12428 "Non-nil indicates that the Mac event loop can now generate drag and\n\
12429drop events. Set in term/mac-win.el.");
12430 Vmac_ready_for_drag_n_drop = Qnil;
12431
12432 DEFVAR_INT ("mac-keyboard-text-encoding", &mac_keyboard_text_encoding,
12433 "One of the Text Encoding Base constant values defined in the\n\
12434Basic Text Constants section of Inside Macintosh - Text Encoding\n\
12435Conversion Manager. Its value determines the encoding characters\n\
12436typed at the Mac keyboard (presumed to be in the MacRoman encoding)\n\
12437will convert into. E.g., if it is set to kTextEncodingMacRoman (0),\n\
12438its default value, no conversion takes place. If it is set to\n\
12439kTextEncodingISOLatin1 (0x201) or kTextEncodingISOLatin2 (0x202),\n\
12440characters typed on Mac keyboard are first converted into the\n\
12441ISO Latin-1 or ISO Latin-2 encoding, respectively before being\n\
12442passed to Emacs. Together with Emacs's set-keyboard-coding-system\n\
12443command, this enables the Mac keyboard to be used to enter non-ASCII\n\
12444characters directly.");
12445 mac_keyboard_text_encoding = kTextEncodingMacRoman;
12446}